Isis Electrical BB
Isis Electrical BB
Isis Electrical BB
Description
SectionPage #
FORWARD................................................................................................................................................................. 01-1
INTRODUCTION........................................................................................................................................................ 02-1
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM OVERVIEW......................................................................................................................... 03-1
GENERAL ELECTRICAL .......................................................................................................................................... 04-1
GENERAL.................................................................................................................................................................. 05-1
BODY CONTOLLER..................................................................................................................................................06-1
BATTERY, IGNITION, AND ACCESSORY TAPS .................................................................................................... 07-1
CB AND 2-WAY RADIO ACCOMMODATION PACKAGES..................................................................................... 08-1
POWER WINDOWS, LOCKS, REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY.................................................................................... 09-1
FUSED BATTERY CONNECTIONS INSIDE CAB.................................................................................................... 10-1
PRODUCTIVITY FEATURES .................................................................................................................................... 11-1
FOG, PLOW, GUIDE POST AND WIG WAG ACCOMMODATIONS ....................................................................... 12-1
BODY BUILDER WIRING FOR STOP/TAIL/TURN LIGHTS .................................................................................... 13-1
WORK LIGHT AND OUTSIDE CAB POWER FEATURES....................................................................................... 14-1
AIR CONDITIONING..................................................................................................................................................15-1
TRANSMISSION SPARE INPUT/OUTPUTS AND TRANSMISSION CODES ......................................................... 16-1
GAUGES.................................................................................................................................................................... 17-1
REMOTE POWER MODULES................................................................................................................................... 18-1
SWITCHES AND SWITCH LABLE PART NUMBERS AND INFORMATION .......................................................... 19-1
POWER FEATURES USING REMOTE POWER MODULES ................................................................................... 20-1
INDICATOR LIGHTS AND ALARMS ........................................................................................................................ 21-1
BODY BUILDER INTEGRATION HARNESS............................................................................................................ 22-1
PTO POWER TAKE OFF .......................................................................................................................................... 23-1
REMOTE ENGINE SPEED CONTROL FEATURES................................................................................................. 24-1
REMOTE AIR SOLENOID MODULE......................................................................................................................... 25-1
REMOTE START/STOP ............................................................................................................................................ 26-1
LIFT GATE ACCOMMODATION PACKAGE............................................................................................................ 27-1
POWERPACK 3 PRIMARY AND TEMPORARY MOUNT FEATURE ......................................................................28-1
THEFT DETERRENT................................................................................................................................................. 29-1
HYBRID ELECTRIC VEHICLE .................................................................................................................................. 30-1
ELECTRICAL FUNCTIONALITY WITHOUT ASSOCIATED FEATURE CODES..................................................... 31-1
CROSS REFERENCE ............................................................................................................................................... 32-1
INDEX
Electrical Data Body Builder Book
October 2012
TABLE OF CONTENTS
October 2012
FORWARD
FORWARD
CONTENTS
In this manual, Navistar Inc. provides information about its different products to assist those who wish to modify
these products for individual applications. Navistar does not recommend or approve any firm nor make any
judgments on the quality of the work performed by a particular firm. Individuals who use the services of a Body
Builder must satisfy themselves as to the quality of the work.
The party installing a body, a fifth wheel, any other equipment, or making any modifications to complete the vehicle
for delivery and make it road-ready is responsible to see that the completed vehicle complies with all applicable
certification procedures and safety standards, as may be set forth in Federal, State, and local statutes, rules and
regulations.
Specifications, descriptions and illustrative material in this literature are as accurate as known at time of publication
but are subject to change without notice. Illustrations are not always to scale and may include optional equipment
and accessories but may not include all standard equipment.
In addition to this Body Builder Electrical Data Book, publication CT-471, Body Builder Data, may be required. The
CT-471 - Body Builder Data is a set of booklets which includes a General Information Body Builder Data booklet for
information about the Navistar, Inc. product line; model series Body Builder Data booklets which contain information
related to the features and specifications for each of their respective models; Component Body Builder Data booklet
containing information for components which have common application in two or more truck series, Body Builder
Engine Programming information and any supplemental Body Builder Data booklets containing information for
components which have common application in two or more truck series.
SAFETY INFORMATION
October 2012
SECTION 01 - PAGE 1
FORWARD
SECTION 01 - PAGE 2
October 2012
INTRODUCTION
INTRODUCTION
DISCLAIMER: NAVISTAR DOES NOT TAKE ANY RESPONSIBILITY FOR CUSTOMER OR BODY BUILDER
WIRING.
NOTE: After-market installed wiring for engine speed control must comply with the following guidelines:
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Sealed switches and connectors must be used for switches and connections that are exposed to the weather or to salt spray emanating from
the vehicle's tires.
Route and clip wiring to minimize chafing and exposure to weather. Use conduit, loom, and/or tape to achieve this.
Fuse all power leads as close to the power source as possible. Remember fuses protect the wiring - size fuses accordingly.
All ground connections that will be made to the frame or body must be connected to clean bare metal. Remove all dirt, paint, grease and rust
that would insulate the terminal from ground. After connecting the ground, seal the connection with a good quality grease or surface sealant
to protect the connection from corrosion.
Spliced wires should be twisted together and soldered. Use a heat shrink tube with a meltable inner wall to seal the connection. Do not expose
splices to the weather.
WARNING: To avoid serious personal injury, possible death, or damage to the vehicle, make sure the transmission is
in neutral, parking brake is set, and the wheels are blocked before undertaking service procedures. In addition, turn
off the engine when you leave the vehicle. Never leave the vehicle unattended with the engine running.
WARNING: To avoid personal injury, possible death, or damage to the vehicle when adding electrical features,
disconnect batteries. Reconnect batteries when installation is complete.
Whenever disconnecting battery terminals always disconnect the ground terminal first. When reconnecting,
always connect the ground terminal last.
To prevent injury to the eyes, face, limbs and body, it is imperative that lighted materials, flames or sparks be kept
away from the vent openings of the battery. The gas mixture in the battery cells, which escapes through the
vents, could ignite and/or cause an explosion. This is particularly true when jumper cables are being used.
In addition, inhaling of gas produced by the normal operation of the battery could result in partial or permanent
damage to the respiratory system.
Always wear eye protection when working around batteries. Do not attempt to jump-start a vehicle having a
frozen battery because the battery may explode. If a frozen battery is suspected, examine all fill vents on the
battery. If ice can be seen, do not attempt to start with jumper cables as long as the battery remains frozen. Thaw
out the battery and recharge.
Do not check battery condition by shorting (flashing) across terminals.
Failure to observe these instructions could result in personal injury and/or damage to the vehicle.
Battery cable terminals must be clean and tight. Use hot water and common baking soda for removing terminal
corrosion and for cleaning the top of the battery. Brighten the contact surface with steel wool, apply a light coat of
lubricant sealing grease such as Fleetrite 472141-C1 or equivalent and reassemble. Be sure the terminals are
clamped tightly and that the battery is clamped securely in place.
When working around the terminals and battery, use extra care to avoid shorting. A good practice is to insulate pliers
and screwdrivers.
October 2012
SECTION 02 - PAGE 1
INTRODUCTION
SECTION 02 - PAGE 2
October 2012
Data Links
Navistars multiplexing uses two types of data-links, J1708 and J1939. The J1708 data link is often referred to
as ATA and J1939 is often referred to as CAN. These two types are utilized in four separate data links on the
vehicle.
Power Train data-link J1939
This data-link provides a path for communication between the engine controller, transmission controller,
antilock brake system (ABS) controller, pyrometer ammeter module (PAM), Body Controller (BC), auxiliary
gauge switch pack (AGSP) and the electronic gauge cluster (EGC). It also provides the capability for
programming and diagnostic functions via the 9-pin diagnostic connector through the use of the appropriate
service tool and diagnostic cable interface.
Body Builder data-link J1939
This data-link provides a path for communication between the remote power module(s), remote engine speed
control module and the BC.
Switch data-link J1708
This J1708 data-link provides a path for communication between the center panel switch packs, door pods and
BC.
ATA data-link J1708
This is the same J1708 data-link (sometimes referred to as ATA) that has been used in the past. The J1708
data-link is available, but is no longer the primary data link for communicating with the engine diagnostic and
programming tool. The J1708 data-link has historically been used to provide programming capability and
diagnostic information for various control modules including the ABS and the engine.
October 2012
SECTION 03 - PAGE 1
f_001
The BC communicates with the switch packs on the switch datalink, controllers from other features on the power train
datalink, and RPMs (remote power modules) and the RESCM (remote engine speed control module) on the Body
Builder datalink. It also receives input from various sensors and hard wire inputs throughout the truck. The BC
converts these inputs, in accordance with the programmed rules, into data to be transmitted on the datalinks.
It is also the power source for circuits that feed some of the components, controlled by the multiplexed switches,
inside and outside of the cab. The primary vehicle software programming resides in the BC.
SECTION 03 - PAGE 2
October 2012
RPMs provide a method of distributing and controlling power to various device loads on the vehicle, outside the cab,
without running high current wires from in-cab switches to the loads or splicing into existing wiring.
f_002
The RPM is connected to the BC via the Body Builder J1939 datalink (the BC is capable of controlling up to seven
RPMs on the vehicle). The only factory-installed wires connected to the RPM are battery power for driving the loads
and the datalink cable. Connectors for Body Builder-installed inputs and outputs are also provided. Power is fed to
the RPM through a fusible link to the battery source. Each RPM has six independently controllable, 20 Ampere
(AMP) outputs (80A maximum per RPM) with virtual (software programmable) fusing similar to the BC. If higher
current capacity is needed, two outputs can be paralleled or the RPM can control a high current relay while still
maintaining logic and diagnostic capability without having to wire to the inside of the cab.
Because the RPM is connected to the BC via the datalink, it also serves as an integration gateway to the BC and
the vehicle electrical system. Six digital inputs on each RPM allow information from body accessories to be
communicated to the BC and processed for interlocks, operator information/warning, etc. These inputs also allow the
Body Builder to add body-mounted switches to turn on or off the same electrical devices controlled by in-cab
switches.
Additional information concerning the use and installation of RPMs is contained in the applicable Feature sections
that follow (see 60AAA/60AAB in particular for detailed data on RPM connectors/pin functions, wiring, and mounting).
The following is an example of how a vehicle electrical system might be configured.
October 2012
SECTION 03 - PAGE 3
f_003
The International Diamond Logic electrical system, in conjunction with the Diamond Logic Builder software,
provides the Body Builder with unprecedented flexibility in adding and customizing the electrical features on a
vehicle.
SECTION 03 - PAGE 4
October 2012
GENERAL ELECTRICAL
GENERAL ELECTRICAL
Navistar vehicle electrical systems are becoming increasingly complex with the addition of a BC, electronic engine
and transmission controls, electronically driven instrument gauges, and Antilock Brake Systems (ABS) to name a
few. While most systems still operate on battery voltage (12 volts), some systems operate at as high as 107 volts
(electronic fuel injection) and as low as five (5) volts (electronic engine controls).
Navistar publishes Electrical Circuit Diagram Manuals for all its models. Body builders and installers should refer to
these manuals before connecting body lights and accessories to the vehicle electrical system to assure that circuits
chosen are both appropriate and not overloaded. Modifications not defined in the circuit diagram book are not to be
made to the vehicle electrical/electronic control systems without first contacting Navistar for assistance at its Tech
Central Department, telephone 1-800-336-4500.
Description
Alternator/Battery Feeds
Ignition Feeds
Accessory Feeds
Headlight System (Daytime Running Lights, Fog, Hi-Beam,etc.); Data Link J1939(+)
Interior Lights (Dome, Panel, etc.); Data Link J1708(+)
Exterior Lights (Tail, Market, Clearance, etc.)
Exterior Lights (Turn, back-up, etc.)
Engine/Chassis Systems (Fuel Solenoid, Horn, etc.); Data Link J1708(-)
Engine/Chassis Monitoring Systems (Gauges)
Data Link J1939(-)
Driver Aid Systems (Windshield Washer, Heater, etc.)
Engine Controls - Electronic
GND
Battery GND Cables or Computer Data Link Systems
NOTE: The wiring in multiple conductor jacketed cable does not follow the above color code system. See the
electrical circuit diagram manual for specific colors and circuit numbers used with each system. Use only
GXL", SXL" or TXL" insulated wire. Crimp and solder all connections.
October 2012
SECTION 04 - PAGE 1
GENERAL ELECTRICAL
CAUTION: Wire gauge is designed to match fuse/circuit breaker rating. Do not increase the size of a circuit
breaker or fuse. To do so could cause wiring to overheat and burn.
Circuit Breakers
Part Number
Size
5A
7.5 A
10 A
15 A
20 A
25 A
30 A
3536177C1
3536178C1
3536179C1
3536180C1
3536181C1
3536182C1
Fuses
Color
Brown
Red
Blue
Yellow
White
Green
Part Number
3534208C1
3546109C1
3534209C1
3534210C1
3534211C1
3534212C1
3534213C1
Color
Tan
Brown
Red
Blue
Yellow
Natural
Green
Circuit breakers and fuses can be installed in the chassis wiring using the following in-line connectors:
1676841C91 - Inline socket and cable for circuit breaker/fuse (20 A Maximum)
1682115C91 - Inline socket and cable for circuit breaker/fuse (30 A Maximum)
Table 4
Size
20 A
20 A
30 A
30 A
Devices
Part Number
Color
131224C1
3529688C1
571691C1
3529690C1
Yellow
Autofuse
Circuit Breaker - Type III
Autofuse
Circuit Breaker - Type III
Green
Type
WorkStar
3534164C1
3573312C1
3573311C1
589390C1
589391C1
1652325C1
1661375C2
1661377C1
1661376C1
1677851C1
1671609C1
1677914C1
587579C1
At Fuse Block
Terminal Fuse Block (18/20 Gauge)
Terminal Fuse Block (14/16 Gauge)
Terminal Fuse Block (10/12 Gauge)
At Tail Lights
Seal, Wire - (Blue) .165-.138 O.D. Cable (12-14 Gauge)
Seal, Wire - (Gray) .137-.111 O.D. Cable (14-16 Gauge)
Seal, Wire - (LtGn) .110-.080 O.D. Cable (16-20 Gauge)
Body Connector, 5-Way Male
Terminal, Female - 14/16 Gauge
Lock, 5-Way Male Connector
Body Connector, 5-Way Female
Terminal, Male - 14-16 Gauge
Lock, 5-Way Female Connector
Sealing Plug (for Empty Connector Cavities)
NOTE: Any unused circuit cavities must be plugged with sealing plugs provided with chassis harness.
SECTION 04 - PAGE 2
October 2012
GENERAL ELECTRICAL
Wire Gauge
2033912C1
2033911C1
12, 14
16, 18, 20
Cavity Seals
Wire Gauge
0589390C1
0589391C1
1652325C1
12
14
16, 18, 20
2039312C91
2039342C1
3553961C1
3554019C1
October 2012
SECTION 04 - PAGE 3
GENERAL ELECTRICAL
f_004
Standard Terminal
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
Mating End
Core Wings
Insulation Wings
Cable
Lock Tang
Insulation
Wire Strands
Solder
SECTION 04 - PAGE 4
October 2012
GENERAL ELECTRICAL
f_005
Insulation
Wire Strands
Clip (Positioned Correctly)
Crimped Correctly
Solder
Tape
SPLICE INSPECTION
f_006
Splice Inspection
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
Terminal Application
Insulation Crimp
Wire Strands Visible in this Area
Core Crimp
Solder Application
Good Solder Application
Crimp and Seal Heat Application
Evidence of Glue
October 2012
SECTION 04 - PAGE 5
GENERAL ELECTRICAL
Description
12-10 AWG Splice
16-14 AWG Splice
22-18 AWG Splice
Dual Wall Heat Shrink, 50mm
Quantity
2
7
2
50
NOTE: A new sleeve must be located a minimum of 1.5 inches (40 mm) from a connector, clip or another
sleeve.
1.
2.
3.
4.
NOTE: Always use the recommended crimp tool for each sleeve. A detailed crimp chart is included in the
Repair Kit.
CAUTION: Use appropriate heat gun. Do not use a match or open flame to heat the sleeve seal.
5. Electrically check the sleeve and wire cable for continuity.
f_007
Wire Strands
Wire Stop
Crimp Connector
Evidence of Glue
SECTION 04 - PAGE 6
October 2012
GENERAL ELECTRICAL
Wire Repair
This instruction addresses termination and splicing of J1939 wire.
f_008
WIRE SPLICING
1. Strip wire ends 1/4 inch.
2. Re-twist any loose wires (one twist per inch).
October 2012
f_009
SECTION 04 - PAGE 7
GENERAL ELECTRICAL
3. Slide 2-inch pieces of insulated heat shrink tube over wire for later use.
f_010
f_011
SECTION 04 - PAGE 8
October 2012
GENERAL ELECTRICAL
f_012
8. Wrap wires with foil tape. Maintain at least 1/2 wrap overlap.
.
f_013
October 2012
f_014
SECTION 04 - PAGE 9
GENERAL ELECTRICAL
J1939
J1939 is a high speed serial communications data link. The system requires two resistor caps. The first resistor
cap for Body Builder J1939 currently starts in the engine compartment. The second resistor cap ends where the
last module is placed. The wire between these two resistors is called the backbone. The backbone cannot be
longer than 131.2 feet (40m). A module can tap into the backbone. This point is called the Node. The distance
between two nodes cannot be less than 3.9 inches (0.1m). The cable length from the node to the module
cannot be longer than 9.8 feet (3m).
With the research of the robustness of the J1939-15 lite (unshielded) International removed the shield from
their high performance vehicle in January 2002. Mixing of the shielded (J1939-11) and unshielded (J1939-15)
is not recommended.
SECTION 04 - PAGE 10
October 2012
GENERAL ELECTRICAL
High voltage systems require the maintainer to be familiar with two types of electrical systems.
DC (Direct Current)
Most DC systems on today's trucks use 12 volt negative GND. Some systems can store DC electricity in
batteries with operating voltages as high as 600 DC volts.
AC (Alternating Current)
The main difference between AC and DC systems is that the voltage levels in DC systems remain constant
while the voltage levels in AC systems are constantly changing. When measuring an AC system, it is important
to know that the average voltage is zero, and that is why A VOLTMETER SET TO DC WILL NOT INDICATE
THE PRESENCE OF AN AC VOLTAGE WHEN CONNECTED TO AN AC CIRCUIT!
High voltage can be lethal. Always refer to the manufacturer of the high voltage component when maintenance
or repairs are needed. In most cases, diagnostics and repair are performed after the high voltage circuits are
disabled. If working around or maintaining high voltage circuits, please seek high voltage training.
WARNING: To avoid property damage, personal injury, or death, circuits must be checked using a voltmeter for
the presence of both DC and AC voltages. A voltmeter set to DC will not indicate the presence of an AC voltage
when connected to an AC circuit! Contacting an unknown AC or DC voltage may cause equipment damage,
electrical shock, and/or electrocution.
Only a trained technician may perform service inside high voltage components. If working around or
maintaining high voltage circuits, please seek high voltage training.
Shore Power
Shore power is a connection from a vehicle to an external 120 volt AC power source. The vehicle is equipped
with an exterior receptacle that allows connection to an external shore power source.
NOTE: High voltage shore power wiring may NOT be marked for easy identification as high voltage.
Inverters
Inverters are electronic devices used to change DC (Direct Current) into AC (Alternating Current). Some
inverters contain converters that also convert AC to DC for battery charging or running 12V equipment.
NOTE: High voltage wiring for inverters may NOT be marked for easy identification as high voltage.
October 2012
SECTION 04 - PAGE 11
GENERAL ELECTRICAL
SECTION 04 - PAGE 12
October 2012
GENERAL ELECTRICAL
and be familiar with its use. Consult the local fire department with any question pertaining to fire
extinguishers.
Ensure that the high voltage power, high voltage power generating equipment and high voltage storage
devices are disconnected, locked out, or otherwise disabled BEFORE working on or around the vehicle, its
electrical circuits, or components. Unless disabled, Auxiliary Power Units (APUs) may start at any time
without warning; when this occurs, the circuits associated with the APU become energized with potentially
lethal high voltage. Some components may require a waiting period or special procedures to discharge the
voltage completely.
Use an appropriate electrical tester and procedures to confirm that the power is disconnected BEFORE
performing any work on or near any high voltage components/circuits.
Exercise caution around output circuits even when the input power is off. Parallel power sources and energy
storage devices can still be dangerous. Be familiar with the high voltage equipment installed on the vehicle.
Some systems contain high voltage condensers that may require time to discharge after power is removed.
After disconnecting or exposing a high-voltage connector or terminal, insulate it immediately using insulation
tape.
After completion of any electrical work, BEFORE restoring the power, verify that parts and/or tools are
removed from the work area and that the fasteners are firmly tightened to the specified torque and the
connectors are correctly connected.
Voltage can be fatal at levels greater than 60 volts. High voltage can jump a larger air gap than low voltage. If
contact is made with high voltage, it may not be possible to simply let go.
Towing a HEV with its drive wheels on the ground may cause the motor to generate electricity. Consult the
operators/owners manual for proper towing procedures.
If a high voltage fuse or circuit protection device trips, do not re-energize the circuit until it has been
determined that the circuit is safe. See manufacturers troubleshooting procedures before servicing a high
voltage system.
Reference OSHA Regulations as necessary and applicable.
SUPPRESSION
International strongly recommends these electromagnetic devices be electrically suppressed, when adding
electromagnetic devices such as relays, magnetic switches, and solenoids.
Unsuppressed electromagnetic devices can generate large voltage spikes which are conducted into the vehicle
electrical system. These voltage spikes may adversely affect customer added electronic devices and in some
instances may affect International installed electronic components.
When installing electromagnetic devices, specify suppressed units. If suppressed units are not available, diode
suppression may be added as shown below:
The following suppressed relays and magnetic switches are available from International.
Table 8
Part Number
1691520C91
1693479C91
3519350C1
WELDING INFORMATION
Whenever electric welding is done on any part of the vehicle, it is not necessary to disconnect the
International electronic modules in the cab such as the BC, ESC or RPM, and the instrument cluster. The
welder's GND must be connected as close to the weld as possible. If the vehicle is equipped with an
International engine, disconnect both the positive (+) and the negative (-) battery cables including the
electronic power feeds prior to electric welding. If it is necessary to weld close to an electronic component, it is
October 2012
SECTION 04 - PAGE 13
GENERAL ELECTRICAL
recommended that the component be temporarily removed.
Consult manufacturers instructions for all other electronic modules such as Allison Transmission, Eaton Auto
Shift Transmission, Bendix ABS, Wabco ABS, Cummins Engine, Caterpillar Engine, and Detroit Diesel Engine.
ROUTING GUIDELINES
Any hosing, tubing, battery cable, wiring or electrical harness must not rub on a sharp edge. However, due to
the high abrasion resistance of synflex tubing, it is permissible for synflex tubing to make contact with the lower
edge of the frame rail flange when the tubing is making the transition from the outside to down and under the
rail. This does not mean that proper clearance or the need for protective wrap is not needed when synflex line
contacts sharp edges or threaded fasteners.
Any hosing, tubing, battery cable, wiring or electrical harness must not rub or make contact with a hot surface.
There should be 5" minimum clearance from the exhaust depending on the situation. The further back from the
turbo, the less clearance required.
Nothing should rub or make contact with the copper compressor discharge tubing other than the clamp(s) that
support it.
All hosing, tubing, battery cables or electrical harnesses should be supported at least every 18" to 20".
Straplocks used to directly clamp or support battery cables or main engine wiring harnesses must be no less
than 7/16" in width.
Straplocks are not to be used on any bulk hose materials (heater hoses, make-up lines, etc.).
SECTION 04 - PAGE 14
October 2012
Distance From
6
8
3
1/2
GENERAL ELECTRICAL
Electrical Harness
Table 10
Problem
Requirement
No Contact
None
1
Yes
Yes
3
Yes
Yes
1/2
Not Directly Under
1 Minimum
1/2 Minimum
1/2 (250 Pound) Wide
No Relative Motion
Cushioned Only
No Cantilever
Dont Clip Anything to Them
Use Grommet
Operates Without Damage
14
Use Shrink Wrap
Do
Dont
October 2012
Exceed 5 AMPS.
SECTION 04 - PAGE 15
GENERAL ELECTRICAL
Item
Do
Dont
SECTION 04 - PAGE 16
October 2012
GENERAL ELECTRICAL
Item
Do
Dont
October 2012
SECTION 04 - PAGE 17
GENERAL ELECTRICAL
Item
Turn Signals
Work Light
RPM Connection
Remote mounted Fuel Level (Low Fuel
Warning)
Clutch switch
Brake Switch
Do
Connect to Body Builder connector (4450
cavity B and C; circuits 56 left/57 right
combined) (4460 cavity A and B; circuits 56
left/57 right separate)
a) Connect into BC connector 1603 Pin G Work
Light Output circuit.
b) Work lamp accommodation (595ABR) must
be programmed into the BC.
c) Add Work Light push button switch to
instrument cluster.Exceed 10 AMPS.
Connect to Body Builder connectors at the
RPM (J3-output circuits and J4- remote inputs).
Refer to RPM Section.
Install additional fuel sender. Extract fuel gauge
data from the Public J1939 data link.
Dont
Connect to the input side of the turn signal
switch or the BC circuit inputs.
Exceed 8 AMPS total circuit.
Exceed 10 AMPS.
SECTION 04 - PAGE 18
October 2012
GENERAL
GENERAL
The following section provides basic information of how to integrate TEM's electrical systems with the vehicle
electrical system. This section includes feature descriptions, programming information and sales codes where
applicable. Also included is a description of how the feature works and in some cases, how the feature can be used.
If the vehicle was not ordered with the desired feature, this section covers basic information on how to add a feature
to the vehicle.
An index of feature codes covered in this section is included in the table below.
Before proceeding, review the Introduction information.
Table 12
Feature Code
04SBL
08518
08585
08718
08HAA
08HAB
08HAE
08HAG
08HAH
08HAT
08HAU
08NAA
08RBK
08RCB
08REA
08RGA
08SAJ
08THG
08THH
08THJ
08THN
08THU
08THV
08TKK
08TME
08TMG
08TMH
October 2012
SECTION 05 - PAGE 1
GENERAL
Feature Code Index
Feature Code
08TMN
08TNP
08VZR
08VZS
08WAA
08WAD
08WCK
08WCM
08WCS
08WEB
08WEE
08WEX
08WGA
08WGB
08WGC
08WGD
08WGL
08WGP
08WGR
08WHX
08WHY
08WKM
08WJA
08WJB
08WJH
08WJT
08WJU
08WJV
08WJW
08WLL
08WLM
08WLN
08WMA
Description
Trailer Connection Socket
Auxiliary Harness for Front Snow Plow Application
In Cab Switch Controls for Body Accessories, 1
RPM (BOC)/6 Momentary Switches
In Cab Switch Controls for Body Accessories, 2
RPMs (BOC)/12 Momentary Switches
Pedestal Mounted Work Light (Truck Lite 81 Series)
Battery Disconnect Switch Battery Box-Mounted
Power Source, 2Post Terminal Type
Power Source for Power Lift Gate Feed
Battery Disconnect Switch Cab Floor-Mounted
Positive Disconnect
Extending Frame and Tail Light Harnesses for
Drop Frame Beverage Body
Passenger- Controlled Air Horn Instrument
Panel-Mounted Switch
Auxiliary Harness for Auxiliary Power Source
One Universal Air Solenoid, N/C
Two Universal Air Solenoids, N/C
Three Universal Air Solenoids, N/C
Four Universal Air Solenoids, N/C
Windshield Wiper Speed Control Forced to Slowest
Speed
Five Universal Air Solenoids, N/O
Six Universal Air Solenoids, N/O
Battery Disconnect Switch Battery Box-Mounted
Positive Disconnect
Battery Disconnect Switch Cab Floor-Mounted
Positive Disconnect
6 Universal Air Solenoids. N/C
Special 200 AMP Max. Lift Gate Power Source 2
Gauge Power Cable
Power Source For Customer Lift Gate 0 Gauge
Power Cable
Power Source, Dual Pole Terminal for Power Lift
Gate Feed
Battery Disconnect Switch (Power to PDC) {Joseph
Pollak} Lever Operated, Mounted on Battery Box
Battery Disconnect Switch (Power to PDC)
Locking, Key Operated, Mounted on Battery Box
Battery Disconnect Switch (Power to PDC) {Joseph
Pollak} Lever Operated, Cab Mounted
Battery Disconnect Switch (Power to PDC) {Joseph
Pollak} Key Operated, Cab Mounted
Pedestal-Mounted Work Light
Fog Lights (Peterson) Amber, Rectangular
WorkStar Series
Fog Lights (Peterson) Clear, Rectangular
WorkStar Series
Work Light Accommodation Package
Customer-Supplied Light or Aux. Application
08WPL
08WPM
08WPZ
08WRB
08WSK
SECTION 05 - PAGE 2
Section Name
Bodybuilder Wiring for Stop/Tail/Turn Lights
Fog, Plow and Guide Post Accommodation
Packages
Section 18-Page 1
Section 18-Page 1
Section 14-Page 1
Section 07-Page 5
Section 10-Page 1
Section 27-Page 1
Section 07-Page 5
Section 13-Page 13
Section 25-Page 5
Section 13-Page 13
Section 25-Page 1
Section 25-Page 1
Section 25-Page 1
Section 25-Page 1
Section 12-Page 9
Productivity Features
Section 11-Page 4
Section 25-Page 1
Section 25-Page 1
Section 07-Page 5
Section 07-Page 5
Section 25-Page 1
Section 27-Page 1
Section 27-Page 1
Section 27-Page 1
Section 07-Page 5
Section 07-Page 5
Section 07-Page 6
Section 07-Page 6
Section 14-Page 1
Section 14-Page 1
Section 12-Page 1
Section 12-Page 1
Section 11-Page 1
Section 07-Page 4
Section 18-Page 1
October 2012
Section 12-Page 1
Section 12-Page 1
GENERAL
Feature Code
08WSM
08WTJ
08WXB
08WXN
08WZG
08WZP
08XBK
08WXD
12VXT
12VXU
12VXV
12VXY
12VYL
12VZA
12VZB
13GSB
13GSS
13WDH
13GUE
13GUG
13WDN
13WUA
13WUB
13WUC
13WUD
13WUE
13WUG
13WUH
13WUJ
13WUK
13WUL
13WUM
October 2012
Section 30-Page 1
Section 30-Page 1
Section 23-Page 54
Section 16-Page 6
Section 16-Page 6
Section 16-Page 6
Section 16-Page 6
Section 16-Page 6
Section 16-Page 6
Section 16-Page 6
Section 16-Page 6
Section 16-Page 6
Section 16-Page 6
Section 16-Page 6
SECTION 05 - PAGE 3
GENERAL
Feature Code Index
Feature Code
13WUP
13WUR
13WUS
13WUT
13WUU
13WUV
13WUZ
13XAA
13ZYV
13ZYW
13ZYX
16HCK
16HCL
16HGG
16HGH
16HGJ
16HGL
16HGN
16HHT
16HKA
16HKT
16VCN
16WJU
16VCP
16WJV
16WKB
16WKZ
16WLM
60AAA
60AAB
Description
Allison Spare Input/Output for Bus Series (B)
Allison Spare Input/Output for Dump/Construction
with Two- Speed Axle or Auxiliary Transmission
(RDS)
Allison Spare Input/Output for Rugged Duty Series
(RDS); General Purpose Trucks Modified for Single
Input Auto Neutral
Allison Spare Input/Output for Emergency Vehicle
Series (EVS); without Split Shaft PTO
Allison Spare Input/Output for Specialty
Transmission Series (SP)
Allison Spare Input/Output for Highway Series (HP);
General Purpose Trucks Modified for Single Input
Auto Neutral
Allison Spare Input/Output for Emergency Vehicle
Series (EVS), 127/198 includes J1939 Based Auto
Neutral; Fire/Pumper, Tank, Aerial/Ladder
Dash-Mounted PTO Control for Customer- Provided
Clutched, Air-Shifted PTO
HEV, Power Electronics Carrier, Back of Fuel Tank
HEV, Power Electronics Carrier, Back of Battery
Box
HEV, Power Electronics Carrier, Behind PEC
Seatbelt Warning Prewire 1 to 3 Belts
Seatbelt Warning Prewire 4 to 6 Belts
Optional Engine Oil Temperature Gauge
Optional Allison Transmission Oil Temperature
Gauge
Optional Manual Transmission Oil Temperature
Gauge
Optional Rear Axle Oil Temperature Gauge
Optional Air Application Gauge
Optional Ammeter Gauge
Optional IP Cluster display Omit fault codes
IP Cluster Display Diagnostics
Remote Keyless Entry w/Aux. Work Light Feature
Power Windows/Locks (2)
Keyless Entry Remote w/ Trailer Function
Power Windows/Locks (4)
Air Conditioning
Remote Keyless Entry and Use of Aux Feature
PTO Hourmeter for Customer-Supplied PTO
Remote Power Module (1) With 6 Latched Switches
Remote Power Modules (2) With 12 Latched
Switches
60AAC
60AAD
60AAE
60AAG
60AAH
60AAJ
60AAK
60AAL
60AAM
SECTION 05 - PAGE 4
Section Name
Transmission Spare Input/Outputs and
Transmission Code
Section 16-Page 7
Section 16-Page 7
Section 16-Page 7
Section 16-Page 7
Section 16-Page 7
Section 16-Page 7
Section 23-Page 54
Section 30-Page 1
Section 30-Page 1
Section 30-Page 1
Section 11-Page 6
Section 11-Page 6
Section 17-Page 3
Gauges
Section 17-Page 4
Gauges
Section 17-Page 5
Gauges
Gauges
Gauges
Gauges
Gauges
Power Windows, Locks, Remote Keyless Entry
Power Windows, Locks, Remote Keyless Entry
Power Windows, Locks, Remote Keyless Entry
Power Windows, Locks, Remote Keyless Entry
Air Conditioning
Power Windows, Locks, Remote Keyless Entry
PTO (Power Take OFF) and PTO Hourmeter
Remote Power Modules
Section 17-Page 6
Section 17-Page 8
Section 17-Page 9
Section 17-Page 11
Section 17-Page 11
Section 09-Page 1
Section 09-Page 1
Section 09-Page 1
Section 09-Page 1
Section 15-Page 1
Section 09-Page 1
Section 23-Page 83
Section 18-Page 2
Section 18-Page 2
Section 28-Page 1
Section 18-Page 2
Section 18-Page 2
Section 18-Page 2
Section 18-Page 2
Section 18-Page 2
Section 18-Page 2
Section 18-Page 1
October 2012
Section 28-Page 1
GENERAL
Feature Code
60AAN
60ABA
60ABB
60ABC
60ABD
60ABE
60ABK
60ABL
60ABM
60ABN
60ACA
60ACB
60ACC
60ACD
60ACE
60ACG
60ACH
60ACJ
60ACK
60ACS
60ACT
60ACU
60ACV
60ACW
60ACX
60AJA
60AJC
60AJD
60AJE
60AJG
60AJH
60AJJ
October 2012
Section 24-Page 25
Section 24-Page 29
Section 24-Page 32
Section 24-Page 36
SECTION 05 - PAGE 5
GENERAL
Feature Code
60AJK
60AJL
60AJM
60AJN
60AJR
60AJS
60AJT
60AJU
60AJV
60AJW
60AJX
60AJY
60AJZ
60AKA
60AKB
60AKC
60AKD
60AKE
60AKG
60AKK
60AKL
595AKY
595ANR
595ABC
SECTION 05 - PAGE 6
October 2012
BODY CONTROLLER
BODY CONTROLLER
f_015
NOTE: Pins E3, E5, and E7 of the BC 32-way connector (1602) are the Zero Volt References (ZVR) for various
sensors on the vehicle and should NEVER have battery voltage applied to them. Doing so will permanently
damage the BC. Do not connect other Ground (GND) signals to the ZVR.
NOTE: All connectors are viewed as looking at the terminal side of the connector.
October 2012
SECTION 06 - PAGE 1
BODY CONTROLLER
BC CONNECTOR J3 (1600)
BC Connector J3 (1600)
f_016
Table 13
#1600 In-Cab
32-Way Connector
Pin
Type
A1
A2
A3
A4
A5
A6
A7
A8
A9
A10
A11
A12
Air Chassis
Pin Description
A13
A14
A15
A16
Automatic
Manual Transmission
Automatic
Manual Transmission
Transmission
Transmission
Accessory Switch Input Accessory Switch Input Accessory Switch Input Accessory Switch Input
AC Request
AC Request
AC Request
AC Request
AC Diagnostics
AC Diagnostics
AC Diagnostics
AC Diagnostics
Headlight Dimmer
Headlight Dimmer
Headlight Dimmer
Headlight Dimmer
Switch (Highbeam
Switch (Highbeam
Switch (Highbeam
Switch (Highbeam
Switch)
Switch)
Switch)
Switch)
Electric Horn Switch
Electric Horn Switch
Electric Horn Switch
Electric Horn Switch
Input
Input
Input
Input
Right Turn Signal
Right Turn Signal
Right Turn Signal
Right Turn Signal
Switch Input
Switch Input
Switch Input
Switch Input
Left Turn Signal Switch Left Turn Signal Switch Left Turn Signal Switch Left Turn Signal Switch
Input
Input
Input
Input
Washer Fluid Low
Washer Fluid Low
Washer Fluid Low
Washer Fluid Low
Switch
Switch
Switch
Switch
Wiper Switch 0
Wiper Switch 0
Wiper Switch 0
Wiper Switch 0
Wiper Switch 1
Wiper Switch 1
Wiper Switch 1
Wiper Switch 1
Wiper Switch 2
Wiper Switch 2
Wiper Switch 2
Wiper Switch 2
Manual Park Brake
Manual Park Brake
Air Park Brake Switch Air Park Brake Switch
Switch
Switch
Door Switch Input
Door Switch Input
Door Switch Input
Door Switch Input
Flash-to- Pass Switch Flash-to- Pass Switch Flash-to- Pass Switch Flash-to- Pass Switch
Input
Input
Input
Input
Washer Pump
Washer Pump
Washer Pump
Washer Pump
IGN Switch InputI
IGN Switch InputI
IGN Switch InputI
IGN Switch InputI
B1
B2
B3*
B4
Open
Open
Open
Open
Primary Air Pressure Primary Air Pressure Auxiliary Air Pressure Auxiliary Air Pressure
Secondary Air PressureSecondary Air Pressure
Open
Open
Open
Clutch Switch
Open
Clutch Switch
SECTION 06 - PAGE 2
October 2012
BODY CONTROLLER
#1600 In-Cab
32-Way Connector
Pin
Type
B5
B6
B7
B8
B9
B10
B11
B12
B13
B14
B15
B16
Air Chassis
Pin Description
Automatic
Manual Transmission
Automatic
Manual Transmission
Transmission
Transmission
AC Accumulator Inlet AC Accumulator Inlet AC Accumulator Inlet AC Accumulator Inlet
Sensor
Sensor
Sensor
Sensor
MD: Open
MD: Open
Open
Open
SS: Engine Oil Temp (Cat SS: Engine Oil Temp (Cat
engine only)
engine only)
Transmission Oil
Transmission Oil
Temperature Sensor
Temperature Sensor
PTO State Input
PTO State Input
(Manual) OR PTO State
(Manual) OR PTO State
Input
Input
Fuel Level Sensor Input Fuel Level Sensor Input Fuel Level Sensor Input Fuel Level Sensor Input
Right Side
Right Side
Right Side
Right Side
Fuel Level Sensor Input Fuel Level Sensor Input Fuel Level Sensor Input Fuel Level Sensor Input
Left Side
Left Side
Left Side
Left Side
FR(Front) Axle Oil TempFR(Front) Axle Oil TempFR(Front) Axle Oil TempFR(Front) Axle Oil Temp
RR(Rear) Axle Oil Temp RR(Rear) Axle Oil Temp RR(Rear) Axle Oil Temp RR(Rear) Axle Oil Temp
AC Pressure
AC Pressure
AC Pressure
AC Pressure
Transducer Signal
Transducer Signal
Transducer Signal
Transducer Signal
AC Accumulator Outlet AC Accumulator Outlet AC Accumulator Outlet AC Accumulator Outlet
Sensor
Sensor
Sensor
Sensor
Brake Application
Brake Application
Open
Open
Pressure
Pressure
Open
Open
Open
Open
Steering Wheel Cruise Steering Wheel Cruise Steering Wheel Cruise Steering Wheel Cruise
Switches Input
Switches Input
Switches Input
Switches Input
The circuit attached to pin B3 should NOT have additional connections or splices added on an air chassis.
NOTE: All outputs will handle up to a 500 milliAmpere load unless stated otherwise.
NOTE: Circuits labeled Gnd Active", 12v Active", or 5v Active are open circuit until active.
No connections or splices are allowable on any signals that are highlighted in bold italic.
October 2012
SECTION 06 - PAGE 3
BODY CONTROLLER
BC CONNECTOR J4 (1601)
BC Connector J4 (1601)
f_017
Table 14
#1601 In-Cab
32-Way Connector
Pin
E1
E2
E3
E4
E5
E6
E7
E8
E9
Air Chassis
Pin Description
Type
Automatic
Manual Transmission
Automatic
Manual Transmission
Transmission
Transmission
TEM Pump Inhibit Relay TEM Pump Inhibit Relay TEM Pump Inhibit Relay TEM Pump Inhibit Relay
OR TEM Aux Relay
OR TEM Aux Relay
OR TEM Aux Relay
Output (Low Side Driver)
OR TEM Aux Relay
Driver 2
Driver 2
Driver 2
Driver 2
TEM Engine Stop Relay TEM Engine Stop Relay TEM Engine Stop Relay TEM Engine Stop Relay
OR TEM Aux Relay
OR TEM Aux Relay
OR TEM Aux Relay
Output (Low Side Driver)
OR TEM Aux Relay
Driver 1
Driver 1
Driver 1
Driver 1
Auto Neutral Relay OR
Auto Neutral Relay OR
Open OR Advanced
LCT Column Shifter IGN Open OR Advanced LCT Column Shifter IGN
Output (Low Side Driver)
Logic Relay Driver #3
Relay OR Advanced
Logic Relay Driver #3
Relay OR Advanced
Logic Relay Driver #3
Logic Relay Driver #3
MD: Theft Deterrent OR MD: Theft Deterrent OR
Advanced Logic Relay Advanced Logic Relay
Theft Deterrent OR
Theft Deterrent OR
Driver #4
Driver #4
Advanced Logic Relay Advanced Logic Relay
Output (Low Side Driver)
SS: Theft Deterrent OR SS: Theft Deterrent OR
Driver #4
Driver #4
Advanced Logic Relay Advanced Logic Relay
Driver #4
Driver #4
40 Amp Aux Circuit OR 40 Amp Aux Circuit OR 40 Amp Aux Circuit OR 40 Amp Aux Circuit OR
Output (Low Side Driver)
Stop Relay (Brake Pedal) Stop Relay (Brake Pedal) Stop Relay (Brake Pedal) Stop Relay (Brake Pedal)
Windshield Wiper
Windshield Wiper
Windshield Wiper
Windshield Wiper
Output (Low Side Driver)
High/Low Speed
High/Low Speed
High/Low Speed
High/Low Speed
Windshield Wiper
Windshield Wiper
Windshield Wiper
Windshield Wiper
Output (Low Side Driver)
Power (On/Off)
Power (On/Off)
Power (On/Off)
Power (On/Off)
MD: LCT Shifter PB
MD: LCT Shifter PB
position unlock solenoid
position unlock solenoid
MD: Open
SS: LCT Shifter PB
SS: LCT Shifter PB
SS: Odometer Shut-off
Output (Low Side Driver)
Open
position unlock solenoid
position unlock solenoid
Relay
OR Odometer Shut-off
OR Odometer Shut-off
Relay
Relay
Air Solenoid #7/Relay
Air Solenoid #7/Relay
Air Solenoid #7/Relay
Air Solenoid #7/Relay
Output (High Side Driver)
Driver #7
Driver #7
Driver #7
Driver #7
SECTION 06 - PAGE 4
October 2012
BODY CONTROLLER
#1601 In-Cab
32-Way Connector
Pin
Type
E10
E11
E12
E13
E14
E15
F1
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
F7
F8
F9
F10
F11
F12
F13
F14
F15
F16
Air Chassis
Pin Description
Automatic
Manual Transmission
Automatic
Manual Transmission
Transmission
Transmission
Trailer Tail Lights (Tractor Trailer Tail Lights (Tractor
Body Builder Tail Lights/ Body Builder Tail Lights/
or Body Builder Lighting)/ or Body Builder Lighting)/
Air Solenoid #13/Relay Air Solenoid #13/Relay
Air Solenoid #13/Relay Air Solenoid #13/Relay
Driver #13
Driver #13
Driver #13
Driver #13
Trailer Auxiliary Circuit Trailer Auxiliary Circuit
TEM PTO Engagement TEM PTO Engagement
OR TEM PTO
OR TEM PTO
Relay (Lectra-Shift)
Relay (Lectra-Shift)
Engagement Relay
Engagement Relay
(Lectra-Shift)
(Lectra-Shift)
Air Solenoid #3/Relay
Air Solenoid #3/Relay
Air Solenoid #3/Relay
Air Solenoid #3/Relay
Driver #3
Driver #3
Driver #3
Driver #3
Air Solenoid #5/Relay
Air Solenoid #5/Relay
Air Solenoid #5/Relay
Air Solenoid #5/Relay
Driver #5
Driver #5
Driver #5
Driver #5
Right Plow Lights Relay Right Plow Lights Relay Right Plow Lights Relay Right Plow Lights Relay
Trailer Right Turn Signal Trailer Right Turn Signal
(Tractor or Body Builder (Tractor or Body Builder Body Builder Right Turn Body Builder Right Turn
Lighting)/Air Solenoid Signal/Air Solenoid #14/ Signal/Air Solenoid #14/
Lighting)/Air Solenoid
Relay Driver #14
Relay Driver #14
#14 (Truck)/Relay Driver #14 (Truck)/Relay Driver
#14
#14
Park Brake Relay
Park Brake Relay
Park Brake Relay
Park Brake Relay
Air Solenoid #11/Relay Air Solenoid #11/Relay Air Solenoid #11/Relay Air Solenoid #11/Relay
Driver #11
Driver #11
Driver #11
Driver #11
Air Solenoid #12/Relay Air Solenoid #12/Relay Air Solenoid #12/Relay Air Solenoid #12/Relay
Driver #12
Driver #12
Driver #12
Driver #12
Air Solenoid #6/Relay
Air Solenoid #6/Relay
Air Solenoid #6/Relay
Air Solenoid #6/Relay
Driver #6
Driver #6
Driver #6
Driver #6
Air Solenoid #8/Relay
Air Solenoid #8/Relay
Air Solenoid #8/Relay
Air Solenoid #8/Relay
Driver #8
Driver #8
Driver #8
Driver #8
Air Solenoid #9/Relay
Air Solenoid #9/Relay
Air Solenoid #9/Relay
Air Solenoid #9/Relay
Driver #9
Driver #9
Driver #9
Driver #9
Air Solenoid #10/Relay Air Solenoid #10/Relay Air Solenoid #10/Relay Air Solenoid #10/Relay
Driver #10
Driver #10
Driver #10
Driver #10
Air Solenoid #4/Relay
Air Solenoid #4/Relay
Air Solenoid #4/Relay
Air Solenoid #4/Relay
Driver #4
Driver #4
Driver #4
Driver #4
Left Plow Lights Relay
Left Plow Lights Relay
Left Plow Lights Relay
Left Plow Lights Relay
Air Solenoid #2/Relay
Air Solenoid #2/Relay
Air Solenoid #2/Relay
Air Solenoid #2/Relay
Driver #2
Driver #2
Driver #2
Driver #2
Fuel Pump Transfer
Fuel Pump Transfer
Fuel Pump Transfer
Fuel Pump Transfer
Particulate Trap Indicator Particulate Trap Indicator Particulate Trap Indicator Particulate Trap Indicator
Trailer Left Turn Signal Trailer Left Turn Signal
(Tractor or Body Builder (Tractor or Body Builder Body Builder Left Turn Body Builder Left Turn
Lighting)/Air Solenoid Signal/Air Solenoid #16/ Signal/Air Solenoid #16/
Lighting)/Air Solenoid
Relay Driver #16
Relay Driver #16
#16 (Truck)/Relay Driver #16 (Truck)/Relay Driver
#16
#16
Trailer Marker Lights
Trailer Marker Lights
Body Builder Marker
Body Builder Marker
(Tractor or Body Builder (Tractor or Body Builder
Lighting)/Air Solenoid Lights/Air Solenoid #15/ Lights/Air Solenoid #15/
Lighting)/Air Solenoid
Relay Driver #15
Relay Driver #15
#15 (Truck)/Relay Driver #15 (Truck)/Relay Driver
#15
#15
Trailer or Body Builder Trailer or Body Builder Trailer or Body Builder Trailer or Body Builder
Stop Lights
Stop Lights
Stop Lights
Stop Lights
Exhaust System High
Exhaust System High
Exhaust System High
Exhaust System High
Temperature Indicator
Temperature Indicator
Temperature Indicator
Temperature Indicator
NOTE: All outputs will handle up to a 500 mAmp load unless stated otherwise.
NOTE: Circuits labeled Gnd Active", 12v Active", or 5v Active are open circuit until active.
NOTE: For Air Solenoid/Relay Driver wiring see the Air Solenoid section of this manual or consult the
applicable circuit diagram manual.
October 2012
SECTION 06 - PAGE 5
BODY CONTROLLER
No connections or splices are allowable on any signals that are highlighted in bold italic.
*Ampere
BC CONNECTOR J5 (1602)
BC Connector J5 (1602)
f_018
Table 15
#1602 In-Cab
32-Way Connector
Pin
Pin
E1
E2
E3
E4
E5
E6
E7
E8
E9
E10
E11
E12
E13
E14
E15
E16*
F1
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
Type
Air Chassis
Pin Description
Automatic
Manual Transmission
Transmission
Type
Automatic Transmission Manual Transmission
Automatic
Manual Transmission
Transmission
Input/Output
Switch Datalink
Switch Datalink
Switch Datalink
Switch Datalink
Input/Output
Switch Datalink +
Switch Datalink +
Switch Datalink +
Switch Datalink +
Reference
ZVR (1)
ZVR (1)
ZVR (1)
ZVR (1)
Output
+5V Output (A)
+5V Output (A)
+5V Output (A)
+5V Output (A)
Reference
ZVR (2)
ZVR (2)
ZVR (2)
ZVR (2)
Output
+5V Output (B)
+5V Output (B)
+5V Output (B)
+5V Output (B)
Reference
ZVR (3)
ZVR (3)
ZVR (3)
ZVR (3)
Output
+5V Output (C)
+5V Output (C)
+5V Output (C)
+5V Output (C)
Input (Gnd Active)
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
Input (Gnd Active)
Open
Open
Open
Open
Input (Gnd Active)
Headlight Enable
Headlight Enable
Headlight Enable
Headlight Enable
Air Horn Solenoid/Air
Air Horn Solenoid/Air
Air Horn Solenoid/Air
Air Horn Solenoid/Air
Input/Output
Solenoid #1/Relay Driver Solenoid #1/Relay Driver Solenoid #1/Relay Driver Solenoid #1/Relay Driver
#1
#1
#1
#1
Input/Output
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
Input (Gnd Active)
Brake Switch Input
Brake Switch Input
Brake Switch Input
Brake Switch Input
Input (Gnd Active)
Brake Switch Input
Brake Switch Input
Brake Switch Input
Brake Switch Input
GND
AC Coupled GND
AC Coupled GND
AC Coupled GND
AC Coupled GND
Input (Gnd Active)
J1939 Shield Datalink
J1939 Shield Datalink
J1939 Shield Datalink
J1939 Shield Datalink
Input/Output
J1939 Datalink
J1939 Datalink
J1939 Datalink
J1939 Datalink
Input/Output
J1939+ Datalink
J1939+ Datalink
J1939+ Datalink
J1939+ Datalink
Input (Gnd Active)
J1939 Shield Datalink
J1939 Shield Datalink
J1939 Shield Datalink
J1939 Shield Datalink
Input/Output
J1939 Datalink
J1939 Datalink
J1939 Datalink
J1939 Datalink
Input/Output
J1939+ Datalink
J1939+ Datalink
J1939+ Datalink
J1939+ Datalink
SECTION 06 - PAGE 6
October 2012
BODY CONTROLLER
#1602 In-Cab
32-Way Connector
Pin
F7
F8
F9
F10
F11
F12
F13
F14
F15
F16
Type
Air Chassis
Pin Description
Automatic Transmission Manual Transmission
N/A
N/A
Air Horn Switch Input
Air Horn Switch Input
Seat Belt Alarm Input
Seat Belt Alarm Input
Backup Light State OR
Backup Light State OR
Electric Trailer Brake
Input (Gnd Active)
Electric Trailer Brake
Controller Input
Controller Input
MD: Hood Switch Input for Two Speed Axle Switch
Open
Input (Gnd Active)
HEV
Input
Input (Gnd Active)
TEM Aux Input 2
TEM Aux Input 2
TEM Aux Input 2
MD: N/A
MD: N/A
MD: N/A
SS: Variable Speed
SS: Variable Speed
Input (Gnd Active)
SS: Variable Speed
Engine Fan
Engine Fan
Engine Fan
Input (Gnd Active)
TEM Aux Input 1
TEM Aux Input 1
TEM Aux Input 1
TEM Remote Start/Stop TEM Remote Start/Stop TEM Remote Start/Stop
Input (Gnd Active)
Switch Input
Switch Input
Switch Input
MD: SAAR Input
Input (Gnd Active) SS: Single Speed T-Case SS: Single Speed T-Case
MD: SAAR Input
Motion Sensor
Motion Sensor
Input (Gnd Active)
Input (Gnd Active)
Manual Transmission
N/A
Air Horn Switch Input
Seat Belt Alarm Input
Backup Light State OR
Electric Trailer Brake
Controller Input
Two Speed Axle Switch
Input
TEM Aux Input 2
MD: N/A
SS: Variable Speed
Engine Fan
TEM Aux Input 1
TEM Remote Start/Stop
Switch Input
MD: SAAR Input
The circuit attached to pin E16 should NOT have additional connections or splices added on a hydraulic
chassis.
NOTE: All outputs will handle up to a 500 mAmp load unless stated otherwise.
NOTE: Circuits labeled Gnd Active", 12v Active", or 5v Active are open circuit until active.
NOTE: For Air Solenoid/Relay Driver wiring see the Air Solenoid section of this manual or consult the
applicable circuit diagram manual.
No connections or splices are allowable on any signals that are highlighted in bold italic.
October 2012
SECTION 06 - PAGE 7
BODY CONTROLLER
BC CONNECTOR J1 (1603)
BC Connector J1 (1603)
f_019
Table 16
#1603 In-Cab
12-Way Connector
Signal Description
Pin
Type
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
J
K
L
M
10 AMP FET*
10 AMP FET
10 AMP FET
10 AMP FET
12 AMP FET
10 AMP FET
10 AMP FET
10 AMP FET
10 AMP FET
10 AMP FET
10 AMP FET
10 AMP FET
SECTION 06 - PAGE 8
October 2012
BODY CONTROLLER
BC CONNECTOR J2 (1604)
BC Connector J1 (1603)
f_020
Table 17
#1604 In-Cab
10-Way Connector
Signal Description
Pin
Type
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
J
K
20 AMP FET
10 AMP FET
10 AMP FET
10 AMP FET
10 AMP FET
10 AMP FET
10 AMP FET
10 AMP FET
10 AMP FET
October 2012
SECTION 06 - PAGE 9
BODY CONTROLLER
SECTION 06 - PAGE 10
October 2012
WIRING INFORMATION
Battery Connections
October 2012
f_021
SECTION 07 - PAGE 1
f_022
Max. Current
Terminal Size
Nut Torque
Special
Number
(Amperes)
20
5/16
12 Nm/9 lbf-ft
3/8
15 Nm/11 lbf-ft
**
Description
Location
Instructions
Mega-Fuse Stud, Outside Dash Panel,
Fused Side*
Drivers Side
Positive Battery
Battery Box
Terminal*
* Additional in-line fuse of appropriate size must be added for circuit being added. Fuse should be located
close to power source.
Special Instructions
**Circuits should not be connected to the battery if vehicle is equipped with sealed battery terminals.
NOTE: Do not use starter stud for battery power, as extra terminals may cause nut to loosen.
SECTION 07 - PAGE 2
October 2012
f_023
Color
Number
Max. Current
Special
(Amps)
Instructions
Description
Location
A14G
Red
15
A13B
Pink
Inside Cab,
Passenger Side
Inside Cab,
Passenger Side
Special Instructions
a. Circuit A14G circuit protected by a 15 AMP fuse in fuse block. A relay is required if the battery load
exceeds 15 AMPS.
b. Circuit A13B circuit protected by a 5 AMP fuse in fuse block. A relay is required if the battery load exceeds
5 AMPS.
October 2012
SECTION 07 - PAGE 3
TESTING
For Battery taps, test to see that battery voltage is present at all times.
For Accessory taps, test to see that battery voltage is present when the IGN key is in Accessory or IGN
key states
For IGN taps, test to see that battery voltage is present when the IGN key is in IGN key state.
HEADLIGHTS ON W/WIPERS
08WRB
HEADLIGHTS ON W/WIPERS Headlights Will Automatically Turn on if Windshield Wipers are turned on. There
are two functions, Lights On With Wipers (LOWW) and Day Time Running Lights (DTRL), available with this
sales code.
Function (LOWW): The Lights On With Wipers (LOWW) function turns on the low beam headlights (tail, marker
& clearance lights are also turned on with low beam headlights) whenever the windshield wipers are ON steady
or intermittent. The headlights will not be enabled in washer mode. When the wipers are turned OFF, headlights
will remain ON until the key is turned OFF or the headlight switch is cycled from OFF to ON to OFF.
Function (DTRL): The Day Time Running Lights (DTRL) function will turn on low beam headlights at 75% of
normal brightness whenever the key is in the RUN position and the Park Brake is OFF.
Both features may be enabled or disabled by using Diamond Logic Builder programming software.
NOTE: DTRL is required by law for Canadian registered vehicles and the feature must not be disabled.
SECTION 07 - PAGE 4
October 2012
ID
Lights_on_with
_Wipers
317
DTRL_Enabled
188
Description
Activate/Deactivate headlights on with wipers. A
value of 1 enables and a value of 0 disables this
feature.
Activate/deactivate daytime running lights. A
value of 1 enables and a value of 0 disables this
feature.
Default
Units
Min
Max
Step
Off
On/Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
On
On/Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
WIRING INFORMATION
None
TESTING
1. If LOWW is wanted to be activated on the vehicle, check the parameter box for Lights_on_with_Wipers and
program the Body Controller.
2. Turn on the wipers (Steady or Intermittent) and verify that the low beam headlights, tail, marker and/or
clearance lights are turned on.
3. Turn off the wipers and verify that the above lights are OFF.
October 2012
SECTION 07 - PAGE 5
f_024
WIRING INFORMATION
No additional wiring is necessary if the vehicle is ordered from International with the sales feature codes listed
above.
TESTING
1. Close switch.
2. Verify that the vehicle is providing 12-14 Volts to the starter motor.
3. Verify vehicle will start.
4. Turn engine off.
5. Open disconnect switch.
6. Verify vehicle systems do not have any electrical power.
SECTION 07 - PAGE 6
October 2012
Installation Circuit for Battery Disconnect Switch (not 08WJT, 08WJU, 08WJV
or 08WJW)
f_025
NOTE: If there is more than one positive cable, eyelet terminals will have to be stacked on the switch stud.
Some installations may not have GND strap to rail if none exists, there is no need to add one.
October 2012
SECTION 07 - PAGE 7
Green Battery On
Indicator Light
SECTION 07 - PAGE 8
October 2012
f_026
CB RADIOS
Refer to the Circuit Diagram Manual S08322, Chapter 4, Cab Accessories, CB Power Radio.
08RCB
CB RADIO Accommodation Package; Header Mounted; Feeds From Accessory Side of Ignition (IGN) Switch;
Includes Power Source and Two Antenna Bases with Wiring
When installing a CB radio, this feature provides the power circuits required for hook-up. This
accommodation package includes a two-way connector with 10 Ampere (AMP) accessory power feed and
cab Ground (GND), dual CB antenna cables routed from the mirrors to the cab overhead console panel
opening, and two CB antenna mounts located at the top of each mirror. A strap is also provided in the header
to mount the customer-supplied CB radio. The CB antennas are not provided with this code. If the two
antennas are desired, an additional feature code 08RBK must be ordered.
08RBK
CB ANTENNA (2) {Pana-Pacific} Full Wave; 4.0 Length Includes International Name on Top
Provides two 4 long CB antennas.
WIRING INFORMATION
Locations for connecting to the vehicle IGN and cab GND have been provided. The table below lists the
connection point along with information about that point. For a complete diagram of the IGN system and for
connector and terminal part numbers, see vehicle circuit diagram manual.
Table 20
Feature Codes
Power Feed
08RCB
10
Accessory
Description
CB Radio Accommodation Package
(Includes 2 Antenna Bases and Cable)
The mating connector for the CB connector is 1661196C1 and terminal 1661209C1 (16 gauge).
TESTING
To test these circuits, refer to the above chart and verify that battery voltage is present in the correct key-state
for each respective feature.
October 2012
SECTION 08 - PAGE 1
2-WAY RADIOS
Refer to the Circuit Diagram Manual S08322, Chapter 4, Cab Accessories, 2-Way Radio.
08REA
2-WAY RADIO Wiring Effects; Wiring With 20 AMP Fuse Protection, Includes IGN Wire With 5 AMP Fuse, Wire
Ends Heat Shrink and 10 Coil Taped to Base Harness
Feature code 08REA provides a fused 20 AMP battery feed power wire, GND wire and fused 5 AMP IGN
feed for applications requiring twoway radio communications such as local municipal government units or
state DOT highway maintenance vehicles. The three wires are taped to the main cab harness.
08RGA
2-WAY RADIO Wiring Effects; Wiring With 20 AMP Fuse Protection, Includes IGN Wire with 5 AMP Fuse, Wire
Ends Heat Shrink and Routed to Center of Header Console in Cab
Feature code 08RGA provides a fused 20 AMP battery feed power wire, GND wire and fused 5 AMP IGN
feed for applications requiring twoway radio communications such as local municipal government units or
state DOT highway maintenance vehicles. The three wires are located in the center of the header console in
the cab.
WIRING INFORMATION
Locations for connecting to the vehicle IGN have been provided. The table below lists the connection point
along with information about that point. For a complete diagram of the IGN system and for connector and
terminal part numbers, see vehicle circuit diagram manual.
Table 21
Feature Code
08REA
08RGA
SECTION 08 - PAGE 2
Power Feed
Description
20
5
20
5
Battery
IGN
Battery
IGN
October 2012
f_027
08REA and 08RGA provide radio power and GND directly from the battery to minimize electrical noise on the
line.
The cable is coiled up under the Instrument Panel (IP) as shown above in 08REA, and is of sufficient length to
route to the back of the Travelcrew cab.
The wiring is located in the center of the header console in the cab for 08RGA.
TESTING
To test these circuits, refer to the applicable circuit diagram for the feature and verify that battery voltage is
present in the correct key-state for each respective feature.
October 2012
SECTION 08 - PAGE 3
SECTION 08 - PAGE 4
October 2012
October 2012
SECTION 09 - PAGE 1
f_028
f_029
The International Keyless Entry System uses electronic door pods in the driver and passenger side doors
which also operate the power door locks and the power windows. If equipped with Remote Keyless Entry
(optional code), the memory in the receiver (front passenger door pod) learns the transmitter codes from the
key fobs (transmitters) and only recognizes those which it has learned in the programming process. Each
vehicle's passenger side door pod has the ability to learn up to six transmitter codes allowing the vehicle to be
accessed by six different key fobs. Each key fob has a unique code which can be learned by any number of
RKE equipped vehicles.
The key fob controls the following functions:
Chirp of the horn and doors lock if the lock button is pressed on the key fob.
Autolock function, which automatically locks the doors at a vehicle speed of 15 MPH see details below.
Panic function, button with horn symbol, which chirps the horn on/off in unison with the headlights and park
lights for three minutes when the panic button on the key fob is pressed and the ignition (IGN) switch is off. If
the button is pressed prior to the time out period, the lights, etc. will go off
SECTION 09 - PAGE 2
October 2012
f_030
October 2012
SECTION 09 - PAGE 3
SECTION 09 - PAGE 4
October 2012
PARTS INFORMATION
Replacement key fobs/transmitters can be obtained from Service Parts by ordering part number 3544938C2.
ID
Panic_ Enable
644
Chirp_ Enable
647
Description
Enable/disable the Panic Mode
for the Keyless Remote. A value
of 1 enables and a value of 0
disables the feature.
Enable/disable the remote lock
"chirp" for Keyless Remote. A
value of 1 enables and a value of
0 disables the feature.
Default
Units
Min
Max
Step
On
No_Units
N/A
N/A
N/A
On
No_Units
N/A
N/A
N/A
The AutoLock_Speed parameter sets the vehicle speed at which the vehicle doors will lock automatically.
Table 23
Parameter
AutoLock_
Speed
ID
Description
Default
Units
Min
Max
Step
652
15
mph
155
WIRING INFORMATION
When using the Aux feature, the work light circuit can be used for other features other than a work light - see
Work Light Feature for additional information.
If truck was built with power locks but not the keyless entry, see How Do I Add Work Light Feature.
With the Diamond Logic Builder software, one other system can be activated. For example, the Aux button
could turn on headlights or hazard lamps, not both.
October 2012
SECTION 09 - PAGE 5
f_031
Insert the extraction tools (2) into the two holes on either side of the pod housing until the locking tabs are fully
depressed. The pod can then be removed from the door panel and the extraction tools removed.
f_032
To install the new replacement pod, connect the appropriate connectors and push the pod in until the locking
tabs are fully engaged.
SECTION 09 - PAGE 6
October 2012
Max. Current
Power Feed
Description
Power Source, Two Post-Type
Power Source (Cigar-Type Receptacle)
Cigar Lighter (provides customer with a 15
AMP battery supply)
(Amperes)
08WCK
08718
20
20
Battery
Battery
08518
15
Battery
October 2012
SECTION 10 - PAGE 1
f_033
TESTING
To test these circuits, refer to the applicable circuit diagram for the feature and verify that battery voltage is
present in the correct key-state for each respective feature.
SECTION 10 - PAGE 2
October 2012
PRODUCTIVITY FEATURES
PRODUCTIVITY FEATURES
NOTE: A bad status on any of the external light inputs, park light switch, service brake switch or key state will
also terminate the lamp check sequence.
For feature 595AES, to enable the external lamp check sequence:
NOTE: (Note: A bad status on any of the external light inputs, park light switch, service brake switch or key
state will also terminate the lamp check sequence)
The backup lamp cannot be included within this test since the ESC does not control this lamp's functionality.
The lamp test repeatedly flashes all the lights on in the following sequence. This allows the operator to get
outside the vehicle and verify that all the lights are working properly.
The following sequence is repeated with no delay between the steps; the programmable time parameter (PP)
shall have a default value of two seconds, a minimum of one second, and a maximum of 10 seconds, with
increments of one second. This parameter is set at FLEET access.
October 2012
SECTION 11 - PAGE 1
PRODUCTIVITY FEATURES
Table 25
Sequence Number
Lights Requested On
Time In This
0
1
Sequence
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
PP
PP
PP
PP
PP
PP
PP
PP
PP
PP
PP
f_034
SECTION 11 - PAGE 2
Default
ID#
Description
Settings
2230
The time
between each
step of the
exterior lamp
check
Units
October 2012
Minimum
Maximum
Value
Value
10
STEP
PRODUCTIVITY FEATURES
WIRING INFORMATION
None required.
TESTING
Refer to the FEATURES/BODY FUNCTION section.
ID
Description
Default
Units
Min
Max
Step
1951
60
180
1952
10
60
10
2457
On/Off
WIRING INFORMATION
No additional wiring is required for this feature.
October 2012
SECTION 11 - PAGE 3
PRODUCTIVITY FEATURES
HOW TO ADD THESE FEATURES
This feature is software only and can be added by activating software feature code 595AZV with Diamond
Logic Builder.
ID
Wipers_To_Low_
Int_Enabled
2171
Wipers_To_Low_
Int_Timeout
2228
Description
Default
Units
Min
Max
Step
None
60
10
300
10
WIRING INFORMATION
This feature is software driven.
TESTING
1. Start vehicle and make sure the parking brake is engaged.
2. Turn the windshield wipers on any setting except for the slowest intermittent speed.
3. Leave the wipers on this setting for 60 seconds without adjusting the wiper speed.
4. After 60 seconds, the wipers should slow to the lowest speed.
5. Adjust the wiper speed control.
6. The wiper setting should match the user set speed.
SECTION 11 - PAGE 4
October 2012
PRODUCTIVITY FEATURES
HOW TO ADD THESE FEATURES
Use the Diamond Logic Builder software to install the appropriate software and determine correct settings for
programmable parameters.
ID
Description
Default
Units
Min
Max
Step
562
On
On/Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
WIRING INFORMATION
None required.
TESTING
Stop Override Hazard Disabled:
1. Turn on the Hazard lights and verify normal operation (flashing), front and rear.
2. Depress the brake pedal and verify that both front and rear hazard lights remain flashing.
Stop Override Hazard Enabled:
1. Turn on the Hazard lights and verify normal operation, front and rear.
2. Depress the brake pedal and verify that both rear stoplights are on (not flashing) and that the front hazard
lights remain flashing.
3. Release the brake pedal and verify that normal operation of the flashing hazards resumes at the rear of the
vehicle.
October 2012
SECTION 11 - PAGE 5
PRODUCTIVITY FEATURES
ID
Description
Default
Units
Min
Max
Step
2179
On
On/Off
N/A
WIRING INFORMATION
None required.
TESTING
Exterior_Lamp_Warn Disabled:
SECTION 11 - PAGE 6
October 2012
PRODUCTIVITY FEATURES
WIRING INFORMATION
Refer to the circuit diagram manual chapter 4, pages 39-41 for wiring information.
October 2012
SECTION 11 - PAGE 7
PRODUCTIVITY FEATURES
The Load_Shed _Level_Air_Shield_Lights parameter specifies at what level the air shield lights may be shed or
loaded.
The Load_Shed _Sleeper_Dome_Light parameter specifies at what level the sleeper dome light may be shed
or loaded.
The Load_Shed _Floor_Search_Lights parameter specifies at what level the floor search lights may be shed or
loaded.
The Load_Shed _Level_Skirt_Light parameter specifies at what level the skirt light may be shed or loaded.
The Load_Shed _Level_Fuel_Heater parameter specifies at what level the fuel heater may be shed or loaded.
The Load_Shed _Level_Aux_Trailer_Circuit parameter specifies at what level the auxiliary trailer circuit may be
shed or loaded.
For features 595AMU or 595ABR: Table 78
Parameter
Load_Shed_Level_
Work_Light
ID
Description
Default
Units
Min
Max
Step
2327
List
N/A
N/A
N/A
ID
Description
Default
Units
Min
Max
Step
2360
List
N/A
N/A
N/A
ID
Description
Default
Units
Min
Max
Step
2369
List
N/A
N/A
N/A
ID
Description
Default
Units
Min
Max
Step
511
List
N/A
N/A
N/A
SECTION 11 - PAGE 8
ID
Description
Default
Units
Min
Max
Step
2363
List
N/A
N/A
N/A
October 2012
PRODUCTIVITY FEATURES
For features 595AAT or 595ADU: Table 83
Parameter
Load_Shed_Floor_
Search_Lights
ID
Description
Default
Units
Min
Max
Step
2324
List
N/A
N/A
N/A
ID
Description
Default
Units
Min
Max
Step
2370
List
N/A
N/A
N/A
ID
Description
Default
Units
Min
Max
Step
2054
List
N/A
N/A
N/A
ID
Description
Default
Units
Min
Max
Step
601
List
N/A
N/A
N/A
WIRING INFORMATION
No additional wiring is needed.
TESTING
No physical testing is specified for this feature. If there is access to DLB, the signal for Battery Voltage could be
set below 11.8 V to test those features that should be shed at level 1, but it is not recommended that the actual
battery voltage be allowed to drain just to test the feature.
October 2012
SECTION 11 - PAGE 9
PRODUCTIVITY FEATURES
SECTION 11 - PAGE 10
October 2012
FOG/DRIVING LIGHTS
Codes 08585, 08WPL, 08WPM, 08WLM, and 08WLN
Refer to the Circuit Diagram Manual S08322, Chapter 9, Lights, Fog Light and Work Light.
DuraStar
08585
TOGGLE SWITCH, AUXILIARY and Wiring; For Driving Lights or Fog Lights Mounted by Customer
08WPL
FOG LIGHTS (2) Amber, Oval, With H355W Halogen Bulb
08WPM
FOG LIGHTS (2) Clear, Oval, With H355W Halogen Bulb
WorkStar
08585
TOGGLE SWITCH, AUXILIARY and Wiring; For Driving Lights or Fog Lights Mounted by Customer
08WLM
FOG LIGHTS {Peterson} Amber, Halogen, Rectangular
08WLN
FOG LIGHTS {Peterson} Clear, Halogen, Rectangular
Feature codes 08WPL, 08WPM, 08WLM, and 08WLN come with the fog light system (wiring and fog lamps)
completely installed. Feature code 08585 is an accommodation package that comes with wiring and a fog light
connector. Customer must supply the mating connector, terminals, and seals, and must install the fog lamps.
All above features operate as follows: to turn on the fog lamps; the headlamps must be on and in the low beam
position. The lamps will go off if the headlamps are switched to high beam.
October 2012
SECTION 12 - PAGE 1
f_035
f_036
SECTION 12 - PAGE 2
October 2012
f_037
Depending on the other features ordered on the vehicle, the fog light button switch could also be located on the
left of the steering column under the instrument cluster.
f_038
For the customers who prefer to mount their own lamps, installation integrity is improved with the factory toggle
switch and wiring feature.
October 2012
SECTION 12 - PAGE 3
ID
2309
2310
2311
Description
Default
Units
Min
Max
Step
10
10
0.1
0.5
10
0.1
0.5
10
0.1
2369
List
N/A
N/A
N/A
2312
10
10
2313
0.5
10
2314
0.5
10
WIRING INFORMATION
With feature 08585 and if the vehicle is a 3200, 4200, 4300 or 4400, a thin fog lamp must be used if mounted
in the bumper opening.
The fog lamp connections are located at the front of the frame on each side. See view below.
Care must be taken when adding fog lamps as lamps may have a GND wire and also have a grounded base.
Be sure that the feed circuit, cavity A, the connector at front of frame, is not connected to GND.
Mating connector part number 587568C91
Terminal (16 gauge) part number 587575C1
Seal part number 1652325C1
SECTION 12 - PAGE 4
October 2012
f_039
Thin fog lamps must be used if mounted in the bumper opening of the 3200, 4200, 4300 and 4400 models.
October 2012
f_040
SECTION 12 - PAGE 5
f_041
TESTING
1. Activate fog light switch with the IGN key on and the headlamp switch on the low-beam mode.
2. Verify that pin F (labeled Left_Fog_Light) and pin K (labeled Right_Fog_Light) in DLB located in connector
(#1603 J1) are providing battery voltage.
3. Verify that the fog lights are functioning correctly.
4. Turn the fog light switch OFF.
5. Verify that the fog light output goes OFF.
SECTION 12 - PAGE 6
October 2012
DESCRIPTION
This section addresses installation, switching, and programming of fog lights on International 4200, 4300,
4400, and 8500 trucks.
Table 32 Parts Information
Part Number
Description
Quantity
2507254C91
2507255C91
1
1
Install fog lights using hardware included in the kit. The Figure below shows installation.
October 2012
f_042
SECTION 12 - PAGE 7
f_043
Control Panel
Location 1: Six pack
Location 2: Six Pack
Location 3: Twelve Pack
SECTION 12 - PAGE 8
October 2012
Description
2507255C91
3555568C91
3535162C1
306132C1
3560279C91
3560225C91
3549438C91
3554890C1
3552493C1
3526712C1
3535292C1
30592R1
2507524R1
Part Number
Description
2507254C91
3555569C91
3535162C1
306132C1
3560279C91
3560225C91
3549438C91
3554890C1
3552493C1
3526712C1
3535292C1
30592R1
2507524R1
October 2012
SECTION 12 - PAGE 9
SECTION 12 - PAGE 10
October 2012
f_044
f_045
WIRING INFORMATION
The circuit ratings are as follows: the headlamp hi beam 20 AMP, the headlamp low beam 20 AMP, the left turn
10 AMP, the right turn 10 AMP and the park 15 AMP. Since the auxiliary park and turn current is shared with
vehicle lighting current, make sure the added lighting does not exceed the stated current rating for each circuit.
All circuit protection is internal to the BC (Body Controller).
NOTE: If the plow lights are turned on without the lights being connected, the BC will log a headlamp fault
code.
Table 35 Aux. Connector Circuit Identification
Circuit Number
Cavity
Function
M64HI
M11-GE
M64LO
M56D
M58F
M57D
Plug
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
Hi Beam
GMD
Low Beam
T/S Left
Park
T/S Right
Plug
October 2012
SECTION 12 - PAGE 11
f_046
Quantity
Description
2039312C91
587579C1
2033912C1
589391C1
2039342C1
1
1
6
6
1
The terminals and seals in the above table are for 14-gauge cable.
NOTE: It is suggested that an extra connector (Part # 2039312C91), be completely filled with plugs, which can
be saved and connected to the chassis harness connector when the plowing season is over this procedure
protects against corrosion.
TESTING
1. Activate the plow light switch in the dash using the Diamond Logic Builder software for switch locations.
2. Turn on vehicle park lights.
3. Verify that auxiliary connector Cavity E has battery voltage levels present.
4. Turn ON vehicle headlights to the LOW BEAM position.
5. Verify that auxiliary connector Cavity C has battery voltage levels present.
6. Turn vehicle headlights to the HIGH BEAM position.
VERIFY THAT AUXILIARY CONNECTOR CAVITY A HAS BATTERY VOLTAGE LEVELS PRESENT.
1. Turn on vehicle left turn signal.
2. Verify that auxiliary connector Cavity D has intermittent voltage levels present.
3. Turn on vehicle right turn signal.
4. Verify that auxiliary connector Cavity F has intermittent voltage levels present.
5. Turn off the plow light switch.
6. Verify all vehicle lights are operating correctly.
SECTION 12 - PAGE 12
October 2012
WIRING INFORMATION
Refer to the Circuit Diagram Manual S08322, Chapter 9, Lights, Light System Marker, Park, Tail, Turn, and
Stop Lights.
Table 37 Connector Cavity Information and Parts Required
Connector
P/N
1661778C1
Cavity
A
B
Circuit #
Left Side
Right Side
M58H
M58-GA
M58J
M58-GB
Gauge
Term
Part Number
Seal
Part Number
16
16
1661875C1
1661875C1
1661872C1
1661872C1
TESTING
1. Turn the Headlight switch to PARK position and verify that both right and left guide post lights are on.
2. Turn the Headlight switch to ON position and verify that both right and left guide post lights are on.
October 2012
SECTION 12 - PAGE 13
This parameter specifies the Wig Wag pattern for the headlights. The following table indicates the pattern and
timing for the headlights.
Table 38
Setting
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
Daytime_Running_Lights_Disable
This parameter (Daytime_Running_Lights_Disable), when set ON provides the capability to disable the
daytime running lights when the Wig Wag is ON.
SECTION 12 - PAGE 14
October 2012
ID
Description
Default
Units
Min
Max
Step
2629
Determines method of
flashing for the wig wag
headlights
Number
13
Non-Emergency Vehicle
REQUIRED SOFTWARE FEATURE CODE FOR 60AKL
595BLP
ID
Daytime_Running_Lights
_Disable
2630
Wig_Wag_Cad
2629
Description
Provides the ability to disable
the daytime running light during
wig wag
Determines method of flashing
for the wig wag headlights
Default
Units
Min
Max
Step
Off
On/Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Number
13
WIRING INFORMATION
Wig Wag switch is located in one of the multiplex switch housings.
f_047
October 2012
SECTION 12 - PAGE 15
Set Wig_Wag_Cad parameter to desired pattern using the Diamond Logic Builder software, or see a dealer.
60AKL (Wig Wag for Non-Emergency Vehicles)
Set Wig_Wag_Cad parameter to desired pattern using the Diamond Logic Builder software, or see a dealer.
Turn on Daytime_Running_Light_Disable, if desired using the Diamond Logic Builder software, or see a
dealer.
SECTION 12 - PAGE 16
October 2012
STOP/TURN/TAIL
International provides standard rear stop and turn signal lights on every vehicle. If the Body Builder or TEM
needs to add different rear light configurations, such as separate stop and rear turn signals, various methods
are offered to tap into the tail light circuits. The first and most common way is to use the standard sealed tail
light 5-way Packard connector to provide lighting circuits for body-mounted lights that need combined stop and
rear turn signals. It is recommended that a sealed mating connector and terminals be used to attach body
wiring to the vehicle wiring. If the existing rear lighting is used and a marker or identification light feed is
needed, International recommends using the 5-way connector on the driver side rear tail light. Other optional
methods for adding various light configurations are available (feature codes 08HAA, 08HAB, and 08NAA).
A feed terminal for body marker lights is provided in "terminal D" position on the left tail lamp. To wire body
lights, Body Builders are to attach a terminal (International part number 2033816C1 or Packard Electric part
number 12129493) and seal (International part number 589391C1 or Packard Electric part number 12015193)
to the body feed cable. The cable can then be snapped into the empty cavity of the existing 5-way connector
(Note: if a splice is absolutely necessary, use heat shrink tubing with proper wire).
To connect to the tail light wiring harness, instead of using the OEM tail lights, use International connector
1677851C1 or Packard Electric P12186400. Be sure to use a terminal plug in any unused cavities in the
connector body. Alternately, order feature code 08NAA which includes separate wiring for standard left and
right tail lights with 8' of extra cable for extending tail light wiring and separate wiring for left and right
body-mounted tail lights.
The standard tail light connectors are located at the lights mounted to both the driver and passenger sides of
the frame rail at the rear.
WIRING INFORMATION
There is an unused cavity in the left rear tail lamp connector that can be used to provide tail, marker and
clearance power. Remove the connector from the lamp and remove the cavity seal. Terminate added circuit
with terminal and seal below, and insert into cavity D.
Table 41
Parts
Part Numbers
2033816C1
589390C1
NOTE: Circuit is protected internally by the Body Controller (BC) at 15 Amperes (AMPS). If current is close to
or exceeds 15 AMPS, a relay must be added.
October 2012
SECTION 13 - PAGE 1
Part Numbers
Connector
1677851C1
1687848C1 10 Gauge
2033912C1 12-14 Gauge
1677914C1
0589390C1 10-12 Gauge
0589391C1 14-16 Gauge
Terminal
Lock
Seal
SECTION 13 - PAGE 2
October 2012
f_048
f_049
ID
Description
1910
1911
1912
1913
1914
1915
Default
Units
Min
Max
Step
0.5
10
0.1
10
10
0.1
0.5
10
0.1
0.5
10
0.1
10
10
0.1
0.5
10
0.1
WIRING INFORMATION
08HAA gives 7 wires located at EOF that are blunt-cut.
Table 44 08HAA
Cavity
Circuit Number
Maximum Current
Description
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
R70
R68
R94
R58
R56
R57
R10
30 A
20 A
30 A
20 A
15 A
15 A
N/A
Stop Lights
Park Lights
IGN Feed
Identification Lights
Left Turn
Right Turn
GND
Fused by
F7-D
F3-B
F8-D
F3-D
F2-A
F2-C
F4-E4
D2-C2
F4-E4
D4-C4
F1-E1
F3-E3
Connector pinout is labeled as Trailer Socket (9734) connector in Circuit Diagram Manual S08322, Chapter 10,
Chassis Accessories, Body Builder and Trailer Socket BOC and EOF. The connector itself is not supplied,
and wires are blunt-cut.
October 2012
SECTION 13 - PAGE 3
f_050
TESTING
WARNING: To avoid property damage, personal injury or death, park the vehicle on a level surface, set the
parking brake, chock the wheels and turn the engine off.
1. Turn on vehicle headlights.
2. Verify that the taillight circuit (# R68) has battery voltage levels present.
3. Verify that the marker light circuit (# R58) has battery voltage levels present.
4. Turn off vehicle headlights.
5. Turn on left turn signal in vehicle.
6. Verify that left turn circuit (# R56) is cycling between battery voltage and GND.
7. Turn off vehicle left turn signal.
8. Turn on right turn signal in vehicle.
9. Verify that right turn circuit (# R57) is cycling between battery voltage and GND.
10. Turn off vehicle left turn signal.
11. Put the vehicle in reverse.
12. Turn the key to the accessory or IGN position.
13. Verify that the IGN circuit (# R94) has battery voltage levels present.
14. Press the vehicle brake pedal.
15. Verify that the stop circuit (# R70) has battery voltage levels present.
16. Release brake pedal.
CIRCUIT DIAGRAM
See Circuit Diagram Manual S08322, Chapter 10, Chassis Accessories, Body Builder and Trailer Socket
BOC and EOF.
SECTION 13 - PAGE 4
October 2012
October 2012
SECTION 13 - PAGE 5
ID
Description
LT_FT_Turn_
Lo_Current
1910
LT_FT_Turn_
Hi_Current
1911
LT_FT_Turn_
OC_Current
1912
RT_FT_Turn_
Lo_Current
1913
RT_FT_Turn_
Hi_Current
1914
RT_FT_Turn_
OC_Current
1915
Default
Units
Min
Max
Step
0.5
10
0.1
10
10
0.1
0.5
10
0.1
0.5
10
0.1
10
10
0.1
0.5
10
0.1
WIRING INFORMATION
08HAB: Connectors are located inside the drivers side frame rail at the BOC.
08HAE: Connectors are located inside the drivers side frame rail at the EOF.
08HAU: Connectors are located inside the cab.
Cavity
Gauge
Color
Description
N68BB
N56BB
N57BB
N54BB
N71BB
N12BB
N11-GD
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
14
16
16
14
16
14
12
Brown
Yellow
Light Green
Brown
Light Blue
Light Blue
White
Tail Light
Left Turn Light
Right Turn Light
Marker Light
Back-up Light
Accessory Feed
GND
Fuse Rating
Available
(Amps)
Current (Amps)
20
10
10
20
10
20
--
20
8
8
20
6
20
--
SECTION 13 - PAGE 6
Description
Chassis Harness
2039311C91
2039344C1
3535486C1
2039343C1
October 2012
1687848C1
2033912C1
2033911C1
Cavity
Gauge
Color
Description
Fuse Rating
Available
N56BC
N57BC
N70BB
16
Orange
(Amps)
10
Current (Amps)
6
16
Orange
10
14
Orange
Stop Light
15
15
Chassis Harness
1686834C1
3553961C1
1664408C1
589391C1
1652325C1
2033816C1
2033819C1
October 2012
2033912C1
2033911C1
f_051
SECTION 13 - PAGE 7
f_052
f_053
SECTION 13 - PAGE 8
October 2012
October 2012
SECTION 13 - PAGE 9
SECTION 13 - PAGE 10
October 2012
WIRING INFORMATION
The extra harness length for code 08NAA is coiled at the EOF on both the right and left frame rail per view
below. The loose harness connector is covered with a sealed connector. If standard tail lights are being
removed, use sealing cap to protect open connector.
If a harness is to be connected to the OEM connector, see below for parts requirements. The part number for
the 08NAA extension harness is 3547275C91.
October 2012
SECTION 13 - PAGE 11
A
B
C
D
E
S71H
S68F
S56E
Plug
S10-GF
Back up
Tail
Stop/Turn
-GND
2033911C1
2033911C1
2033911C1
2033911C1
2033911C1
589391C1
589391C1
589391C1
589391C1
589391C1
A
B
C
D
E
S71G
S68G
S57E
Plug
S10-GE
Back up
Tail
Stop/Turn
-GND
2033911C1
2033911C1
2033911C1
2033911C1
2033911C1
589391C1
589391C1
589391C1
589391C1
589391C1
f_054
SECTION 13 - PAGE 12
October 2012
WIRING INFORMATION
A 6 extension of the center chassis harness, part number 3560971C91, is provided for Beverage Body
Applications. A 24-pin connector is provided at the end of the extension.
f_055
October 2012
SECTION 13 - PAGE 13
WIRING INFORMATION
The wiring inside back of cab includes both GND and feed circuits, and the circuits are terminated to a two pin
connector. The GND circuit is white, and the Ign12V feed is orange.
Connector Part Number: 0587568C91
Connector ref # 1872F
f_056
This switch is hard wired and there are no multiplex circuits associated with this feature. NOTE - This feature
does depend on IGNITION key position, and can not be turned on with the key off.
SECTION 13 - PAGE 14
October 2012
TESTING
1. Turn on ignition switch.
2. Verify that the added feature operates.
3. Verify that the feed wire is receiving battery voltage.
October 2012
SECTION 13 - PAGE 15
ID
1911
1910
1912
1914
1913
1915
Description
Left front turn signal high current
detection level (AMPS)
Left front turn signal low current
detection level (AMPS)
Left front turn signal open circuit
detection level (AMPS)
Right front turn signal high
current detection level (AMPS)
Right front turn signal low current
detection level (AMPS)
Right front turn signal open circuit
detection level (AMPS)
Default
Units
Min
Step
Max
10
10
0.1
0.5
10
0.1
0.5
10
0.1
10
10
0.1
0.5
10
0.1
0.5
10
0.1
WIRING INFORMATION
For circuit installation, see Circuit Diagram Manual S08322, Chapter 10, Chassis Accessories, Electric Trailer
Brake.
The circuit colors/function to the electric brake controller are as follows:
Table 53
Circuit
Wire Color
Wire Gauge
Black
Red
Grey
White
12
16
10
16
08HAG and 08HAH provides seven blunt-cut wires located at end of frame and four blunt-cut wires located
under cab IP.
The following are the wires for the circuits found in the blunt-cut wires located at the end of the frame.
Table 54
Circuit Number
Maximum
Description/Labeled
Color
Current
08HAG and 08HAH Label Number (Connector 9724)
R70
R68
R94
R58
R10
30 A
20 A
30 A
20 A
N/A
Stop Lights
Park Lights
Trailer Brake
Identification Lights
GND
Red
Brown
Grey
Brown
White
15 A
15 A
Left Turn
Right Turn
Yellow
Light Green
15 A
15 A
Left/Stop Turn
Right/Stop Turn
Yellow
Light Green
SECTION 13 - PAGE 16
-30 A
15 A
20 A
GND Signal
Power Supply Signal
Stop Lights
Elec Brake Signal
October 2012
White
Black
Red
Dark Blue
f_057
F_050
NOTE: Many trailers combine trailer marker lamps with the tail lamp. If this has been done, leave the black
circuit covered with the heat shrink tube.
October 2012
SECTION 13 - PAGE 17
TRAILER SOCKETS
Refer to Circuit Diagram Manual S08322, Chapter 10, Chassis Accessories, Body Builder and Trailer Socket
BOC and EOF.
08TME
TRAILER CONNECTION SOCKET 7-Way; Mounted at EOF, Wired for Turn Signals Independent of Stop,
Compatible with Trailers That Have Amber or Side Lamps
08TMG
TRAILER CONNECTION SOCKET 7-Way; Mounted at EOF, Wired for Turn Signals Combines With Stop,
Compatible With Trailers That Use Combined Stop, Tail, Turn Lamps
These features are used to connect trailer lighting circuits to the vehicle. These options are for providing
separate and combined stop and turn signals and are located at the EOF. These 7-way sockets provide
IGN-controlled fused 30 AMP center pins for trailer Antilock Brake Systems (ABS). Feature 08TMG is designed
for trailers with combined stop and turn lamps. With all trailer connection features, the socket is a standard SAE
recommended socket used in the trucking industry. The circuit arrangement in the socket is also the same as
SAE recommendation, except for 08TMG which has no separate stop circuit.
SECTION 13 - PAGE 18
October 2012
ID
1910
1911
1912
1913
1914
1915
Description
Park and ID Lights Low Current
Detection Level (Amps)
Park and ID Lights High Current
Detection Level (Amps)
Park and ID Lights Open Circuit
Detection Level (Amps)
Park and ID Lights Low Current
Detection Level (Amps)
Park and ID Lights High Current
Detection Level (Amps)
Park and ID Lights Open Circuit
Detection Level (AMPS)
Default
Units
Min
Max
Step
0.5
10
0.1
10
10
0.1
0.5
10
0.1
0.5
10
0.1
10
10
0.1
0.5
10
0.1
WIRING INFORMATION
A 7-Way Trailer socket is provided at the end of the drivers side frame rail.
f_058
October 2012
SECTION 13 - PAGE 19
Fused
Available Current
Color
GND
Tail Lamp
Right Turn
Left Turn
Marker
Stop
Center Pin
-20
15
15
20
30
30
-20
15
15
20
30
30
White
Brown
Green
Yellow
Black
Red
Blue
Circuit Description
Fused
Available Current
Color
GND
Tail Lamp
Right Turn
Left Turn
Marker
Stop
Center Pin
-20
15
15
20
-30
-20
15
15
20
Not Provided
30
White
Brown
Green
Yellow
Black
-Blue
TESTING
08TME
SECTION 13 - PAGE 20
October 2012
October 2012
SECTION 13 - PAGE 21
SECTION 13 - PAGE 22
October 2012
Tractor
08WLL
WORK LIGHT; Pedestal Mounted With Switch on Instrument Panel
08WAA
WORK LIGHT; Pedestal Mounted With Switch on Instrument Panel (Truck Lite 81 Series)
Straight Truck
08WMA
WORK LIGHT TOGGLE SWITCH, on Instrument Panel and Wiring Effects for Customer Furnished Back of
Cab Light
08WXN
WORK LIGHT (2) (Grote) 60 Series, Mounted Under Hood One Each Side
With the International-installed work light (08WLL, 08WAA), nighttime trailer hook-ups are made easier with a
work light mounted at the Back of Cab (BOC) on tractors. This light illuminates the fifth wheel area of the
vehicle. Both features include a switch in the Instrument Panel (IP), or 08WMA can also come with a push
button switch located below the instrument cluster. Either switch will illuminate when the switch is on. These
features provide an out-of-cab load on pin G of the Body Controller (BC) connector #1603. The feature without
the light (08WMA) can be used to satisfy any number of electrical needs for vehicles with straight truck brakes
(4091) such as lights inside dry van boxes, small pumps, and illumination to aid in various job functions.
If the engine is off, there is a time out feature, which is factory set at 120 minutes. The time out period can be
changed through the Diamond Logic Builder software (see local dealer if not owned). If the vehicle is running,
the work light will not time out after 120 minutes. If the work light is left on when the vehicle is moving, the green
indicator light in the work light switch will flash.
f_059
October 2012
SECTION 14 - PAGE 1
f_060
f_061
595ABR or
595AMU Switch located below the instrument cluster in position B and
595AJE
08WXN:
SECTION 14 - PAGE 2
October 2012
Work_Light_
Lo_Current
Work_Light_
Hi_Current
Work_Light_
OC_Current
Load_Shed_
Level _Work_
Light
Work_Light_Off_
Speed
ID
Description
Default
Units
Min
Max
Step
120
Min
10
1440
10
10
0.1
10
10
0.1
10
0.1
List
2568
90
Mph
90
WIRING INFORMATION
The maximum current load for the work light/aux light is 10 AMPS. The circuit protection is internal to the Body
Controller (BC).
Table 59 Parts Required to Connect to Work Light Cable
Connector Part #
Lock Part #
Term Part #
Seal Part #
1661778C1
1661874C1
1661875C1
1661872C1
Circuit Number
Circuit Description
A
B
N65
N65-G
October 2012
SECTION 14 - PAGE 3
SECTION 14 - PAGE 4
October 2012
f_062
f_063
WIRING INFORMATION
A blunt-cut wire (light green) taped back to the dash harness near the megafuse is provided for customer
interface to this circuit. The battery feed to this wire is through a relay that is enabled by a 12V signal from the
Body Controller (BC) connector 1601 pin E5 when the switch is activated.
October 2012
SECTION 14 - PAGE 5
f_064
TESTING
To test this circuit, verify that battery voltage is present at the wire provided when the in-cab switch is activated
with the IGN key in the on or accessory position. The green indicator in the rocker switch shall be illuminated
when the output is on.
WIRING INFORMATION
The wiring in the roof includes both GND and feed circuits, and the circuits are blunt-cut covered with a heat
shrink sleeve. The GND circuit is white, and the feed is brown.
Switch Part Number: 3557932C1
Switch Label: "Roof Aux"
SECTION 14 - PAGE 6
October 2012
View of the Right Pillar and Roof Area, Viewed From Inside Vehicle
f_065
f_066
This switch is hard wired and there are no multiplex circuits associated with this feature. The switch is lighted
to give an ON indication.
NOTE: This feature does not depend on any IGN key position, and can be turned on with the key off. Care
must be taken as leaving the switch on may discharge the batteries.
October 2012
SECTION 14 - PAGE 7
TESTING
1. Turn on in-cab switch.
2. Verify that the added feature operates.
3. Verify that the feed wire is receiving battery voltage.
SECTION 14 - PAGE 8
October 2012
IN-CAB LIGHTING
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM 12-Volt, Standard Equipment
This standard connection provides a fused connection point (5 AMPS maximum for all circuits connected to this
point) to allow auxiliary lights to be dimmed as the panel lights are dimmed.
This circuit utilizes a Pulse Width Modulated (PWM) signal. Do not connect a relay coil to it.
WIRING INFORMATION
The connection is located under the instrument panel left of the interior fuse panel.
f_067
To connect to this circuit, remove the lock from the wire side of the bus bar connector and insert the added wire
with terminal (terminal part number 1661208C1) on an unused connection point.
NOTE: The cover opposite the wires should also be removed to verify that the new connection is properly
seated.
Re-install the cover and lock.
TESTING
Check that the added circuit properly dims when the panel dimmer switch is activated with the headlamp switch
in the PARK or ON position.
October 2012
SECTION 14 - PAGE 9
ID
LOWW_
Enabled
317
DTRL_ Enabled
(See Note)
188
Description
Activate/Deactivate headlights on
with wipers. A value of 1 enables
and a value of 0 disables this
feature.
Activate/Deactivate day time
running lights. A value of 1
enables and a value of 0 disables
this feature.
Default
Units
Min
Max
Step
Off
On/Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
On
On/Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
WIRING INFORMATION
None required.
TESTING
LOWW
1. Turn on wipers (to the low speed) with IGN switch in run position.
2. Verify that the low beam headlights (and tail, marker and clearance lights) are on.
3. Turn on wipers (intermittent) with IGN in Run position.
4. Verify low beam headlights are on.
5. Turn off wipers and verify headlights remain on.
6. Cycle the Headlight switch and verify that headlights are off.
DTRL
1. Set the IGN switch to run with the park brake off.
2. Verify that low beam headlights are on.
SECTION 14 - PAGE 10
October 2012
1. Activate the LOWW_Enabled parameter using the Diamond Logic Builder software, or see a dealer.
DTRL
2. Go to your local dealer and have them enable the DTRL_Enabled parameter with their version of the
Diamond Logic Builder software.
October 2012
SECTION 14 - PAGE 11
SECTION 14 - PAGE 12
October 2012
AIR CONDITIONING
AIR CONDITIONING
AIR CONDITIONING
Refer to the circuit diagram in S08322, Chapter 12, Air Conditioning.
16WKB
Air Conditioner (International Blend Air) with integral heater, defroster and R134-A Refrigerant.
This is an electrical connection point for detecting when the air conditioner clutch is on. No direct electrical
connection point is provided for tapping into the A/C clutch wire. However, if an A/C clutch connection is
necessary, the Body Builder may use proper splice techniques to tap into wire AC77A. The added load required
by the Body Builder should not exceed two Amperes (AMPS). This control wire shall be at battery volts when
the A/C clutch is on and 0 volts when off. The software in the Body Controller (BC) determines when the A/C
clutch should be on or off based upon the mode of the HVAC controls in the cab and condenser temperatures
and high side pressures of the A/C system.
WIRING INFORMATION
WIRE GAUGE: 16 Gauge
WIRE NUMBER/COLOR: AC77A-LTGN
BC connector (1603): Pin C
TERMINAL: 3534163C1
CIRCUIT DIAGRAM: See Electrical Circuit Diagram Manual S08322 Chapter 12, Air Conditioning.
f_001
TESTING
1. Start the vehicle. Turn on air conditioner.
2. Verify that the wire feeding the body load is at battery volts when the A/C Clutch is ON and 0 volts when
OFF.
3. Ensure that no faults codes are present when the truck is on.
September 2012
SECTION 15 - PAGE 1
AIR CONDITIONING
BODY BUILDER IMPORTANT INFORMATION
In some applications it may be advantageous to add an additional A/C evaporator to cool remote areas of the
vehicle. The following procedures and part numbers will accommodate this addition.
NOTE: Do not break into the A/C clutch circuit for the purpose of controlling the A/C system.
Do not connect to the high side of the pressure transducer.
Do not connect to either of the A/C system thermistors.
PARTS INFORMATION
2007 MaxxForce DT and MaxxForce 9 Engines, Low Cab Mount
PROCEDURE
WARNING: To avoid property damage, personal injury or death, park the vehicle on a level surface, set the
parking brake, chock the wheels and turn the engine off.
WARNING: Wear a face shield, or other adequate eye protection, and nonporous gloves when working with
refrigerant. The temperature of liquid refrigerant may cause injury or blindness if the refrigerant contacts the
eyes. Should liquid refrigerant come in contact with skin, remove contaminated clothing, including shoes and
treat the injury as though the skin had been frostbitten. See a doctor immediately.
WARNING: Refrigerant must be recovered from the air conditioning system before any components of the
system are replaced. Removing components while pressure is in the system will cause personal injury or
death.
1. Recover the refrigerant from the A/C system.
2. Remove the A/C hose from the condenser to the evaporator and install the new hose.
3. Remove the A/C hose from the accumulator to the compressor and install the new hose.
4. Install the A/C hose from the new evaporator to the aux. fitting on the newly installed hose from the
condenser to the evaporator.
5. Install the A/C hose from the new evaporator to the aux. fitting on the newly installed hose from the
accumulator to the compressor.
6. Evacuate the system.
7. Recharge the system using R-134A refrigerant. The original truck system holds 30 oz. and the new
evaporator should require an additional 16 oz. The additional requirement will vary from system to system
depending on the length of hoses and the capacity of the new evaporator. The additional capacity will also
require an additional 40 cc (1.2 fl. Oz.) of PAG oil in the system.
SECTION 15 - PAGE 2
September 2012
AIR CONDITIONING
CAUTION: Failure to add additional PAG oil to the increased capacity A/C system will result in improper
lubrication and lead to premature component failure.
8. Operate the vehicle to make sure the A/C is performing properly and is not leaking.
A/C COMPRESSOR ACCOM. DUAL; FOR LOW SPEED ACCELERATION DISABLE, FOR
AFTERMARKET A/C SYSTEM
595AZR
This feature shall activate high side relay driver outputs A/C Compressor Clutch RD1 and A/C Compressor
Clutch RD2. Output will be defaulted to turn off when vehicle is not accelerating from a stop. This feature is
used to reduce engine load added by the AC compressors.
NORMAL OPERATION
The feature shall set AC_Clutch_RD_1 and AC_Clutch_RD_2 if the following conditions are true:
(Ignition Signal is ON AND Current Gear is in Neutral AND Park Brake is Set)
OR
(Ignition Signal is ON AND Current Gear is not in Neutral AND Park Brake is not Set AND Wheel Based
Vehicle Speed is less than 1mph AND Accelerator Pedal Position is less than Accelerator 8%)
OR
(Ignition Signal is ON AND Current Gear is not in Neutral AND Park Brake is not Set AND Wheel Based
Vehicle Speed is greater than 4mph AND Engine Speed is greater than or equal to Engine Speed AC
Compressor On Speed)
The feature shall reset AC_Clutch_RD_1 and AC_Clutch_RD_2 if the following conditions are true:
Ignition Signal is Off
OR
(Current Gear is not in Neutral AND Park Brake is not set AND Wheel Based Vehicle Speed is less than or
equal to 4mph AND Accelerator Pedal Position is greater than or equal to Accelerator 8%)
NOTE: Please use the Diamond Logic Builder software to determine pin locations on the Body Controller.
If pin locations F13 and F14 are being used by other features, contact Vehicle Programming Support for
assistance.
September 2012
SECTION 15 - PAGE 3
AIR CONDITIONING
WIRING INFORMATION
See the graphic below. Install the circuits, as illustrated, if they were not factory installed.
f_052
TESTING
1. With Park Brake released, Air Conditioning Demand on and compressor running, accelerate from a stop.
The Compressor (s) should be shut off, upon initial acceleration is completed.
2. The Compressor (s) should be shut off, upon initial acceleration is completed.
SECTION 15 - PAGE 4
September 2012
October 2012
SECTION 16 - PAGE 1
SECTION 16 - PAGE 2
October 2012
October 2012
SECTION 16 - PAGE 3
SECTION 16 - PAGE 4
October 2012
October 2012
SECTION 16 - PAGE 5
SECTION 16 - PAGE 6
October 2012
The features listed above describe both Allison transmission sales features as well as Allison vocational
electrical interface sales features. Review each entry carefully, and choose the transmission and optional
electrical interface feature that is right for the particular equipment application. Allison electrical interface
connections are optional equipment on International vehicles. Choose one of the features described below to
receive a cable harness interface connection on a vehicle factory-installed.
Allison provides electrical inputs and outputs for a variety of vehicle controls. The controls may be specific for
fire truck, emergency vehicle, loader, etc. See Allison Controls and General Information for details.
WIRING INFORMATION
See Allison Controls and General Information for technical details and circuit design.
With the Allison 3000/4000 Series, there are two connectors 7205 and 7206. Connectors 7205 and 7206
have their mating connectors attached filled with cavity plugs. The interface connections are located in between
the radiator pipe and the engine on the driver side of the engine.
October 2012
SECTION 16 - PAGE 7
f_068
To use these connectors, remove cavity plugs and use the following:
Table 62
SECTION 16 - PAGE 8
Connector
Cavity Plug
3525874C1
3525875C1
2025431C1
Terminals
Wire Gauge
1667742C1
16, 18, 20
Cable Seals
Wire Gauge
1661872C1
16, 18, 20
Connector
Cavity Plug
3525872C1
3525873C1
2025431C1
Terminals
Wire Gauge
1661875C1
16, 18, 20
Cable Seals
Wire Gauge
1661872C1
16, 18, 20
October 2012
Circuit Number
I/O
Connector Number 7205
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
K92B103
K92#161
K92#157
K92#124
K92#122
K92#105
K92#164
K92#162
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
K92#101
K92#117
K92C103
K92#143
K92#142
K92#145
K92#130
K92#123
Maximum Current
-Input
Input
Output
Input
Output
Output
Input
---500 mAMP*
--500 mAMP
--
-----500 mAMP
500 mAMP
--
*milliAmpere
NOTE: See Allison technical manual for suggested circuit design.
NOTE: See special features table below for package content.
NOTE: MUST COMPLY WITH FMVSS STANDARD #102.
The Allison 1000/2000 series has a single connector 7205. Connector 7205 has its mating connector
attached and filled with cavity plugs. The interface connections are located in between the radiator pipe and the
engine on the driver side of the engine.
f_069
October 2012
SECTION 16 - PAGE 9
Connector Lock
Cavity Plug
3525874C1
3525875C1
2025431C1
Terminals
Wire Gauge
1667742C1
16, 18, 20
Cable Seals
Wire Gauge
1661872C1
16, 18, 20
The circuit numbers on the harness correspond to the circuit numbers used by Allison. The table below gives
the Allison 1000/2000 circuit number which corresponds to the circuit numbers in the International harness
connectors. For a complete circuit diagram of the transmission wiring and for connector and terminal part
numbers, see Circuit Diagram Manual S08322, Chapter 11, Transmission.
Table 65
Cavity
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
Circuit Number
I/O
Connector Number 7205
L92C103
L92#143
L92#150
L47C125
L92#101
L92#123
L92#145
L92#105
-Input
Output
Output
Input
Output
Output
Input
Maximum Current
--500 mAMP*
---500 mAMP
--
*milliAmpere
NOTE: See Allison technical manual for suggested circuit design.
NOTE: See special features table below for package content.
NOTE: MUST COMPLY WITH FMVSS STANDARD #102.
SECTION 16 - PAGE 10
October 2012
Table 65
Spare
Input/Output
Package Content
Function #
I-A
I-C
I-D
I-E
I-F
I-G
I-H
I-J
I-L
I-Q
I-W
I-Y
I-Z
I-AA
I-AG
I-AJ
O-A
O-B
O-C
O-D
O-G
O-J
O-I
O-O
O-Q
O-S
Code
13WU#B
13WUC#
13WUD#
13WUE#
13WUG#
13WUH#
Group
Package
98
200
99
113
102
150
Highway Series
(HS)
Rugged Duty
Series (RDS)
107
120
Emergency
Vehicle Series
(EVS)
110
113
Other
108
174
Emergency
Vehicle Series
(EVS)
Requirements
General Purpose
Trucks
General Purpose
Trucks,
Construction
Rescue,
Ambulance
Fire/Pumper, Tank,
Aerial/Ladder
Function Name
Secondary Shift
Schedule
PTO Enable
Shift Selection Transition
Auxiliary Function Range
Inhibit (STD)
Auxiliary Function Range
Inhibit (Special)
Auxiliary Hold
Engine Brake &
Preselect Request
Fire Truck Pump Mode
Auto Neutral for PTO
(STD)
Two-Speed Axle Enable
Direction Change Enable
ABS Input
Retarder Enable
Service Brake Status
Auto Neutral for Refuse
Packer & PTO Enable
4th Gear Lockup for
Pump Mode
Engine Brake Enable
Sump/Retarder
Temperature Indicator
Range Indicator
Output Speed Indicator A
PTO Enable
Two-Speed Axle Enable
Engine Overspeed
Indicator
Service Indicator
Retarder Indicator
Neutral Indicator for PTO
143
143
101*
142
143
101*
101*
142
102/157
102/157
101*
142
102/157
102/157
102/157
102/157
122*
121
161
162
122*
121
161
162
122/123*
121
161
162
122*
121
161
162
121
161
162
121
161
162
122/123*
104
104
104
104
104
164
164
145
105
145
105
130
104
164
164
164
164
113
105
130
145 (4th)
105
130
145
105
130
145 (4th)
105
130
124
124
124
145
October 2012
124
124
124
SECTION 16 - PAGE 11
Function #
I-A
I-C
I-D
I-E
I-F
I-G
I-H
I-J
I-L
I-Q
I-W
I-Y
I-Z
I-AA
I-AG
I-AJ
O-A
O-B
O-C
O-D
O-G
O-J
O-I
O-O
O-Q
O-S
Code
13WUJ@
13WUK@
13WUL#
13WUM#
13WUP#
Group
Package
105
142
106
170
103
167
112
1484
Other
Rugged Duty
Series (RDS)
Rugged Duty
Series (RDS)
Rugged Duty
Series (RDS)
111
203
Pupil
Transportation
Series (PTS)
Requirements
Front Loaders,
Rear Loaders,
Recycling/Packer
Trucks
Side Loaders
Street Sweeper
School/Shuttle
142
143
101*
Function Name
Secondary Shift
Schedule
PTO Enable
Shift Selection Transition
Auxiliary Function Range
Inhibit (STD)
Auxiliary Function Range
Inhibit (Special)
Auxiliary Hold
Engine Brake &
Preselect Request
Fire Truck Pump Mode
Auto Neutral for PTO
(STD)
Two-Speed Axle Enable
Direction Change Enable
ABS Input
Retarder Enable
Service Brake Status
Auto Neutral for Refuse
Packer & PTO Enable
4th Gear Lockup for
Pump Mode
Engine Brake Enable
Sump/Retarder
Temperature Indicator
Range Indicator
Output Speed Indicator A
PTO Enable
Two-Speed Axle Enable
Engine Overspeed
Indicator
Service Indicator
Retarder Indicator
Neutral Indicator for PTO
SECTION 16 - PAGE 12
102/157
M
143
101*
101*
142
142
102/157
102/157
102/157
117*
117*
117*
121
161
162
121
161
162
101
121
161
162
121
161
162
142/117
104
104
104
104
164
164
164
164
105
130
113
105
130
145
145
105
145
105
130
124
145
124
145
124
124
October 2012
Code
13WUR#
13WUS%
13WUT#
13WUU#
13WUV%
Group
Package
100
146
Dump/Constructio
n with Two-Speed
Axle or Auxiliary
Transmission
(RDS)
99
113 mod
107
119
114
163
98
200
Rugged Duty
Series (RDS)
Emergency
Vehicle Series
(EVS)
Other
General Purpose
General Purpose
Trucks Modified for
Fire (not for
Trucks Modified for
Specialty Vehicles
Single Input
Split-Shaft PTO)r
Single Input
Auto Neutral
Auto Neutral
Requirements
Function #
I-A
I-C
I-D
I-E
I-F
I-G
I-H
I-J
I-L
I-Q
I-W
I-Y
I-Z
I-AA
I-AG
I-AJ
O-A
O-B
O-C
O-D
O-G
O-J
O-I
O-O
O-Q
O-S
Specialty Series
Highway Series (HS)
(SP)
Function Name
Secondary Shift
Schedule
PTO Enable
Shift Selection Transition
Auxiliary Function Range
Inhibit (STD)
Auxiliary Function Range
Inhibit (Special)
Auxiliary Hold
Engine Brake &
Preselect Request
Fire Truck Pump Mode
Auto Neutral for PTO
(STD)
Two-Speed Axle Enable
Direction Change Enable
ABS Input
Retarder Enable
Service Brake Status
Auto Neutral for Refuse
Packer & PTO Enable
4th Gear Lockup for
Pump Mode
Engine Brake Enable
Sump/Retarder
Temperature Indicator
Range Indicator
Output Speed Indicator A
PTO Enable
Two-Speed Axle Enable
Engine Overspeed
Indicator
Service Indicator
Retarder Indicator
Neutral Indicator for PTO
143
143
143
143
101*
101*
101/142
142
102/157
102/157
142
102/157
102/157
102/157
117
142
121
161
162
122*
121
161
162
121
161
162
121
161
162
121
161
162
104
104
104
104
104
164
164
164
164
105
130
145
105
130
145
105
124
124
164
145
130
145
124
145
105
130
124
October 2012
164
124
145
SECTION 16 - PAGE 13
Code
13WUZ#
13WVB%
Group
Package
127
198
Emergency
Vehicle Series
(EVS)
Fire/pumper, Tank,
Aerial/Ladder
108
174
Emergency
Vehicle Series
(EVS)
Ambulance,
Rescue
Other
Requirements
Function #
I-A
I-C
I-D
I-E
I-F
I-G
I-H
I-J
I-L
I-Q
I-W
I-Y
I-Z
I-AA
I-AG
I-AJ
O-A
O-B
O-C
O-D
O-G
O-J
O-I
O-O
O-Q
O-S
SECTION 16 - PAGE 14
Function Name
Secondary Shift
Schedule
PTO Enable
Shift Selection Transition
Auxiliary Function Range
Inhibit (STD)
Auxiliary Function Range
Inhibit (Special)
Auxiliary Hold
Engine Brake &
Preselect Request
Fire Truck Pump Mode
Auto Neutral for PTO
(STD)
Two-Speed Axle Enable
Direction Change Enable
ABS Input
Retarder Enable
Service Brake Status
Auto Neutral for Refuse
Packer & PTO Enable
4th Gear Lockup for
Pump Mode
Engine Brake Enable
Sump/Retarder
Temperature Indicator
Range Indicator
Output Speed Indicator A
PTO Enable
Two-Speed Axle Enable
Engine Overspeed
Indicator
Service Indicator
Retarder Indicator
Neutral Indicator for PTO
October 2012
142
143
101
102/157
102/157
122/123
121
161
162
121
161
162
104
104
164
164
145
105
130
113
105
130
124
124
145
GAUGES
GAUGES
This chapter describes the optional gauges that are either installed or can be installed in the instrument cluster.
If the vehicle was ordered without a desired gauge, one or more can be added in the field. Programming of the
Body Controller (BC) and proper placement is critical. Certain gauges will only work in certain locations. Before
adding the gauge to the vehicle, ensure that the vehicle can accept it. The outboard four gauges are the only
ones that can be moved or added. They can be added by using the Diamond Logic Builder software. Follow
the steps below for adding a gauge to the cluster (those without Diamond Logic Builder should see an
International dealer). The following instructions can be followed for any of the four auxiliary gauge positions.
Tilt the cluster forward to gain access to the back of the cluster (use caution not to scratch the face of the
cluster).
d. Remove all the connectors from the back of the cluster, and remove the cluster from the vehicle.
e. Remove the ten screws from the metal panel on the back of the cluster.
f.
g. Install the gauge using caution not to move the needle, damage the face, or get the face of the gauge dirty.
h. Connect the jumper wire in the socket directly next to the added gauge.
i.
Replace the metal panel, and install in the vehicle in the reverse order of removing it.
October 2012
SECTION 17 - PAGE 1
GAUGES
f_070
WIRING INFORMATION
The standard cluster includes:
ODOMETER DISPLAY: Miles, Trip Miles, Engine Hours, Trip Hours, Fault Code Readout (Odometer, trip
odometer, and fault code readout electronic-liquid crystal display)
WARNING SYSTEM: Low Fuel, Low Oil Pressure, High Engine Coolant Temp, and Low Battery Voltage (Visual
and Audible)
GAUGE CLUSTER GAUGES (6): Engine Oil Pressure (Electronic), Water Temperature (Electronic), Fuel
(Electronic), Tachometer (Electronic), Voltmeter, Speedometer
GAUGE, AIR PRESSURE: Air 1 and Air 2 Gauges; Located in Instrument Cluster (Air Chassis only)
TESTING
Use the Diamond Logic Builder software to steer each gauge to test values.
SECTION 17 - PAGE 2
October 2012
GAUGES
ID
Description
Default
Units
Min
Max
Step
Aux_Air_
Press_Alrm_
Type_Param
2380
List
Aux_Air_
Press_Filter_
Param
108
255
No_Units
255
Aux_Air_
Press_Max_
WL _Gen2
2392
Aux_Air_
Press_Min_WL
1964
Table 67
Optional Gauges
3615266C1
3615267C1
October 2012
SECTION 17 - PAGE 3
GAUGES
The Eng_Oil_Temp_Filter_Param parameter sets the engine oil temperature update rate. The higher the
number is, the faster the update rate. 255 is the fastest update rate available, and 1 is the slowest update rate
available.
The Eng_Oil_Temp_Max_WL parameter sets the maximum point for engine oil temperature in-gauge warning
light. When the oil temperature rises above this set parameter, the warning light in the gauge will illuminate.
The Eng_Oil_Temp_Min_WL parameter sets the minimum point for engine oil temperature in-gauge warning
light. When the oil temperature falls below this set parameter, the warning light in the gauge will illuminate.
Table 68
Parameter
ID
Description
Default
Units
Min
Max
Step
Eng_Oil_
Temp_Alrm_
Ty_Param
2354
List
255
No_Units
255
251
100
300
0.03125
3226
100
300
0.03125
Eng_Oil_
Temp_Filter
_Param
219
Eng_Oil_
Temp_ Max_WL
2274
Eng_Oil_
Temp_ Min_WL
2291
Table 69
Optional Gauges
3615258C1
3615259C1
16HGH
Provides Allison transmission fluid temperature information to the vehicle operator.
SECTION 17 - PAGE 4
October 2012
GAUGES
Table 70
Parameter
ID
Trans_Oil_
Temp_Alrm_
Ty_Param
2356
Trans_Oil_
Temp_
Filter_Param
589
Trans_Oil_
Temp_ Max_WL
2272
Trans_Oil_
Temp_ Min_WL
2273
Description
Transmission oil
temperature gauge alarm
type.
Transmission oil
temperature gauge
update rate. A value of 1
is the slowest and 255 is
the fastest update rate.
Maximum set point for
transmission oil
temperature in-gauge
warning light. The default
of 3226 means no
maximum warning light.
Minimum set point for
transmission oil
temperature in-gauge
warning light. The default
of 3226 means no
minimum warning light.
Default
Units
Min
Max
Step
No_Units
255
No_Units
255
3226
100
300
0.03125
3226
100
300
0.03125
Table 71
Optional Gauges
3615268C1
3615269C1
This feature provides manual transmission oil temperature to the vehicle operator. Manual transmissions
should not be operated at temperatures above 250 F (120 C).
16HGJ
GAUGE, OIL TEMP, MANUAL TRAN
October 2012
SECTION 17 - PAGE 5
GAUGES
Table 72
Parameter
ID
Default
Units
Min
Max
Step
No_Units
255
No_Units
255
250
100
300
0.03125
3226
100
300
0.03125
Trans_Oil_
Temp_Alrm_
Ty_Param
2356
Trans_Oil_
Temp_
Filter_Param
589
Trans_Oil_
Temp_ Min_WL
2273
Description
Transmission oil
temperature gauge alarm
type.
Transmission oil
temperature gauge
update rate. A value of 1
is the slowest and 255 is
the fastest update rate.
Table 73
Optional Gauges
3615268C1
3615269C1
SECTION 17 - PAGE 6
October 2012
GAUGES
The Rear_Axle_TempC_Min_Gen2_WL parameter sets the minimum point for rear-rear axle temperature
in-gauge warning light. When the rear-rear axle temperature falls below this set parameter, the warning light in
the gauge will illuminate.
The Fwd_Axle_TempC_Max_Gen2_WL parameter sets the maximum point for forward-rear axle temperature
in-gauge warning light. When the forward-rear axle temperature rises above this set parameter, the warning
light in the gauge will illuminate.
The Fwd_Axle_TempC_Min_Gen2_WL parameter sets the minimum point for forward-rear axle temperature
in-gauge warning light. When the forward-rear axle temperature falls below this set parameter, the warning light
in the gauge will illuminate.
The Fwd_Axle_Temperature_Alarm_Gen2_Param parameter defines the number of beeps associated with the
forward-rear axle temperature alarm.
Table 74
Parameter
ID
Fwd_RR_
Axle_Temp_
Filter_Param
277
Rear_Axle_
Temperature_
Alarm_Gen2
2415
Rear_RR_
Axle_Temp_
Filter_Param
519
Rear_Axle_
TempC_
Max_Gen2_WL
2485
Rear_RR_
Axle_TempC_M
in_Gen2_WL
2486
Fwd_Axle_
TempC_
Max_Gen2_WL
2498
Fwd_RR_
Axle_TempC_M
in_Gen2_WL
2499
Fwd_Axle_
Temperature_
Alarm_Gen2
2500
Description
Forward-rear axle
temperature gauge
update rate. A value of 1
is the slowest and 255 is
the fastest update rate.
Rear-rear axle
temperature gauge alarm
type.
Rear-rear axle
temperature gauge
update rate. A value of 1
is the slowest and 255 is
the fastest update rate.
Maximum set point for
rear-rear axle temperature
in-gauge warning light
Minimum set point for
rear-rear axle temperature
in-gauge warning light. A
value of 117923 means no
minimum warning light.
Maximum set point for
forward-rear axle
temperature in-gauge
warning light
Minimum set point for
forward-rear axle
temperature in-gauge
warning light. A value of
117923 means no
minimum warning light.
Forward-rear axle
temperature gauge alarm
type.
Default
Units
Min
Max
Step
255
No_Units
255
No_Units
255
255
240
100
300
100
100
300
240
100
300
100
100
300
No_Units
October 2012
SECTION 17 - PAGE 7
GAUGES
The Rear_Axle_TempC_Max_Gen2_WL parameter sets the maximum point for rear-rear axle temperature
in-gauge warning light. When the rear-rear axle temperature rises above this set parameter, the warning light in
the gauge will illuminate.
The Rear_Axle_TempC_Min_Gen2_WL parameter sets the minimum point for rear-rear axle temperature
in-gauge warning light. When the rear-rear axle temperature falls below this set parameter, the warning light in
the gauge will illuminate.
Table 75
Parameter
ID
Rear_Axle_
Temperature_
Alarm_Gen2
2415
Rear_RR_
Axle_Temp_
Filter_Param
519
Rear_Axle_
TempC_
Max_Gen2_WL
2485
Rear_RR_
Axle_TempC_M
in_Gen2_WL
2486
Description
Rear-rear axle
temperature gauge alarm
type.
Rear-rear axle
temperature gauge
update rate. A value of 1
is the slowest and 255 is
the fastest update rate.
Maximum set point for
rear-rear axle temperature
in-gauge warning light.
Minimum set point for
rear-rear axle temperature
in-gauge warning light. A
value of 117920 means no
minimum warning light.
Default
Units
Min
Max
Step
No_Units
255
No_Units
255
240
100
300
100
100
300
Table 76
Optional Gauges
Rear-rear Axle Oil Temperature
Gauge
Forward-rear Axle Oil
Temperature Gauge
3615272C1
3615273C1
3615260C1
3615261C1
SECTION 17 - PAGE 8
October 2012
GAUGES
The Brake_App_Max_WL_Gen2_AGSP parameter sets the maximum point for the brake application AGSP
warning light. When the brake pressure rises above this set parameter, the warning light in the gauge will
illuminate.
The Brake_App_Min_WL_Gen2_AGSP parameter sets the minimum point for brake application AGSP warning
light. When brake pressure falls below this set parameter, the warning light in the gauge will illuminate.
Table 77
Parameter
ID
Description
Default
Units
Min
Max
Step
LH_Brake_
App_ Alrm_Ty_
Param
2348
No_Units
255
No_Units
255
150
0.5
Brake_App_
Filter_Param
128
Brake_App_
Max_WL
2343
Brake_App_
Min_WL
2337
Brake_App_
Max_WL_
Gen2_AGSP
2424
Brake_App_
Min_WL_
Gen2_AGSP
2423
38020
38020
psi
150
0.5
150
psi
38020
psi
38020
Table 78
Optional Gauges
3616155C1
361656C1
October 2012
SECTION 17 - PAGE 9
GAUGES
The Ammeter_Filter_Param parameter sets the ammeter gauge update rate. The higher the number is, the
faster the update rate. 255 is the fastest update rate available, and 1 is the slowest update rate available.
The Ammeter_Max_WL parameter sets the maximum point for the ammeter in-gauge warning light. When the
amperage rises above this set parameter, the warning light in the gauge will illuminate.
The Ammeter_Min_WL parameter sets the minimum point for ammeter in-gauge warning light. When
amperage falls below this set parameter, the warning light in the gauge will illuminate.
The PAM_Acc_Pos_Offset_Param parameter estimates the electrical loads measured by the PAM when the
key is in the accessory position.
The PAM_Run_Pos_Offset_Param parameter estimates the electrical loads measured by the PAM when the
key is in the run position.
The PAM_Xfer_Function_Slope_Param parameter sets the slope of the transfer function used to calculate the
electrical load on the vehicle displayed by the ammeter.
Table 79
Parameter
ID
Ammeter_
Alrm_Ty_
Param
71
Ammeter_
Filter_Param
72
Ammeter_
Max_WL
2394
Ammeter_
Min_WL
2393
PAM_Acc_
Pos_Offset_
Param
1941
PAM_Run_
Pos_Offset_
Param
1940
PAM_Xfer_
Function_
Slope_ Param
1939
Ammeter_
Max_WL
2004
Ammeter_
Min_WL
2001
SECTION 17 - PAGE 10
Description
Ammeter gauge alarm
type. The number of
beeps is the value of this
parameter divided by 5.
255 is a continuous tone.
Ammeter gauge update
rate. A value of 1 is the
slowest and 255 is the
fastest update rate.
Maximum set point for
ammeter in-gauge
warning light. The default
of 1676 means no
maximum warning light.
Minimum set point for
ammeter in-gauge
warning light. The default
of 1676 means no
minimum warning light.
Estimation of electrical
load that is not measured
by the PAM when the key
is in the accessory
position.
Estimation of electrical
load that is not measured
by the PAM when the key
is in the run position.
Slope of the transfer
function used to calculate
the electrical load on the
vehicle to be displayed by
the ammeter
Maximum set point for
ammeter in-gauge
warning light.
Minimum set point for
ammeter in-gauge
warning light.
Default
Units
Min
Max
Step
Number
255
25
255
Number
255
1676
-300
300
1676
-300
300
250
250
475
micro Ohm
64255
150
-300
300
-150
-300
300
October 2012
GAUGES
Table 80
Optional Gauges
Ammeter
3615264C1
--
WIRING INFORMATION
No additional wiring is needed.
TESTING
1. Set Park Brake
2. Press and hold Cruise On switch and Cruise Resume switch
3. Odometer should NOT display NO FAULTS or a number of FAULTS.
WIRING INFORMATION
No additional wiring is needed.
TESTING
1. Set Park Brake
2. Press and hold Cruise On switch and Cruise Resume switch
3. Odometer should display the number of active and past fault codes.
4. Pressing the selection button on the face of the cluster will cycle through the fault codes, or they will
change to the next fault code every ten seconds.
October 2012
SECTION 17 - PAGE 11
GAUGES
SECTION 17 - PAGE 12
October 2012
October 2012
SECTION 18 - PAGE 1
SECTION 18 - PAGE 2
October 2012
FEATURE/BODY FUNCTION
On the DuraStar models, codes 08SAJ, 08WSM, 60AAA, AAD, AAN and 60AAB have the RPMs mounted at
the back of the battery box.
On the WorkStar models, codes 08SAJ, 08WSM, 60AAA, AAD, AAN and 60AAB have the RPMs mounted
under the cab, left rear.
On either the DuraStar or WorkStar models, codes 08WSK, 08WTJ or 60AAM have the RPMs mounted on
the drivers side frame rail at the ROF.
On the DuraStar or WorkStar models, codes 08VZR, 08VZS, 60AAG, 60AAH, 60AAJ, 60AAK, or 60AAL
have the RPMs mounted inside the cab, behind the drivers seat.
On the Workstar models, codes 60AJL and 60AJM have the PRMs mounted inside the cab, behind the
passengers seat. On the DuraStar, codes 60AJL and 60AJM are not available.
On WorkStar models code 60AAN is not compatible with 60AAB
October 2012
f_071
SECTION 18 - PAGE 3
f_072
Feature codes 08WSK, 08WSM, 08SAJ, 08VZR, 08VZS, and 08WTJ each add a 6-pack switch pack in a
one-to- one relationship to the RPM feature code.
60AAA and 60AAB add switches by filling in the first empty switch location. Once the first switch pack is full, a
second will be added filling in from the left to right of the switch pack.
SECTION 18 - PAGE 4
October 2012
08SAJ
08WSK
08WSM
08VZR
08VZS
08WTJ
60AAA
60AAB
60AAD
# of RPMs
and
Addresses
Used
2
(1, 2)
1
(4)
1
(1)
1
(1)
2
(1, 2)
1
(4)
1
(1)
2
(1, 2)
2
(1, 2
# of
Switches
Type of
Switches
Switch Configuration
Model
Location
12
Momentary
DuraStar
WorkStar
Momentary
DuraStar &
WorkStar
Momentary
Momentary
12
Momentary
Latched
Latched
12
Latched
Latched
DuraStar
WorkStar
DuraStar &
WorkStar
DuraStar &
WorkStar
DuraStar &
WorkStar
DuraStar
WorkStar
DuraStar
WorkStar
DuraStar
WorkStar
60AAG
1
(1)
Latched
DuraStar &
WorkStar
60AAH
2
(1,2)
12
Latched
DuraStar &
WorkStarI
60AAJ
3
(1, 2, 4)
18
Latched
DuraStar &
WorkStarI
60AAK
2
(1,2)
Latched
DuraStar &
WorkStarI
Latched
Latched
60AJL (Not
recommended,
use 60AAG)
60AJM
(Not recommended,
use 60AAH)
DuraStar
1
12
WorkStar
DuraStar
Not available
WorkStar
60AAL
3
(1, 2, 4)
None
N/A
DuraStar &
WorkStar
60AAM
1
(5)
None
N/A
DuraStar &
WorkStar
60AAN
1
(3)
None
N/A
WorkStar
October 2012
SECTION 18 - PAGE 5
SECTION 18 - PAGE 6
October 2012
ID
Description
Default
Units
Min
Max
Step
454
20
20
0.1
455
20
20
0.1
456
20
20
0.1
457
20
20
0.1
458
20
20
0.1
459
20
20
0.1
OFF
No_ Units
N/A
N/A
N/A
OFF
No_ Units
N/A
N/A
N/A
OFF
No_ Units
N/A
N/A
N/A
OFF
No_ Units
N/A
N/A
N/A
OFF
No_ Units
N/A
N/A
N/A
OFF
No_ Units
N/A
N/A
N/A
PwrMod4_
Init_State1_
Param
460
PwrMod4_
Init_State2_
Param
461
PwrMod4_
Init_State3_
Param
462
PwrMod4_
Init_State4_
Param
463
PwrMod4_
Init_State5_
Param
464
PwrMod4_
Init_State6_
Param
465
October 2012
SECTION 18 - PAGE 7
SECTION 18 - PAGE 8
October 2012
ID
Description
Default
Units
Min
Max
Step
392
20
20
0.1
393
20
20
0.1
394
20
20
0.1
395
20
20
0.1
396
20
20
0.1
397
20
20
0.1
OFF
No_ Units
N/A
N/A
N/A
OFF
No_ Units
N/A
N/A
N/A
OFF
No_ Units
N/A
N/A
N/A
OFF
No_ Units
N/A
N/A
N/A
OFF
No_ Units
N/A
N/A
N/A
OFF
No_ Units
N/A
N/A
N/A
PwrMod1_
Init_State1_
Param
398
PwrMod1_
Init_State2_
Param
399
PwrMod1_
Init_State3_
Param
400
PwrMod1_
Init_State4_
Param
401
PwrMod1_
Init_State5_
Param
402
PwrMod1_
Init_State6_
Param
403
October 2012
SECTION 18 - PAGE 9
SECTION 18 - PAGE 10
October 2012
ID
Description
Default
Units
Min
Max
Step
35
20
20
0.1
36
20
20
0.1
37
20
20
0.1
38
20
20
0.1
39
20
20
0.1
40
20
20
0.1
OFF
No_ Units
N/A
N/A
N/A
OFF
No_ Units
N/A
N/A
N/A
OFF
No_ Units
N/A
N/A
N/A
OFF
No_ Units
N/A
N/A
N/A
OFF
No_ Units
N/A
N/A
N/A
OFF
No_ Units
N/A
N/A
N/A
PwrMod2_
Init_State1_
Param
41
PwrMod2_
Init_State2_
Param
42
PwrMod2_
Init_State3_
Param
43
PwrMod2_
Init_State4_
Param
44
PwrMod2_
Init_State5_
Param
45
PwrMod2_
Init_State6_
Param
46
PwrMod1_
Fuse_Level1_
Param
PwrMod1_
Fuse_ Level2_
Param
PwrMod1_
Fuse_ Level3_
Param
PwrMod1_
Fuse_Level4_
Param
392
20
20
0.1
393
20
20
0.1
394
20
20
0.1
395
20
20
0.1
October 2012
SECTION 18 - PAGE 11
ID
Description
Default
Units
Min
Max
Step
396
20
20
0.1
397
20
20
0.1
OFF
No_ Units
N/A
N/A
N/A
OFF
No_ Units
N/A
N/A
N/A
OFF
No_ Units
N/A
N/A
N/A
OFF
No_ Units
N/A
N/A
N/A
OFF
No_ Units
N/A
N/A
N/A
OFF
No_ Units
N/A
N/A
N/A
PwrMod1_
Init_State1_
Param
398
PwrMod1_
Init_State2_
Param
399
PwrMod1_
Init_State3_
Param
400
PwrMod1_
Init_State4_
Param
401
PwrMod1_
Init_State5_
Param
402
PwrMod1_
Init_State6_
Param
403
SECTION 18 - PAGE 12
October 2012
The following parameters may or may not show up in certain combinations based on which of the above
software feature codes are installed on the vehicle.
The TEM_Aux1_Output_Fuse_Param sets the limit (in AMPS) of the current flowing from the output labeled
Aux_Switch_1_Output of RPM #1.
The TEM_Aux2_Output_Fuse_Param sets the limit (in AMPS) of the current flowing from the output labeled
Aux_Switch_2_Output of RPM #1.
The TEM_Aux3_Output_Fuse_Param sets the limit (in AMPS) of the current flowing from the output labeled
Aux_Switch_3_Output of RPM #1.
The TEM_Aux4_Output_Fuse_Param sets the limit (in AMPS) of the current flowing from the output labeled
Aux_Switch_4_Output of RPM #1.
The TEM_Aux5_Output_Fuse_Param sets the limit (in AMPS) of the current flowing from the output labeled
Aux_Switch_5_Output of RPM #1.
The TEM_Aux6_Output_Fuse_Param sets the limit (in AMPS) of the current flowing from the output labeled
Aux_Switch_6_Output of RPM #1.
The TEM_Aux7_Output_Fuse_Param sets the limit (in AMPS) of the current flowing from the output labeled
Aux_Switch_7_Output of RPM #1.
The TEM_Aux8_Output_Fuse_Param sets the limit (in AMPS) of the current flowing from the output labeled
Aux_Switch_8_Output of RPM #1.
The TEM_Aux9_Output_Fuse_Param sets the limit (in AMPS) of the current flowing from the output labeled
Aux_Switch_9_Output of RPM #1.
The TEM_Aux10_Output_Fuse_Param sets the limit (in AMPS) of the current flowing from the output labeled
Aux_Switch_10_Output of RPM #1.
The TEM_Aux11_Output_Fuse_Param sets the limit (in AMPS) of the current flowing from the output labeled
Aux_Switch_11_Output of RPM #1.
The TEM_Aux12_Output_Fuse_Param sets the limit (in AMPS) of the current flowing from the output labeled
Aux_Switch_12_Output of RPM #1.
October 2012
SECTION 18 - PAGE 13
ID
TEM_Aux1_
Output_Fuse_
Param
1990
TEM_Aux2_
Output_Fuse_
Param
1991
TEM_Aux3_
Output_Fuse_
Param
1992
TEM_Aux4_
Output_Fuse_
Param
1995
TEM_Aux5_
Output_Fuse_
Param
1999
TEM_Aux6_
Output_Fuse_
Param
2000
TEM_Aux7_
Output_Fuse_
Param
2100
TEM_Aux8_
Output_Fuse_
Param
2101
TEM_Aux9_
Output_Fuse_
Param
2102
TEM_Aux10_
Output_Fuse_
Param
2103
TEM_Aux11_
Output_Fuse_
Param
2104
TEM_Aux12_
Output_Fuse_
Param
2105
Description
This is the maximum current
Aux 1 output is allowed to
source before the virtual fusing
turns the output off.
This is the maximum current
Aux 2 output is allowed to
source before the virtual fusing
turns the output off.
This is the maximum current
Aux 3 output is allowed to
source before the virtual fusing
turns the output off.
This is the maximum current
Aux 4 output is allowed to
source before the virtual fusing
turns the output off.
This is the maximum current
Aux 5 output is allowed to
source before the virtual fusing
turns the output off.
This is the maximum current
Aux 6 output is allowed to
source before the virtual fusing
turns the output off.
This is the maximum current
Aux 7 output is allowed to
source before the virtual fusing
turns the output off.
This is the maximum current
Aux 8 output is allowed to
source before the virtual fusing
turns the output off.
This is the maximum current
Aux 9 output is allowed to
source before the virtual fusing
turns the output off.
This is the maximum current
Aux 10 output is allowed to
source before the virtual fusing
turns the output off.
This is the maximum current
Aux 11output is allowed to
source before the virtual fusing
turns the output off.
This is the maximum current
Aux 12 output is allowed to
source before the virtual fusing
turns the output off.
Default
Units
Min
Max
Step
20
Amps
20
0.1
20
Amps
20
0.1
20
Amps
20
0.1
20
Amps
20
0.1
20
Amps
20
0.1
20
Amps
20
0.1
20
Amps
20
0.1
20
Amps
20
0.1
20
Amps
20
0.1
20
Amps
20
0.1
20
Amps
20
0.1
20
Amps
20
0.1
FEATURE/BODY FUNCTION
08WTJ: 595AJG
Feature 08WTJ adds one RPM to the end of the frame to be used by itself or in combination with 60AAA (one
RPM BOC) or 60AAB (two RPMs BOC). The RPM will have six channels, 20 AMPS per channel, and 80 AMPS
maximum output. There will be six, 2-position, latched switches located in the IP that will control the RPM
through multiplex wiring.
SECTION 18 - PAGE 14
October 2012
ID
TEM_Aux13_
Output_Fuse_
Param
2215
TEM_Aux14_
Output_Fuse_
Param
2216
TEM_Aux15_
Output_Fuse_
Param
2217
TEM_Aux16_
Output_Fuse_
Param
2218
TEM_Aux17_
Output_Fuse_
Param
2219
TEM_Aux18_
Output_Fuse_
Param
2220
Description
This is the maximum current
Aux 13 output is allowed to
source before the virtual fusing
turns the output off.
This is the maximum current
Aux 14 output is allowed to
source before the virtual fusing
turns the output off.
This is the maximum current
Aux 15 output is allowed to
source before the virtual fusing
turns the output off.
This is the maximum current
Aux 16 output is allowed to
source before the virtual fusing
turns the output off.
This is the maximum current
Aux 17 output is allowed to
source before the virtual fusing
turns the output off.
This is the maximum current
Aux 18 output is allowed to
source before the virtual fusing
turns the output off.
Default
Units
Min
Max
Step
20
Amps
20
0.1
20
Amps
20
0.1
20
Amps
20
0.1
20
Amps
20
0.1
20
Amps
20
0.1
20
Amps
20
0.1
WIRING INFORMATION
Each module receives power from a 4-gauge cable, protected by a fusible link, connected to the battery stud of
the starter motor or the battery depending on the location of the RPM.
October 2012
SECTION 18 - PAGE 15
f_073
Each generic RPM has the ability to operate up to six devices of 20 AMPS or less not to exceed 80 AMPS for
the entire module. Each RPM comes with a 6-pack of switches that is inserted into the center section of the IP.
Each generic switch controls one output of the RPM. The switch mapping is one-to-one with the RPM, i.e.
switch one controls output channel one on the RPM. The switch pack is connected to the switch data bus that
communicates switch operation to the BC, which communicates that operation to the RPM. The RPM also has
inputs on the module itself that can be programmed to control the outputs. This means that the RPM functions
like a 3-way lamp switch in a home. Each in-cab switch is a momentary rocker switch that is stable in the center
position. The upper section of each switch has an indicator light to provide the status of each power output
channel. Pressing the upper section of the switch will latch the respective power output channel on and
illuminate the indicator. Pressing the lower section of the switch will latch the power output channel off and turn
the indicator off. Likewise, the output channels may be controlled remotely by using a three-position momentary
single pole, double throw switch on each remote switch input. Applying battery volts to the remote switch input
will turn the output channel on. Applying GND to the remote switch input will turn the output channel off. The
lamp indicator on the IP switch will always display the current status of the output channel as long as the IGN
key is in the IGN or accessory position. Each RPM In-cab switch operates with the key in the IGN or accessory
position. The RPM remote input switches operate at any time. If a conflict exists between the switches, the off
state always wins.
A maximum of three RPMs may be connected to the vehicle from the factory which allows a total of 18 devices
to be controlled as long as the 80 AMPS per module is not exceeded. The modules can be relocated from their
mounting position as long as the datalink cable will reach its new mounting location without the datalink cable
being modified.
ADDRESSING RPMS
All RPMs require jumpers to tell the system controller what RPM it is controlling. Jumpers are to be installed in
a 23-way connector in location J3, shown in the figure below. No two RPMs can have the same address on a
vehicle.
SECTION 18 - PAGE 16
October 2012
f_074
J3 23Way Connector
f_075
Switch Labeling: Switch packs provided with the RPM feature are general purpose un-labeled rocker
switches. Since the functions of the rocker switches are unknown at the time of vehicle assembly, un-labeled
rocker switches are provided so the Body Builder can customize the switches to any particular need. For switch
graphic information, see the Switches chapter in this electrical guide.
October 2012
SECTION 18 - PAGE 17
f_076
f_077
SECTION 18 - PAGE 18
October 2012
Signal Name
2
3
4
6
2
3
4
6
1
Supply Voltage
Input
80
Table 88
Pin
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
Signal Name
Signal Direction
Signal Connector
Module Select Common
Module Select #1
Module Select Common
Module Select #2
Module Select Common
Module Select #3
Input #1
Input #2
Input #3
Input #4
Input #5
Input #6
GND
Digital Input
GND
Digital Input
GND
Rating (Amps)
0.010
0.010
0.010
Switch Input
Switch Input
Switch Input
Switch Input
Switch Input
Switch Input
0.010
0.010
0.010
0.010
0.010
0.010
Power Connector
Output #1
Output #2
Output #3
Output #4
Output #5
Output
Output
Output
Output
Output
20
20
20
20
20
Output #6
Output
20
October 2012
SECTION 18 - PAGE 19
Plug
1688285C1
Cable Gauge
16, 18, 20
Lock
3548934C1
3548943C1
Terminal
3535930C1
3534163C1
3535931C1
Cable Seal
3535936C1
3535937C1
3548945C1
Plug
Cable Gauge
16, 18
12
14
Cable Gauge
2025431C1
f_079
For Switch Product Graphic Label Kit part numbers, see the Switch chapter in this electrical guide.
SECTION 18 - PAGE 20
October 2012
October 2012
SECTION 18 - PAGE 21
f_081
RPM Connectors
SECTION 18 - PAGE 22
f_080
October 2012
Description
Quantity
2588909C92
3804529P93
3558934C92
3611349P93
MIN10
3519178C91
3549776C4
3578910C1
3578733C1
3533928C1
3552005C4
2585423C91
2585651C91
2594135R1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
6
6
6
1
1
1
1
This kit is for left-mounted battery box for DuraStar models and under cab for WorkStar models and inside the
cab, for both models. If truck has right-mounted battery box, add 3558936C91. If adding two RPMs, use jumper
harness 3558937C91 from first to second RPM and add 3558934C92 cable for the battery feed.
If RPM brackets are needed, the following part numbers will need to be ordered.
DuraStar models (one or two RPMs)
October 2012
SECTION 18 - PAGE 23
1. Install A5E (1939 +) {yellow} into the IP center chassis (1701) cavity 52
2. Install A5E (1939 -) {green} into the IP center chassis (1701) cavity 53
3. Insert A20 {lt green} into the IP center chassis (1701) cavity 51
4. Install N10-GR {white} into splice pack (8809) cavity C
Install a terminating resistor in the open connector in the cab, and install a terminating resistor in the last
module in the datalink.
f_082
SECTION 18 - PAGE 24
October 2012
f_083
October 2012
f_084
SECTION 18 - PAGE 25
f_085
SECTION 18 - PAGE 26
October 2012
f_086
f_087
When more than one Remote Power Module (RPM) is installed, the Data Link wire harness must be
daisy-chained using the scheme diagrammed in the figure below. Connect the 6 pin Data Link Harness (J1939)
from the first RPM to either data link connector of the second. Continue connecting the data link jumper
October 2012
SECTION 18 - PAGE 27
SECTION 18 - PAGE 28
October 2012
f_089
f_090
To install a switch in the switch pack housing, insert the switch in the proper slot and push in until the switch
locking tabs are fully engaged (switches are keyed and cannot be installed upside down).
f_092
Remove the rear cover of the switch pack. It is attached with a snap fit. See the attached pictures to determine
which end is up on the switch pack. Install the LED lamps with the white base (part number 3578733C1) in the
upper section of each switch on the switch pack housing. These are the indication of on lamps and will glow
green when activated. Note that the LED lamps have a keying feature as they are installed in the switch pack
circuit board. If the lamps are forced in against the proper orientation, they will not illuminate.
Install the LED lamps with the black base (part number 3533928C1) in the lower section of each switch on the
switch pack housing. These are the back light lamps and will glow amber when the panel lights are on.
Reattach the rear cover and secure the wire harnesses under the cover hooks.
Locate a free switch pack opening in the central IP.
If no switch packs are present in the vehicle, remove the switch blank below the radio space and locate the
6-pin cab harness for the switch packs. Connect the cab switch harness to the left side switch pack harness (as
viewed from the front). Connectors are keyed to ensure proper connection. Ensure that the switch pack is
installed in the proper orientation. The green indication of on lamps must be on top when viewing the front of
the switch pack.
If one 6-switch pack is already present, locate the new switch pack in the lower left switch pack area.
October 2012
SECTION 18 - PAGE 29
f_093
If an additional switch pack is being installed, it is connected to the multiplex system by daisy chaining its
connectors to the existing switch pack (or to the cab harness if no switch pack is currently installed). It is
important to connect the switch packs in the correct order. Connecting the switch packs together and to the cab
harness in the wrong order will cause switch pack addressing problems.
f_094
SECTION 18 - PAGE 30
October 2012
f_095
f_031
Insert the extraction tools (2) into the two holes on either side of a switch pack housing until the locking tabs are
fully depressed. The switch pack can then be removed from the panel and the extraction tools removed.
f_096
To remove individual switches or blanks from a switch pack, squeeze the locking tabs on the rear of the switch
or blank (top and bottom) and push it from the housing.
To install a switch pack in the panel, make the necessary connections then simply push the assembly into place
until the locking tabs are fully engaged.
NOTE: The switch pack can be inadvertently installed upside down. To avoid this when no switches are
present in the housing, make sure the white wire in the lead assemblies on the rear of the housing is towards
the top.
October 2012
SECTION 18 - PAGE 31
If any RPM outputs have been programmed to turn on automatically when the key is turned on, (see
programmable parameters) then turn the key to the on position and verify that those outputs are providing
battery voltage.
SECTION 18 - PAGE 32
October 2012
ID
Description
Default
Settings
Units
PV-TEMAux-13
Step
20
Amps
20
0.1
PV-TEMAux-14
20
Amps
20
0.1
PV-TEMAux-15
20
Amps
20
0.1
PV-TEMAux-16
20
Amps
20
0.1
PV-TEMAux-17
20
Amps
20
0.1
PV-TEMAux-18
20
Amps
20
0.1
WIRING INFORMATION
Refer to current remote power module.
TESTING
Refer to current remote power module.
October 2012
SECTION 18 - PAGE 33
SECTION 18 - PAGE 34
Part Number
Description
3595804F91
6 of 3533928C1
6 of 3578733C1
6 of 3578910C1
October 2012
f_097
Most switches are rocker actuators that do not require hard wiring. See the Switch Actuators for Multiplex
Systems Table below. The switches are used in switch pack modules (6 or 12 switches) that connect to the
multiplex system through the switch housing cable harnesses. Push button switches for the cluster are also
available. See Push Buttons Table below.
If the original vehicle has a three switch pack with only one or two switch locations full, adding another switch is
acceptable. Once three switch locations are full, adding more would require the purchase of a six switch pack.
To identify a 3 or 6-pack, remove the switch pack from the center console using the radio removal tool. A
3-pack has wires on the left side only; a 6-pack has wires on the left and right side.
In the Switch Actuator Table below, the first column references the part numbers of the new replacement
switch, and columns 2 and 3 are the replacement LEDs part numbers. Column 4 is the switch description.
Columns 5, 6, and 7 describe the switch functions. Position Number reflects the number of positions where the
switch can physically be placed. Position On denotes the position of the switch for activation. Switch Action
indicates whether the switch is momentary (spring-loaded, switch returns to a specific state) or if the switch is
latching (switch stays in the selected state).
NOTE: Switches are no longer packaged with LEDs (Light Emitting Diodes). LEDs must be ordered separately.
Refer to the Table below to locate the proper LED part numbers. Each switch usually requires two LEDs that
are installed from the rear side of the switch pack assembly (see the Switches section). If the switch has an on
indicator, a green LED will be located in the upper portion. An amber LED is required in the lower portion
providing for nighttime viewing. If a switch does not contain an on indicator, then an amber LED should be
installed in the upper as well as the lower section.
October 2012
SECTION 19 - PAGE 1
3533928C1 (amber) = 2
Position On
Mid/Up
Up
All
Up
All
Up/Down
All
Up/Down
Up/Down
Up
Up
Up
Up/Hi
Up
Down
Up
Up
Up
Up
Up
Up
Up
Up/Hi
Up
Up
Up
Up
Up
Up
Up
Up
Up
Up
Up
Up
Up/Mid
Up
Up
Up
Up
Up
Up
Up
Up
Switch Action
Latching
Latching
Latching
Latching
Latching
Latching
Latching
Momentary
Latching
Latching
Latching
Latching
Latching
Latching
Momentary
Latching
Latching
Latching
Latching
Momentary
Latching
Momentary
Latching
Momentary
Momentary
Momentary
Latching
Momentary
Latching
Latching
Latching
Momentary
Latching
Latching
Momentary
Latching
Momentary
Latching
Momentary
Latching
Latching
Latching
Latching
Latching
ALL
Latching
NOTE: Blank switches have two clear square windows on them and require a stick-on graphic to identify
function and allow for custom switches. The graphic labels can be purchased under part numbers in the Switch
Graphic Label Kits Table below.
*These blank switches are normally to be used with Remote Power Modules (RPMs) or advanced logic
functions.
SECTION 19 - PAGE 2
October 2012
f_098
Part Number
Description
3587032C1
3596344C1
3587033C1
3587034C1
3587024C1
3587031C1
f_099
October 2012
SECTION 19 - PAGE 3
f_100
SECTION 19 - PAGE 4
October 2012
Sheet 1 5
Sheet 1
Sheet 2
Sheet 3
Sheet 4
Sheet 5
Sheet 6
3552005C4
2588422C1
First Label
Sheet
First Label
Left Alley
Mangr Cancel
Aux 1
On
Raise Bed
Self Test
Sheet 7
Sheet 8
Sheet 9
Sheet 10
Sheet 11
Sheet 12
Sheet 13
2589327C1
2590999C1
2591000C1
2593674C1
2593676C1
2593677C1
2597868C1
Left Cot
Night Strobe
Hyd Filter
Tank1 Open
Door
Estop
Front
AUX WARN
Sheet 2
BOOM N/STOW
Sheet 4
Quantity of 8
Sheet 2
Sheet 4
Sheet 7
Sheet 4
Sheet 4
Sheet 2
Sheet 2
Sheet 4
Sheet 9
Sheet 5
Sheet 7
Sheet 9
Sheet 9
Sheet 9
Sheet 10
Sheet 11
Sheet 11
Sheet 6
Sheet 13
Sheet 3
Sheet 3
Sheet 3
Sheet 6
Sheet 11
Sheet 11
Sheet 2
AXLE 1 DOWN
AXLE 1 UP
AXLE 2 DOWN
AXLE 2 UP
B LOAD GATE
BACK ALARM
BACKUP LIGHT
BAR LIGHTS
BATH ASSIST
BATH CONFIRM
BATH LIGHT
BATT SAVE
BATTERY ON
BEACON LIGHT
BED UP
BELLY VALVE
BIN LIGHT
BLOWER
BODY LOWER
BODY N/STOW
BODY OVRHT
BODY RAISE
BODY UP
BOOM
BOOM DOWN
BOOM LEFT
Sheet 3
Sheet 3
Sheet 3
Sheet 3
Sheet 7
Sheet 3
Sheet 2
Sheet 5
Sheet 13
Sheet 13
Sheet 13
Sheet 5
Sheet 7
Sheet 2
Sheet 5
Sheet 7
Sheet 1
Sheet 3
Sheet 11
Sheet 9
Sheet 9
Sheet 11
Sheet 11
Sheet 3
Sheet 3
Sheet 3
DECK LIGHT
DEFROST FAN
DEFUEL VALVE
DFROST FAN 1
DFROST FAN 2
DIESEL GEN
DIESEL HEATER
DIESEL PUMP
DIESEL REEL
DIGGER
DIVIDER DOWN
DIVIDER UP
DO NOT MOVE
DOCK LIGHTS
DOME LIGHT
DOOR
DOOR DOWN
Sheet 1
Sheet 7
Sheet 7
Sheet 13
Sheet 13
Sheet 13
Sheet 13
Sheet 11
Sheet 11
Sheet 13
Sheet 5
Sheet 5
Sheet 2 &12
Sheet 10
Sheet 1
Sheet 11
Sheet 12
Sheet 5
BOOM RIGHT
BOOM STOW
BOOM UP
BOOST DOWN
BOOST OPERATE
BOOST UP
BOTTOM LOAD
BOX UP
BRAKE INTLCK
BRAKE LOCK
BRK INT OVRIDE
CAB BACKUP
CAB ROTO
CAB STROBE
CABIN LIGHTS
CAMERA LIGHT
CARGO LIGHT
CEILING LIGHT
CENTER DOME
CHARGE PSI LOW
CHARGR POWER
CHASER FLASH
CHECK ELEC
CHECK FAULTS
CHECK HYBRID
CHUTES
Sheet 3
Sheet 3
Sheet 3
Sheet 9
Sheet 9
Sheet 9
Sheet 7
Sheet 3
Sheet 7
Sheet 2
Sheet 7
Sheet 6
Sheet 1
Sheet 1
Sheet 5
Sheet 3
Sheet 1
Sheet 13
Sheet 11
Sheet 9
Sheet 12
Sheet 9
Sheet 3
Sheet 12
Sheet 9
Sheet 8
EMERG SHTOFF
EMERG STOP
ESPAR HEAT
ESTOP
EXHST FAN
EXT SPEAKR
EXTEND
FAN
FAN 1
FAN 2
FAN HIGH
FAN LOW
FAST IDLE
FILL VALVE
FILTER BYPASS
FLOOD LIGHT
FLOOR HEATER
Sheet 11
Sheet 6
Sheet 4
Sheet 12
Sheet 2
Sheet 11
Sheet 8
Sheet 4
Sheet 11
Sheet 11
Sheet 2
Sheet 2
Sheet 10
Sheet 3
Sheet 6
Sheet 2
Sheet 5
Sheet 8
Sheet 8
Sheet 8
Sheet 8
Sheet 2
Sheet 7
Sheet 1
Sheet 9
Sheet 5
Sheet 7
Sheet 9
Sheet 2
Sheet 2
Sheet 2
Sheet 2
Sheet 5
Sheet 13
October 2012
SECTION 19 - PAGE 5
Sheet 12
Sheet 12
Sheet 12
Sheet 12
Sheet 12
Sheet 12
Sheet 1
Sheet 3
Sheet 5
Sheet 11
Sheet 4
Sheet 11
Sheet 8
Sheet 8
Sheet 8
Sheet 6
Sheet 13
Sheet 8
Sheet 8
Sheet 8
Sheet 9
Sheet 7
DOOR LIGHT
DOOR OPEN
DOOR UP
DOWN
DRAIN VALVE
DRIVE LIGHT
DRIVER ALLEY
DRIVER DOME
DRUM CHRGE
DRUM DISCHRG
DRUM START
DRUM STOP
DUMP CLOSE
DUMP OPEN
DUMP POWER
DUMP VALVE
ELECT HORN
ELECT MAGNET
ELECT SUCTN
EMERG MASTER
EMERG OVRIDE
EMERG PANIC
Sheet 12
Sheet 2
Sheet 12
Sheet 5
Sheet 3
Sheet 2
Sheet 1
Sheet 13
Sheet 8
Sheet 8
Sheet 8
Sheet 8
Sheet 10
Sheet 10
Sheet 7
Sheet 9
Sheet 2
Sheet 12
Sheet 3
Sheet 2
Sheet 13
Sheet 3
FLOOR LIGHTS
FLOOR UNLOAD
FLORES LIGHT
FLOW 1 CLOSE
FLOW 1 OPEN
FLOW 2 CLOSE
FLOW 2 OPEN
FOG LIGHTS
FRONT
FRONT A/C
FRONT ALARM
FRONT CENTER
FRONT FLASH
FRONT LIGHT
FRONT SCENE
FRONT STROBE
FRONT SWEEP
FRONT UNITY
FRONT WARN
FRONT WORK
FRT OW NOZZLE
FT LF ARM DN
Sheet 5
Sheet 9
Sheet 1
Sheet 6
Sheet 6
Sheet 6
Sheet 6
Sheet 11
Sheet 13
Sheet 5
Sheet 13
Sheet 5
Sheet 1
Sheet 1
Sheet 7
Sheet 1
Sheet 12
Sheet 13
Sheet 1
Sheet 13
Sheet 7
Sheet 6
Sheet 6
Sheet 6
Sheet 8
Sheet 11
Sheet 8
Sheet 9
Sheet 11
Sheet 11
Sheet 1
Sheet 8
Sheet 10
Sheet 10
Sheet 7
Sheet 7
Sheet 7
Sheet 10
Sheet 9
Sheet 12
Sheet 5
Sheet 10
Sheet 1
Sheet 13
Sheet 5
Sheet 7
Sheet 6
Sheet 7
Sheet 11
Sheet 8
Sheet 6
Sheet 1
Sheet 5
Sheet 12
Sheet 12
Sheet 12
Sheet 11
Sheet 5
LEFT WARN
LEFT WING
LF DUMP CLOSE
LF DUMP OPEN
LF WEEDSEEKER
LIFT
LIFT ENABLE
LIFT EXTEND
LIFT GATE
LIGHT BAR
LIGHT BOARD
LIGHT TOWER
LO FLO HOSE
LOAD
LOAD MANGR
LOCK
LOCK DOOR
LOCK WINDOW
LOW
LOW PRES
LOW THROTL
LOW VOLTS
LOWER
LOWER BED
LOWER BOX
LOWER IDLE
LOWER LIFT
LOWER PLW LTS
LOWER WARN
LOWER WORK
MACHINE
MANGR CANCEL
MANUAL
MAP LIGHT
MASTER
MASTER HEATER
Sheet 1
Sheet 3
Sheet 6
Sheet 6
Sheet 6
Sheet 5
Sheet 13
Sheet 11
Sheet 3 &5
Sheet 1
Sheet 2
Sheet 7
Sheet 11
Sheet 11
Sheet 2
Sheet 9
Sheet 4
Sheet 9
Sheet 4 &5
Sheet 9
Sheet 7
Sheet 2
Sheet 5
Sheet 5
Sheet 3
Sheet 7
Sheet 12
Sheet 13
Sheet 1
Sheet 1
Sheet 2
Sheet 2
Sheet 11
Sheet 1
Sheet 2
Sheet 13
SECTION 19 - PAGE 6
Sheet 6
Sheet 6
Sheet 6
Sheet 11
Sheet 11
Sheet 9
Sheet 5
Sheet 9
Sheet 2
Sheet 6
Sheet 1
Sheet 11
Sheet 5
Sheet 11
Sheet 11
Sheet 11
Sheet 13
Sheet 13
Sheet 13
Sheet 13
Sheet 9
Sheet 11
Sheet 7
Sheet 4 & 5
Sheet 3
Sheet 9
Sheet 4
Sheet 7
Sheet 9
Sheet 8
Sheet 8
Sheet 8
Sheet 8
Sheet 4
Sheet 8
Sheet 7
October 2012
Sheet 11
Sheet 8
Sheet 9
LEFT SCENE
LEFT SPRAY
LEFT SWEEP
Sheet 1
Sheet 10
Sheet 12
MASTER POWER
MASTER THROTL
MEDIUM IDLE
Sheet 12
Sheet 2
Sheet 10
PURGE
PUSHER DOWN
PUSHER UP
QUICK RAISE
RADIO REMOTE
RAISE BED
RAISE BOX
RAISE IDLE
RAISE LIFT
RAMP ENABLE
REAR
REAR A/C
REAR ALERT
REAR ALLEY
REAR CAMERA
REAR CENTER
REAR CHUTE
REAR CNTRL
REAR COMPT
REAR DELIVRY
Sheet 10
Sheet 8
Sheet 8
Sheet 13
Sheet 8
Sheet 5
Sheet 3
Sheet 7
Sheet 12
Sheet 13
Sheet 13
Sheet 5
Sheet 5
Sheet 1
Sheet 5
Sheet 5
Sheet 7
Sheet 9
Sheet 7
Sheet 10
Sheet 8
Sheet 4
Sheet 10
Sheet 8
Sheet 8
Sheet 13
Sheet 6
Sheet 11
Sheet 12
Sheet 5
Sheet 11
Sheet 8
Sheet 8
Sheet 13
Sheet 7
Sheet 13
Sheet 4
Sheet 2
Sheet 2
Sheet 6
Sheet 4
Qty of 24
Sheet 9
Sheet 5
Sheet 3
Sheet 9
Sheet 1
Sheet 3
Sheet 5
Sheet 3
Sheet 9
Sheet 9
Sheet 9
Sheet 2
Sheet 2
Sheet 6 &13
Sheet 11
Sheet 11
PACKER RIGHT
PANEL LIGHT
PASS ALLEY
PERM LIGHT
PLC POWER
PLOW DOWN
PLOW LEFT
PLOW LIGHT
PLOW RIGHT
PLOW UP
POLE LIGHT
POWER
POWER WINDOW
PRESSURE
PRIMRY WARN
PRINTR POWER
PTO
PTO 1
PTO 2
PTO 3
Sheet 11
Sheet 12
Sheet 1
Sheet 1
Sheet 12
Sheet 3
Sheet 6
Sheet 3
Sheet 6
Sheet 3
Sheet 13
Sheet 5
Sheet 9
Sheet 10
Sheet 1
Sheet 11
Sheet 2
Sheet 12
Sheet 7 & 12
Sheet 12
PTO CURB
Sheet 10
REAR FLASHR
Sheet 2
PTO DIESEL
PTO DRIVER
PTO GAS
PTO GEN
PTO OVRIDE
PTO PASNGR
PTO PUMP
PTO STREET
PUMP
PUMP & ROLL
PUMP ENGD
PUMP HI
PUMP LO
PUMP ONE
PUMP PANEL
PUMP TWO
Sheet 10
Sheet 12
Sheet 10
Sheet 2
Sheet 6
Sheet 12
Sheet 2
Sheet 10
Sheet 3
Sheet 2
Sheet 2
Sheet 10
Sheet 10
Sheet 6
Sheet 2
Sheet 6
REAR FLOOD
REAR GATE
REAR LIGHT
REAR MOOD
REAR SCENE
REAR STROBE
REAR SWEEP
REAR UNITY
REAR WARN
REAR WORK
REEL GATE
REFER FUEL
REFER TEMP
REGEN ON
REMOTE OVRIDE
RESET
Sheet 1
Sheet 6
Sheet 1
Sheet 11
Sheet 1
Sheet 1
Sheet 12
Sheet 13
Sheet 1
Sheet 13
Sheet 6
Sheet 9
Sheet 9
Sheet 12
Sheet 8
Sheet 11
SECND WARN
SELF TEST
SENSOR POWER
SHAKER
SHRED POWER
SHUT DOWN
SIDE DELVRY
SIDE EVAC
SIDE GATE
SIDE WARN
SIREN
SIREN BRAKE
Sheet 1
Sheet 6
Sheet 10
Sheet 3
Sheet 9
Sheet 9
Sheet 10
Sheet 7
Sheet 6
Sheet 1
Sheet 2
Sheet 2
SWIVEL DOWN
SWIVEL UP
TAG DOWN
TAG UP
TAIL GATE
TANK 1 CLOSED
TANK 1 OPEN
TANK 2 CLOSED
TANK 2 OPEN
TANK 3 CLOSED
TANK 3 OPEN
TANK 4 CLOSED
Sheet 9
Sheet 9
Sheet 3&12
Sheet 3&12
Sheet 8
Sheet 10
Sheet 10
Sheet 10
Sheet 10
Sheet 10
Sheet 10
Sheet 10
Sheet 8
Sheet 10
Sheet 1
Sheet 13
Sheet 5
Sheet 7
Sheet 6
Sheet 7
Sheet 11
Sheet 8
Sheet 1
Sheet 5
October 2012
SECTION 19 - PAGE 7
Sheet 12
Sheet 12
Sheet 12
Sheet 11
Sheet 5
Sheet 1
Sheet 10
Sheet 12
Sheet 1
Sheet 3
Sheet 6
Sheet 13
Sheet 1
Sheet 2
Sheet 6
Sheet 6
Sheet 6
Sheet 6
Sheet 7
Sheet 6
Sheet 6
Sheet 6
Sheet 6
Sheet 6
Sheet 3
Sheet 3
SIREN HORN
SLOW FLASH
SLOW IDLE
SPARE
SPOT LIGHT
SPRAY FILL
SPREDR
SPREDR LIGHT
START
START GEN
START REGEN
STEP HEATER
STEP LIGHT
STEP LT CANCEL
STOP
STOP CONFIRM
STOP GEN
STOP HYBRID
STOP REGEN
STOP REQST
STROBE BAR
STROBE LIGHT
SUMMER
SUSP DUMP
SUSP KNEEL
SUSP RAISE
Sheet 2
Sheet 9
Sheet 10
Sheet 3
Sheet 4
Sheet 7
Sheet 5
Sheet 2
Sheet 6
Sheet 7
Sheet 12
Sheet 7
Sheet 1
Sheet 1
Sheet 6
Sheet 13
Sheet 7
Sheet 9
Sheet 12
Sheet 13
Sheet 1
Sheet 1
Sheet 8
Sheet 7
Sheet 13
Sheet 7 & 13
TANK 4 OPEN
TANK 5 CLOSED
TANK 5 OPEN
TANK 6 CLOSED
TANK 6 OPEN
TANK 7 CLOSED
TANK 7 OPEN
TANK 8 CLOSED
TANK 8 OPEN
TANK EMPTY
TANK HEAT
TANK VENTS
TARP UNWIND
TARP WIND
T-GATE DOWN
T-GATE UP
THROTL
TIRE PRES
TOOL CIRCUIT
TOWER DOWN
TOWER POWER
TOWER UP
TRAFFC CNTRL
TRAILER ACTIVE
TRANS HEAT
TRAP LIGHT
Sheet 10
Sheet 10
Sheet 10
Sheet 10
Sheet 10
Sheet 10
Sheet 10
Sheet 10
Sheet 10
Sheet 5
Sheet 9
Sheet 10
Sheet 3
Sheet 3
Sheet 8
Sheet 8
Sheet 13
Sheet 9
Sheet 13
Sheet 10
Sheet 7
Sheet 10
Sheet 10
Sheet 8
Sheet 10
Sheet 3
Sheet 13
Sheet 5
Sheet 6
Sheet 2
Sheet 9
Sheet 3
Sheet 7
Sheet 7
Sheet 11
Sheet 7
Sheet 8
Qty of 2
Sheet 8
Sheet 1
Sheet 3
Sheet 2
Sheet 12
Sheet 12
Sheet 5
Sheet 7
Sheet 11
Sheet 9
Sheet 4
Sheet 9
Sheet 5
VAC ON
VACUUM
VAN DOWN
VAN UP
VAPOR PUMP
VAPOR VALVE
VOLUME
WARN 1
WARN 2
WARN 3
Sheet 12
Sheet 8
Sheet 5
Sheet 5
Sheet 11
Sheet 7
Sheet 10
Sheet 12
Sheet 12
Sheet 12
WELDER LIGHT
WHEEL CHAIR
WHEEL CHOCK
WIG WAG
WIGWAG FLASH
WINCH
WINCH IN
WINCH OUT
WINDOW AJAR
WING LIGHTS
Sheet 13
WATER
Sheet 8
WINTER
UPPER WARN
UPPER WORK
VAC OFF
Sheet 1
Sheet 1
Sheet 12
WATER CANNON
WATER J-STICK
WATER PUMP
Sheet 13
Sheet 13
Sheet 5
WINTER SUMMER
WORK LIGHT
XFER CASE
SECTION 19 - PAGE 8
October 2012
f_101
October 2012
SECTION 19 - PAGE 9
f_102
SECTION 19 - PAGE 10
October 2012
f_103
October 2012
SECTION 19 - PAGE 11
f_104
SECTION 19 - PAGE 12
October 2012
ID
TEM_Dual1_
Output1_
Fuse_Param
1988
TEM_Dual1_
Output2_
Fuse_Param
1989
Description
This is the maximum current
Dual 1 Output 1 is allowed to
source before the virtual fusing
turns the output off.
This is the maximum current
Dual 1 Output 2 is allowed to
source before the virtual fusing
turns the output off.
Default
Units
Min
Max
Set
20
20
0.1
20
20
0.1
WIRING INFORMATION
This feature requires the customer to supply the wiring that runs from the pins labeled
DUAL_OUTPUT_SWITCH_Output1 and DUAL_OUTPUT_SWITCH_Output2, on the brown 8-pin RPM output
connector, to the customer-installed feature that requires the load.
September 2012
SECTION 20 - PAGE 1
f_105
TESTING
1. Depress the switch.
2. Verify that the desired voltage is being pulled from the RPM outputs labeled
DUAL_OUTPUT_SWITCH_Output1 and DUAL_OUTPUT_SWITCH_Output2 (as programmed by the
Diamond Logic Builder software).
SECTION 20 - PAGE 2
September 2012
Interlocking Condition
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
September 2012
SECTION 20 - PAGE 3
f_106
* TEM_Aux1_Interlock_Latches_Off
Normally, if the output is deactivated because the interlocking condition is not met, the output will re-activate as
soon as the interlocking condition is re-established as long as the switch is still on. If this behavior is not
desirable, the parameter TEM_Aux1_Interlock_Latches_Off parameter can be set. When it is set and the
output is deactivated because the interlocking condition is not met, the output will not reactivate when the
interlocking condition is re-established even if the switch is still on. To re-activate the output in this case, the
switch must be re-cycled (flipped off and then on again).
* TEM_Aux1_Speed_Interlock_Param
If TEM_Aux1_Misc_Interlock_Param is set to 9 or 10, the speed-interlock parameter
(TEM_Aux1_Speed_Interlock_Param) must also be set. This parameter must be set to the actual speed to use
in the condition selected by TEM_Aux1_Misc_Interlock_Param (default unit for this parameter is MPH). The
speed parameter is only used if TEM_Aux1_Misc_Interlock_Param is set to 9 or 10.
Example: If you want the output to only come on when the vehicle is traveling over 15 MPH, you would set
TEM_Aux1_Misc_Interlock_Param to 9 and set TEM_Aux1_Speed_Interlock_Param to 15 MPH.
* TEM_Aux1_Gear_Interlock_Param
If TEM_Aux1_Misc_Interlock_Param is set to 13 or 14 and the vehicle has an automatic transmission, the
gear-interlock parameter (TEM_Aux1_Gear_Interlock_Param) must also be set. This parameter must be set to
the transmission gear to use in the condition selected by TEM_Aux1_Misc_Interlock_Param. The transmission
gear is set as follows:
SECTION 20 - PAGE 4
September 2012
Transmission Gear
125
Transmission in Neutral
126
127
128
125 + x
124
123
125 y
ID
Description
Default
Units
2006
Min
Max
Set
Off
On/Off
2007
30
Mph
100
2008
Number
250
2009
20
20
0.1
2033
10
List
WIRING INFORMATION
The wiring out of the pin labeled INTERLOCKED_SWITCH_AUX1_Output on the Brown 8-pin RPM output
connector is customer supplied.
September 2012
SECTION 20 - PAGE 5
f_107
TESTING
1. Depress switch.
2. Verify that the RPM output labeled INTERLOCKED_SWITCH_AUX1_Output is obtaining the desired
voltage (as programmed by the Diamond Logic Builder software).
3. Verify the functionality of the 30 Mph interlock by violating the parameter and determine that the output
shuts off.
4. Test all other interlocks by violating the programmable parameters to see if the output shuts off.
SECTION 20 - PAGE 6
September 2012
September 2012
SECTION 20 - PAGE 7
Interlocking Condition
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
SECTION 20 - PAGE 8
September 2012
f_106
Transmission Gear
125
Transmission in Neutral
126
127
128
125 + x
124
123
125 y
September 2012
SECTION 20 - PAGE 9
Interlocking Condition
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
SECTION 20 - PAGE 10
September 2012
f_106
Transmission Gear
125
Transmission in Neutral
126
127
128
125 + x
124
123
125 y
September 2012
SECTION 20 - PAGE 11
ID
Description
Default
Units
2006
Off
On/Off
2007
30
2008
2009
2033
2010
Min
Max
Set
Mph
100
Number
250
20
20
0.1
10
List
Off
On/Off
2011
30
Mph
100
2012
Number
250
2013
20
20
0.1
2034
10
List
WIRING INFORMATION
The wiring out of the pin labeled INTERLOCKED_SWITCH_AUX1_Output on the Brown 8-pin RPM output
connector is customer supplied.
The wiring out of the pin labeled INTERLOCKED_SWITCH_AUX2_Output on the Brown 8-pin RPM output
connector is customer supplied.
SECTION 20 - PAGE 12
September 2012
f_110
TESTING
1. Depress switch.
2. Verify that the RPM output labeled INTERLOCKED_SWITCH_AUX1_Output is obtaining the desired
voltage (as programmed by the Diamond Logic Builder software).
3. Verify the functionality of the 30 Mph interlock by violating the parameter and determine that the output
shuts off.
4. Test all other interlocks can by violating the programmable parameters to see if the output shuts off
5. Depress the second switch.
6. Verify that the RPM output labeled INTERLOCKED_SWITCH_AUX2_Output is obtaining the desired
voltage (as programmed by the Diamond Logic Builder software).
7. Verify the functionality of the 30 MPH interlock by violating the parameter and determine that the output
shuts off.
8. Test all other interlocks can by violating the programmable parameters to see if the output shuts off
September 2012
SECTION 20 - PAGE 13
SECTION 20 - PAGE 14
September 2012
ID
Description
Default
Units
Min
Max
Step
20
20
0.1
Off
On/Off
NA
NA
NA
WIRING INFORMATION
Customer may mount a switch and install the wiring into the pin labeled 3POS_SWITCH_AUX1_Input in the
black 23-pin RPM input connector. Installation of the remote switch is optional with this feature (see Diamond
Logic Builder for input pin location).
Customer must install wiring from the pin labeled 3POS_SWITCH_AUX1_Output brown 8-pin RPM output
connector to the electrical load that is to be controlled (see Diamond Logic Builder for output pin location).
f_111
TESTING
1. This feature allows the customer the ability to activate the output when the IGN key is turned from OFF to
ACCESSORY or IGN. This functionality is obtained by turning programmable parameters
(TEM_Aux1_w_Ext_Switch_Init_State ON.
2. Activate the first remote Body Builder installed switch to 12 volts by using a momentary switch action.
3. Verify that the RPM output labeled 3POS_SWITCH_AUX1_Output is providing the battery volts at rated
current levels (as programmed in Diamond Logic Builder).
4. Verify that the green switch indicator light comes on.
5. Verify that the RPM input labeled 3POS_SWITCH_AUX1_Input is receiving battery volts from the
customer-mounted switch (as programmed in Diamond Logic Builder).
6. Deactivate the first remote Body Builder installed switch by providing a momentary switch action to GND.
September 2012
SECTION 20 - PAGE 15
Select software feature code 595AKD using Diamond Logic Builder (see local dealer).
Programmable Parameters must be set using the Diamond Logic Builder (see local dealer)
The 3-position momentary switch with latching software must be installed in the in-cab switch pack.
The customer must install wiring from the RPM output to the load they wish to control.
The customer may mount a remote switch and install the wiring into the RPM input.
SECTION 20 - PAGE 16
September 2012
ID
TEM_Aux1_
w_Ext_Sw_
Fuse_Level
1998
TEM_Aux1_
w_Ext_Switch_
Init_State
2032
TEM_Aux2_
w_Ext_Sw_
Fuse_Level
2106
TEM_Aux2_
w_Ext_Switch_
Init_State
2142
Description
This is the level above which the
RPM will fuse the TEM Auxiliary
output with external switch.
This programmable parameter sets
the initial State of RPM channel used
with TEM Auxiliary with external
switch #1.
This is the level above which the
RPM will fuse the TEM Auxiliary
output #2 with external switch.
This programmable parameter sets
the initial State of RPM channel used
with TEM Auxiliary with external
switch #2.
Default
Units
Min
Max
Step
20
20
0.1
Off
On/Off
NA
NA
NA
20
20
0.1
Off
On/Off
NA
NA
NA
WIRING INFORMATION
Customer may mount a switch and install the wiring into the pin labeled 3POS_SWITCH_AUX1_Input in the
black 23-pin RPM input connector. Installation of the remote switch is optional with this feature (see Diamond
Logic Builder for input pin location).
Customer may mount a switch and install the wiring into the pin labeled 3POS_SWITCH_AUX2_Input in the
black 23-pin RPM input connector. Installation of the remote switch is optional with this feature (see Diamond
Logic Builder for input pin location).
Customer must install wiring from the pin labeled 3POS_SWITCH_AUX1_Output brown 8-pin RPM output
connector to the electrical load that is to be controlled (see Diamond Logic Builder for output pin location).
Customer must install wiring from the pin labeled 3POS_SWITCH_AUX2_Output brown 8-pin RPM output
connector to the electrical load that is to be controlled (see Diamond Logic Builder for output pin location).
September 2012
SECTION 20 - PAGE 17
f_112
TESTING
1. This feature allows the customer the ability to activate the output when the IGN key is turned from off to
accessory or IGN. This functionality is obtained by turning the programmable parameters
(TEM_Aux1_w_Ext_Switch_Init_State and TEM_Aux2_w_Ext_Switch_Init_State) on.
2. Activate the first remote Body Builder installed switch to 12 volts by using a momentary switch action.
3. Verify that the RPM output labeled 3POS_SWITCH_AUX1_Output is providing the battery volts at rated
current levels (as programmed in Diamond Logic Builder).
4. Verify that the green switch indicator light comes on.
5. Verify that the RPM input labeled 3POS_SWITCH_AUX1_Input is receiving battery volts from the
customer-mounted switch (as programmed in Diamond Logic Builder).
6. Deactivate the first remote Body Builder-installed switch by providing a momentary switch action to GND.
7. Verify that the RPM output goes OFF.
8. Activate the first in-cab switch.
9. Verify that the RPM output labeled 3POS_SWITCH_AUX1_Output is providing the battery volts (as
programmed in Diamond Logic Builder).
10. Verify that the green switch indicator light comes on.
11. Deactivate the first in-cab switch.
12. Activate the second remote Body Builder installed switch to 12 volts by using a momentary switch action.
13. Verify that the RPM output labeled 3POS_SWITCH_AUX2_Output is providing the battery volts at rated
current levels (as programmed in Diamond Logic Builder).
14. Verify that the green switch indicator light comes on.
15. Verify that the RPM input labeled 3POS_SWITCH_AUX2_Input is receiving battery volts from the
customer-mounted switch (as programmed in Diamond Logic Builder).
SECTION 20 - PAGE 18
September 2012
Select software feature code 595AKE using Diamond Logic Builder (see local dealer).
Programmable parameters must be set using Diamond Logic Builder (see local dealer).
The 3-position momentary switch with latching software must be installed in the in-cab switch pack.
The customer must install wiring from the RPM outputs to the loads that are to be controlled
The customer may mount a switch (12 volts active and GND de-active) and install the wiring into the RPM
inputs (Use the Diamond Logic Builder software to determine switch and pin location assignments).
September 2012
SECTION 20 - PAGE 19
ID
TEM_Aux1_
w_Ext_Sw_
Fuse_Level
1998
TEM_Aux1_
w_Ext_Switch_
Init_State
2032
TEM_Aux2_
w_Ext_Sw_
Fuse_Level
2106
TEM_Aux2_
w_Ext_Switch_
Init_State
2142
TEM_Aux3_
w_Ext_Sw_
Fuse_Level
2107
TEM_Aux3_
w_Ext_Switch_
Init_State
2143
Description
This is the level above which the
RPM will fuse the TEM Auxiliary
output #1 with external switch.
This programmable parameter sets
the initial State of RPM channel used
with TEM Auxiliary with external
switch #1.
This is the level above which the
RPM will fuse the TEM Auxiliary
output #2 with external switch.
This programmable parameter sets
the initial State of RPM channel used
with TEM Auxiliary with external
switch #2.
This is the level above which the
RPM will fuse the TEM Auxiliary
output #3 with external switch.
This programmable parameter sets
the initial State of RPM channel used
with TEM Auxiliary with external
switch #3.
Default
Units
Min
Max
Step
20
20
0.1
Off
On/Off
NA
NA
NA
20
20
0.1
Off
On/Off
NA
NA
NA
20
20
0.1
Off
On/Off
NA
NA
NA
WIRING INFORMATION
Customer may mount a switch and install the wiring into the pin labeled 3POS_SWITCH_AUX1_Input in the
black 23-pin RPM input connector. Installation of the remote switch is optional with this feature (see Diamond
Logic Builder for input pin location).
Customer may mount a switch and install the wiring into the pin labeled 3POS_SWITCH_AUX2_Input in the
black 23-pin RPM input connector. Installation of the remote switch is optional with this feature (see Diamond
Logic Builder for input pin location).
SECTION 20 - PAGE 20
September 2012
f_113
TESTING
1. This feature allows the customer the ability to activate the output when the IGN key is turned from off to
accessory or IGN. This functionality is obtained by turning programmable parameters
(TEM_Aux1_w_Ext_Switch_Init_State, TEM_Aux2_w_Ext_Switch_Init_State or
TEM_Aux3_w_Ext_Switch_Init_State) on.
2. Activate the first remote Body Builder installed switch to 12 volts by using a momentary switch action.
3. Verify that the RPM output labeled 3POS_SWITCH_AUX1_Output is providing the battery volts at rated
current levels (as programmed in Diamond Logic Builder).
4. Verify that the green switch indicator light comes on.
5. Verify that the RPM input labeled 3POS_SWITCH_AUX1_Input is receiving battery volts from the
customer-mounted switch (as programmed in Diamond Logic Builder).
September 2012
SECTION 20 - PAGE 21
Select software feature code 595AKG using Diamond Logic Builder (see local dealer).
Programmable parameters must be set using Diamond Logic Builder (see local dealer).
The 3-position momentary switch with latching software must be installed in the in-cab switch pack.
The customer must install wiring from the RPM outputs to the loads that are to be controlled
The customer may mount a switch (12 volts active and GND de-active) and install the wiring into the RPM
inputs (use Diamond Logic Builder to determine switch and pin location assignments).
SECTION 20 - PAGE 22
September 2012
October 2012
f_114
SECTION 21 - PAGE 1
SECTION 21 - PAGE 2
October 2012
ID
2160
Description
This parameter is used to set the voltage
level that indicates when the tail gate alert
should be active.
Default
Units
Min
Max
List
Step
2165
Off
On/Off
2167
List
List
20
10
60
10
10
60
2168
TEM_Tail_
Gate_Alarm_
Period
2172
TEM_Tail_
Gate_Alarm_
Timeout
2175
WIRING INFORMATION
**If the truck has a manual transmission, to interlock indicator lights and alarm with the transmission, splice a
wire off of the reverse light circuit and run that wire into a pin on the black 23-pin RPM input connector (see the
Diamond Logic Builder software for correct pin and switch locations). This wire will indicate to the Body
Controller (BC) that the truck is in reverse. This is only required if the customer wishes to interlock the
functionality of the indicator lights and audible alarm with reverse (and they have a manual transmission).
The customer must run a wire from the tailgate switch to the pin labeled Tail_Gate_Open_Input on the black
23-pin input connector on the RPM (See the Diamond Logic Builder software for correct pin locations).
The customer must run a wire from the rear alert switch to the pin labeled Rear_Alert_Switch_Input on the
black 23-pin input connector on the RPM (See the Diamond Logic Builder software for correct pin
locations).
October 2012
SECTION 21 - PAGE 3
f_115
TESTING
1. Set park brake.
2. Open the tailgate.
3. Verify that the input labeled Tail_Gate_Open_Input is receiving the correct voltage (as programmed in the
Diamond Logic Builder software).
4. Verify that the red Gate Open indicator light in the switch pack comes on.
5. Release park brake.
6. Verify that indicator light flashes and audible alarm sounds and works according to the set programmable
parameters seen above.
7. Close tail gate.
8. Reset park brake.
9. Activate Rear Alert switch.
10. Verify that the input labeled Rear_Alert_Switch_Input is receiving the correct voltage (as programmed in
the Diamond Logic Builder software).
11. Verify that the red Rear Alert indicator light in the switch pack comes on and an audible alarm sounds.
SECTION 21 - PAGE 4
October 2012
Requires Warning Assy. 3587024C1 and LED 3587031C1 be added to the switch pack if this feature is
added aftermarket
Software feature codes 595AKP and 595AMD must be enabled using the Diamond Logic Builder software
(see local dealer). NOTE: these features can be added individually in the field.
Set programmable parameters for software feature codes using the Diamond Logic Builder software (See
Local Dealer).
Install the wiring from tailgate switch into a pin on the black 23-pin input connector on the RPM (See the
Diamond Logic Builder software for pin locations).
Install the wiring from rear alert switch into a pin on the black 23-pin input connector on the RPM (See the
Diamond Logic Builder software for pin locations).
Customer must install indicator light labels in switch pack (indicator graphics or suitable substitutes can be
used from the graphics sheets that come with the RPM kit).
October 2012
SECTION 21 - PAGE 5
f_116
PROGRAMMABLE PARAMETERS
Required software feature codes: 595AKR, 595AKS
SECTION 21 - PAGE 6
October 2012
ID
2061
2074
Description
If this parameter is set, the audible alarm
for the boom-not- stowed warning light
will be inhibited.
If this parameter is set, the audible alarm
for the outriggers deployed warning light
will be inhibited.
Default
Units
Off
On/Off
Off
On/Off
Min
Max
2150
List
2151
List
Step
WIRING INFORMATION
The customer must run a wire from the customer-mounted Outriggers out of Stow switch to the pin labeled
Outrig_Not_Stow_Input on the black 23-pin input connector on the RPM (see the Diamond Logic Builder
software for correct pin locations).
The customer must run a wire from the customer-mounted Boom out of Stow switch to the pin labeled
Boom_Not_Stow_Input on the black 23-pin input connector on the RPM (see the Diamond Logic Builder
software for correct pin locations).
October 2012
SECTION 21 - PAGE 7
f_117
TESTING
1. Set the park brake.
2. Take boom out of stow.
3. Verify that the RPM input labeled Boom_Not_Stow_Input is receiving the correct active state voltage (as
programmed in the Diamond Logic Builder software).
4. Verify that the boom up indicator light is on constantly.
5. Take off the parking brake (with boom still out of stow).
6. Verify that the boom up indicator light is now flashing and the audible alarm is sounding.
7. Set park brake and put boom back in stow.
8. Put outriggers down.
9. Verify that the RPM input labeled Outrig_Not_Stow_Input is receiving the correct active state voltage (as
programmed or the Diamond Logic Builder software).
10. Verify that the outrig out indicator light is on constantly.
11. Take off the parking brake (with outriggers still down).
12. Verify that the outrig out indicator light is now flashing and the audible alarm is sounding.
SECTION 21 - PAGE 8
October 2012
f_118
October 2012
SECTION 21 - PAGE 9
Description
Allows the selection of one of four beeper
2259 cadences 0 = Off, 1 = 5 fast beeps, 2 = 3
slow beeps, 3 = continuous beeps
Allows the selection of one of four beeper
2260207 cadences 0 = Off, 1 = 5 fast beeps, 2 = 3
4
slow beeps, 3 = continuous beeps
This parameter selects the active state of
2261 the BODY UP RPM input. 0 = Open, 1 =
GND, 3 = 12 volts
Allows selection of one of four beeper
2262 cadences 0 = Off, 1 = 5 fast beeps, 2 = 3
slow beeps, 3 = continuous beeps
Allows the selection of one of four beeper
2263 cadences 0 = Off, 1 = 5 fast beeps, 2 = 3
slow beeps, 3 = continuous beeps
This parameter is used to set the voltage
level that indicates when the tailgate alert
2160
should be active. 0 = Open, 1 = GND, 3 =
12V
SECTION 21 - PAGE 10
ID
Default
Units
Min
Max
Step
List
List
List
List
List
List
October 2012
f_119
WIRING INFORMATION
The customer must run a wire from the customer-mounted Gate Open switch to the pin labeled
Tail_Gate_Open_Input on the black 23-pin input connector on the RPM (see the Diamond Logic Builder
software for correct pin locations).
The customer must run a wire from the customer-mounted Body Up switch to the pin labeled
TEM_Body_Up_Signal on the black 23-pin input connector on the RPM (see the Diamond Logic Builder
software for correct pin locations).
TESTING
1. Set park brake.
2. Open the tailgate.
3. Verify that the input labeled TEM_Tail_Gate_Input_Active_State input is receiving the correct voltage (as
programmed in the Diamond Logic Builder software).
4. Verify that the Red Gate Open indicator light in the switch pack comes on.
5. Release park brake.
6. Verify that indicator light flashes and audible alarm sounds and works according to the set programmable
parameters seen above.
7. Close tailgate.
8. Reset park brake.
9. Raise the body.
10. Verify that the input labeled TEM_Body_Up_Input_Active_State is receiving the correct voltage (as
programmed in the Diamond Logic Builder software).
11. Verify that the red Body Up indicator light in the switch pack comes on, and an audible alarm sounds.
12. Reset park brake.
October 2012
SECTION 21 - PAGE 11
SECTION 21 - PAGE 12
October 2012
October 2012
SECTION 21 - PAGE 13
f_120
Switch
TESTING
1. Create Advanced Logic in Diamond Logic Builder to turn each light ON using RPM inputs for each light to
be tested.
2. Use indicator lights as outputs
3. Apply template to vehicle
4. Program the vehicle with the template created
5. Turn on RPM inputs as needed and check indicator lights
SECTION 21 - PAGE 14
October 2012
WIRING INFORMATION
For wiring information for this feature, see Circuit Diagram Manual S08322, Chapter 10, Chassis Accessories,
Aux Inputs and Drivers.
TESTING
Use Diamond Logic Builder software to program and test drivers and inputs.
October 2012
SECTION 22 - PAGE 1
WIRING INFORMATION
For wiring information for this feature, see Circuit Diagram Manual S08322, Chapter 10, Chassis Accessories,
Aux Inputs and Drivers.
TESTING
Use Diamond Logic Builder software to program and test drivers and inputs.
SECTION 22 - PAGE 2
October 2012
Circuit Number
Gauge
Color
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
RBTEM1
RBTEM2
RBTEM3
RBTEM4
RBTEM5
RBTEM6
RBTEM7
RBTEM8
16
16
16
16
16
16
16
16
Gray
Gray
Gray
Gray
Gray
Gray
Gray
Gray
f_190
October 2012
SECTION 22 - PAGE 3
3601924C1
1689499C1
f_191
SECTION 22 - PAGE 4
October 2012
ALARMS
If TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_Alarms parameter is turned on, then an audible alarm will sound in the cab if the
primary air pressure drops below the value specified by TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_Alarm_Limit.
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Run_Alarms is turned on, then an alarm will sound if the PTO is engaged while the engine is
turned off.
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_Alarms is turned on, then an alarm will sound if the PTO is engaged and the engine
speed is over the value set by TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_Alarm_Limit
October 2012
SECTION 23 - PAGE 1
ID
TEM_PTO_Air_
Pres_Alarms
2138
TEM_PTO_Air_
Pres_Alarm_Limit
TEM_PTO_
Eng_Run_ Alarms
TEM_PTO_
Eng_Spd_
Alarm_Limit
Description
If this parameter is 1, an alarm will sound if the
PTO is engaged and the air pressure is below
TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_Alarm_Limit
Default
Min
Max
Step
Off
NA
NA
NA
2139
See TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_Alarms
0 psi
500
2137
Off
NA
NA
NA
2136
1400 RPM
5000
0.1
On
NA
NA
NA
Off
NA
NA
NA
Off
NA
NA
NA
On
NA
NA
NA
5 MPH
100
TEM_PTO_
Eng_Spd_ Alarms
2135
TEM_PTO_
Non_Neut_ Alarms
2132
TEM_PTO_
Pk_Brake_ Alarms
2131
TEM_PTO_
Veh_Spd_ Alarms
2133
TEM_PTO_
Veh_Spd_
Alarm_Limit
2134
OTHER PARAMETERS
The TEM_RPM_PTO_Engaged_Param parameter indicates the active state that the Body Controller (BC) will
read as active for the TEM PTO feedback switch. This active state will be used to indicate when the PTO is
engaged.
0 = Input active when open circuit
1 = Input active when grounded
3 = Input active when at 12V
Table 118
Parameter
TEM_PTO_Air_
Pres_Alarms
ID
2147
Description
Active State for the TEM PTO engagement
feedback switch.
Default
Min
Max
Step
List
List
List
WIRING INFORMATION
Please use the Diamond Logic Builder software to determine pin locations for RPM inputs.
The wiring to the RPM input is customer supplied.
A wire must be connected from the Body Builder-installed PTO feedback switch to the pin labeled
PTO_Feedback_Switch in the black 23-pin RPM input connector (J3).
SECTION 23 - PAGE 2
October 2012
f_121
Part Number
2585651C91
2585423C9
NOTE: The following connectors are optional because they are already provided with the RPMs.
This information is given so that the Body Builder could purchase connectors in the event that the original
connectors were damaged or lost, or so that the Body Builder can pre-fabricate a wire harness.
October 2012
SECTION 23 - PAGE 3
3548934C1
Connector, Body, Brown 8Way RPM Output
3534163C1 12 Gauge
3535931C1 14 Gauge
3535930C1 16 & 18 Gauge
3548945C1 12 & 14 Gauge
3535937C1 16 & 18 Gauge
3548943C1
3573833C1
3535938C1
2585981C91
Connector, Body, Black 23-Way RPM Input Kit
1698937C1
N/A
N/A
N/A
Built into the connector
SECTION 23 - PAGE 4
October 2012
f_122
F_123
TESTING
Verify that the RPM input labeled PTO_Feedback_Switch (pin position specified by the Diamond Logic
Builder software) is receiving the correct voltage (12V or Ground (GND)) as specified by the programmable
parameter 2147 in the Diamond Logic Builder software.
Make certain that the PTO indicator light in the gauge cluster illuminates by engaging the PTO.
The audible alarm can be tested by activating a vehicle condition that will sound the alarm based upon the
settings of the programmable parameters. For example, if the park brake interlock is programmed on, release
the park brake and engage the PTO. The audible alarms should sound with continuous beeps.
October 2012
SECTION 23 - PAGE 5
ENGAGEMENT
These parameters set rules that must be met in order for the PTO to be engaged.
If TEM_PTO_Brake_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the brake pedal must be depressed in order
for the PTO to engage.
If TEM_PTO_Cltch_Engmnt_Inhib parameter turned on, then the clutch pedal must be depressed for the PTO
to engage.
SECTION 23 - PAGE 6
October 2012
October 2012
SECTION 23 - PAGE 7
ID
Description
Default
Min
Max
Step
2095
Off
NA
NA
NA
2094
Off
NA
NA
NA
2096
Off
NA
NA
NA
On
NA
NA
NA
1000 RPM
100
5000
On
NA
NA
NA
Off
NA
NA
NA
Off
NA
NA
NA
Off
NA
NA
NA
2089
2088
2087
100
2099
Off
NA
NA
NA
DISENGAGEMENT
These parameters set the conditions under which the PTO will be disengaged.
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Run_Disengages parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the engine is
turned off.
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_Disengages parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the engine
speed rises above the value set by TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_DisEng_Limit.
If TEM_PTO_ Non_Neut _Disengages parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the
transmission is taken out of neutral.
If TEM_PTO_Pk_Brake_Disengages parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the Park Brake
is released.
If TEM_PTO_Veh_Spd_Disengages parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the vehicle
speed is over the valued specified by TEM_PTO_Veh_Spd_DisEng_Limit.
If TEM_PTO_Ext_Input_Disengages is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the external input
designated for this purpose is active.
If TEM_PTO_Mast_Switch_Disengages is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the vehicle master
switch is not ON.
SECTION 23 - PAGE 8
October 2012
ID
Description
Default
Min
Max
Step
2114
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
2113
1400 RPM
5000
2112
On
N/A
N/A
N/A
2109
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
2108
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
2110
On
N/A
N/A
N/A
2111
5 MPH
100
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
RE-ENGAGEMENT
These parameters set the conditions under which the PTO can be re-engaged.
NOTE: All re-engagement parameters should be set to 0 with Lectra-Shift PTOs to prevent gear grind and
damage to the transmission.
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Run_Allow_ReEng parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be reengaged (after
disengagement due to engine stopping) when the engine is restarted.
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_Allow_ReEng parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be reengaged (after
disengagement due to engine overspeed) when the engine speed falls below
TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_Engmnt_Limit.
If TEM_PTO_Key_State_Allow_ReEng parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be allowed to reengage when
the key state is returned to run.
If TEM_PTO_Non_Neut_Allow_ReEng parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be reengaged (after
disengagement due to transmission out of neutral) when the transmission is placed back into neutral.
If TEM_PTO_Pk_Brake_Allow_ReEng parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be reengaged (after
disengagement due to park brake released) when the park brake is reapplied.
If TEM_PTO_Veh_Spd_Allow_ReEng parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be reengaged (after
disengagement due to the vehicle being over the vehicle speed value) when the vehicle speed is falls
TEM_PTO_Veh_Spd_Engmnt_Limit.
If TEM_PTO_Mast_Switch_Allow_ReEng is turned on, then the PTO will be reengaged after a disengage due
to the master switch being turned off when the master switch is turned on again.
If TEM_PTO_Ext_Input_Allow_ReEng is turned on, then the PTO will be reengaged after a disengage due to
the designated external input when the external input is no longer active.
October 2012
SECTION 23 - PAGE 9
ID
2122
TEM_PTO_
Eng_Spd_
Allow_ReEng
2120
TEM_PTO_Key_
State_ Allow_
ReEng
2069
TEM_PTO_
Non_Neut_
Allow_ReEng
2148
TEM_PTO_
Pk_Brake_
Allow_ReEng
2149
TEM_PTO_
Veh_Spd_
Allow_ReEng
2119
TEM_PTO_Mast_
Switch_Allow_ReEn 2123
g
TEM_PTO_Ext_
Input_Allow_ReEng
2121
Description
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be reengaged
after disengagement due to the engine stopping
when the engine is restarted.
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be reengaged
after disengagement due to engine overspeed
when the engine speed is below
TEM_PTO_Eng_ Spd_Engmnt_ Limit.
If this parameter is set, the PTO will be allowed to
reengage when the key state is returned to run.
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be reengaged
after disengagement due to transmission out of
neutral when the transmission is placed back into
neutral.
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be reengaged
after disengagement due to park brake released
when the park brake is reapplied.
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be reengaged
after disengagement due to vehicle overspeed
when the vehicle speed is below
TEM_PTO_Veh_ Spd_Engmnt_ Limit.
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be reengaged
after a disengage due to the master switch being
turned off when the master switch is turned on
again
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be reengaged
after a disengage due to the designated external
input when the external input is no longer active
Default
Min
Max
Step
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
ALARMS
These parameters utilize the gauge cluster to sound an alarm to the driver when certain programmable
parameters are violated.
If TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_Alarms parameter is turned on, then an alarm will sound if the PTO is engaged and the
air pressure is below the value set by TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_Alarm_Limit.
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_Alarms parameter is turned on, then an alarm will sound if the PTO is engaged and the
engine speed is over the value set by TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_Alarm_Limit.
If TEM_PTO_Non_Neut_Alarms parameter is turned on, then an audible alarm will sound if the PTO is
engaged and the transmission is taken out of neutral.
If TEM_PTO_Pk_Brake_Alarms parameter is turned on, then an audible alarm will sound if the PTO is engaged
and the park brake is released.
If TEM_PTO_Veh_Spd_Alarms parameter is turned on, then an audible alarm will sound if the PTO is engaged
and the vehicle speed is about the value set by TEM_PTO_Veh_Spd_Alarm_Limit.
SECTION 23 - PAGE 10
October 2012
ID
Description
If this parameter is 1, an alarm will sound if the
PTO is engaged and the air pressure is below
Default
Min
Max
Step
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
2139
SeeTEM_PTO_Air_Pres_Alarms
0 psi
500
2137
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
2136
1400 RPM
5000
0.1
On
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
On
N/A
N/A
N/A
5 mph
100
2138
TEM_PTO_
Eng_Spd_ Alarms
2135
TEM_PTO_
Non_Neut_ Alarms
2132
TEM_PTO_
Pk_Brake_ Alarms
2131
TEM_PTO_
Veh_Spd_ Alarms
2133
TEM_PTO_
Veh_Spd_
Alarm_Limit
2134
OTHER PARAMETERS
The TEM_PTO_Retaining_Solenoid_Fuse parameter is the fusing value for the Remote Power Module output
feeding the retaining coil that holds the electric solenoid in the engaged position. If current exceeds this value,
the BC will turn off the output.
The TEM_PTO_Lectra_Shift_Max_Retries parameter allows the customer to establish the maximum number of
times that the operator can request a PTO engagement per key cycle.
The TEM_PTO_Lectra_Shift_Retry_Time parameter sets the time between a failed engagement attempt and
the time that the operator can attempt to engage the PTO again.
The TEM_PTO_Allowed_Engagement_Time parameter sets the maximum time allowed for the solenoid to
make one engagement attempt.
The TEM_RPM_PTO_Engaged_Param parameter indicates the state that the BC will read as active for the
TEM PTO feedback switch (as it goes into the RPM input). This active state will be used to tell the BC when the
PTO is engaged.
0 = Input active when open circuit
1 = Input active when grounded
3 = Input active when at 12V
October 2012
SECTION 23 - PAGE 11
ID
Description
Default
Min
Max
Step
2022
20 Amps
20
0.1
2058
0 Retries
65535
2059
600
Seconds
600
10
0.1
List
List
List
2057
2147
WIRING INFORMATION
Please use the Diamond Logic Builder software to determine pin locations for RPM inputs (refer to the
CONNECTOR screen view) and to set programmable parameters (refer to the FEATURE screen view).
When a vehicle is ordered from Navistar with this feature, a 3-pin connector is provided which mates with the
connector from the Muncie Lectra-Shift Solenoid. This connector is located in the transmission/engine
harness located above the transmission. The customer is responsible for connecting two wires from this
connector to the RPM connectors.
The white wire is pre-wired from a relay to the Lectra-Shift connector. This wire is for the engagement coil.
The red wire is for the holding coil in the solenoid. The red wire must be connected to the brown 8-pin RPM
output connector pin labeled PTO_Lectra-Shift_Retaining_Solenoid_Output.
The black wire is for the PTO feedback switch. The customer must wire from this pin into the black 23-pin
RPM input connector pin labeled PTO_Feedback_Switch.
When the customer has completed the wiring from the connector, plug the 3-pin connector into the connector
provided by the Muncie Solenoid (See the Figure below).
The customer is responsible for providing GND to the solenoid.
SECTION 23 - PAGE 12
October 2012
October 2012
f_124
f_125
SECTION 23 - PAGE 13
f_126
Part Number
2585651C91
2585423C91
NOTE: The following connectors are optional because they are already provided with the RPMs.
This information is given so that the Body Builder could purchase connectors in the event that the original
connectors were damaged or lost, or so that the Body Builder can pre-fabricate a wire harness.
Table 127 8-Way RPM Output Connector (Brown) and 23-Way RPM Input Connector (Black)
Connector Part No.
Description
Terminal Part
Cable Seal Part
Connector Lock Part
CPA Lock
Cavity Plug
SECTION 23 - PAGE 14
3548934C1
Connector, Body, Brown 8Way RPM Output
3534163C1 12 Gauge
3535931C1 14 Gauge
3535930C1 16 & 18 Gauge
3548945C1 12 & 14 Gauge
3535937C1 16 & 18 Gauge
3548943C1
3573833C1
3535938C1
October 2012
2585981C91
Connector, Body, Black 23-Way RPM Input Kit
1698937C1
N/A
N/A
N/A
Built into the connector
October 2012
f_122
f_123
SECTION 23 - PAGE 15
f_129
WARNING: Batteries expel explosive gases. Keep sparks, flames, burning cigarettes or other ignition (IGN)
sources away at all times. Always wear safety glasses and a face shield when working near batteries to prevent
personal injury and/or property damage.
Open hood and disconnect batteries on the vehicle.
SECTION 23 - PAGE 16
October 2012
Ensure the switch assigned to the Lectra-Shift is a center stable momentary switch.
b.
If the switch is not a momentary switch, use a DIN removal tool and remove the affected switch pack
from the Instrument Panel (IP). Install a momentary switch in the position assigned to the PTO switch.
Re-install the switch pack in the IP.
October 2012
SECTION 23 - PAGE 17
ENGAGEMENT
These parameters set rules that must be met in order for the PTO to be engaged.
If TEM_PTO_Brake_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the brake pedal must be depressed in order
for the PTO to engage.
If TEM_PTO_Cltch_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the clutch pedal must be depressed for the
PTO to engage.
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Run_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the engine has to be running in order for
the PTO to be engaged.
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the PTO cannot be engaged if the engine
speed is over a certain threshold, which is defined as a programmable parameter in
TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_Engmnt_Limit
If TEM_PTO_Neut_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the PTO can only be engaged if the
Transmission is NOT in Neutral or Park
If TEM_PTO_Non_Neut_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the Transmission must be in Neutral or
Park for the PTO to be engaged.
If TEM_PTO_Pk_Brake_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the Park Brake must be set in order for the
PTO to be engaged.
If TEM_PTO_Veh_Spd_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the PTO cannot be engaged if the Vehicle
Speed is over the value prescribed by TEM_PTO_Veh_Spd_Engmnt_Limit.
If TEM_Air_Pres_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the PTO cannot be engaged if the Vehicle
Primary Air Pressure is under the value prescribed be TEM_Air_Pres_Engmnt_Limit.
If TEM_PTO_Mast_Switch_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, the PTO will not be engaged if the vehicle
master switch is not ON.
SECTION 23 - PAGE 18
October 2012
ID
Description
Default
Min
Max
Step
2095
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
2094
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
2096
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
On
N/A
N/A
N/A
1000 RPM
100
5000
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
On
N/A
N/A
N/A
2089
2088
2087
3 MPH
100
2097
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
2098
See TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_Engmnt_Inhib
500
2099
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
DISENGAGEMENT
These parameters set the conditions under which the PTO will be disengaged.
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Run_Disengages parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the engine is
turned off.
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_Disengages parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the engine
speed rises above the value set by TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_DisEng_Limit.
If TEM_PTO_ Non_Neut _Disengages parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the
transmission is taken out of neutral.
If TEM_PTO_Pk_Brake_Disengages parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the Park Brake
is released.
If TEM_PTO_Veh_Spd_Disengages parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the vehicle
speed is over the valued specified by TEM_PTO_Veh_Spd_DisEng_Limit.
October 2012
SECTION 23 - PAGE 19
ID
Description
Default
Min
Max
Step
2114
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
2113
1800 RPM
5000
2112
On
N/A
N/A
N/A
2109
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
2108
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
2110
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
2111
0 MPH
100
TEM_PTO_Air_
Pres_Disengages
2115
N/A
N/A
N/A
TEM_PTO_Air_
Pres_DisEng_Limit
2116
See TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_Disengages
500
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
TEM_PTO_Ext_
Input_Disengages
TEM_PTO_Mast_
Switch_Disengages
RE-ENGAGEMENT
These parameters set the conditions under which the PTO can be reengaged.
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Run_Allow_ReEng parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be reengaged (after
disengagement due to engine stopping) when the engine is restarted.
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_Allow_ReEng parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be reengaged (after
disengagement due to engine overspeed) when the engine speed falls below
TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_Engmnt_Limit.
If TEM_PTO_Ext_Input_Allow_ReEng parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be reengaged (after
disengagement due to the designated external input being in active state) when the external input is no longer
in active state.
If TEM_PTO_Key_State_Allow_ReEng parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be allowed to reengage when
the key state is returned to run.
SECTION 23 - PAGE 20
October 2012
ID
Description
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be reengaged
2122 after disengagement due to the engine stopping
when the engine is restarted.
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be reengaged
after disengagement due to engine overspeed
2120
when the engine speed is below
TEM_PTO_Eng_ Spd_Engmnt_ Limit.
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be reengaged
after disengagement due to the designated
2121
external input when the external input is no longer
active.
2069
TEM_PTO_
Non_Neut_
Allow_ReEng
2148
TEM_PTO_
Pk_Brake_
Allow_ReEng
2149
TEM_PTO_
Veh_Spd_
Allow_ReEng
2119
TEM_PTO_Mast_
Switch_Allow_
ReEng
2123
TEM_PTO_Air_
Pres_Allow_ReEng
2124
October 2012
Default
Min
Max
Step
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
On
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
SECTION 23 - PAGE 21
ID
TEM_PTO_Air_
Pres_Alarms
2138
TEM_PTO_Air_
Pres_Alarm_Limit
TEM_PTO_
Eng_Run_ Alarms
TEMP_PTO_Eng_
Spd_Alarm_Limit
Description
If this parameter is 1, an alarm will sound if the
PTO is engaged and the air pressure is below
TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_Alarm_Limit
Default
Min
Max
Step
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
2139
See TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_Alarms
0 psi
500
2137
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
See TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_Alarms
1400 RPM
5000
0.1
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
5 mph
100
2136
TEM_PTO_
Eng_Spd_ Alarms
2135
TEM_PTO_
Non_Neut_ Alarms
2132
TEM_PTO_
Pk_Brake_ Alarms
2131
TEM_PTO_
Veh_Spd_ Alarms
2133
TEM_PTO_Veh_
Spd_Alarm_Limit
2134
SECTION 23 - PAGE 22
October 2012
ID
2147
1993
Description
Active State for the TEM PTO engagement
feedback switch.
This is the fuse level of the Hydraulic PTO FET
(Field Effect Transistor).
Default
Min
Max
Step
List
List
List
20 Amps
20
0.1
WIRING INFORMATION
Please use the Diamond Logic Builder software to determine pin locations for RPM inputs (refer to the
CONNECTOR screen view) and to set programmable parameters (refer to the FEATURE screen view).
All wiring to RPM inputs and outputs is customer supplied.
One wire must be connected from the pin labeled PTO_Output in the brown 8-pin RPM output connector to
the coil on the hydraulic solenoid. This wire drives the engagement and disengagement of the solenoid. The
customer supplies a GND wire for the hydraulic solenoid.
A second wire must be connected from the Body Builder-installed PTO feedback switch (GND active) to the
pin labeled PTO_Feedback_Switch in the black 23-pin RPM input connector. This feedback switch is used to
determine whether or not the PTO is engaged by determining if the switch is in the active state. If the switch
is indeed in the active state and the PTO is running, then an indicator light in the gauge cluster will be on.
When the switch is not in the active state, the indicator light will not be on.
The switch provided is labeled PTO.
October 2012
SECTION 23 - PAGE 23
f_130
Part Number
2585651C91
2585423C91
NOTE: The following connectors are optional because they are already provided with the RPMs.
This information is given so that the Body Builder can purchase connectors in the event that the original
connectors are damaged or lost, or so that the Body Builder can pre-fabricate a wire harness.
Table 134 8-Way RPM Output Connector (Brown) and 23-Way RPM Input Connector (Black)
Connector Part No.
Description
Terminal Part
Cable Seal Part
Connector Lock Part
CPA Lock
Cavity Plug
SECTION 23 - PAGE 24
3548934C1
Connector, Body, Brown 8Way RPM Output
3534163C1 12 Gauge
3535931C1 14 Gauge
3535930C1 16 & 18 Gauge
3548945C1 12 & 14 Gauge
3535937C1 16 & 18 Gauge
3548943C1
3573833C1
3535938C1
October 2012
2585981C91
Connector, Body, Black 23-Way RPM Input Kit
1698937C1
N/A
N/A
N/A
Built into the connector
October 2012
f_127
f_123
SECTION 23 - PAGE 25
SECTION 23 - PAGE 26
October 2012
ENGAGEMENT
These parameters set rules that must be met in order for the PTO to be engaged.
If TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, the PTO cannot be engaged if the primary
vehicle air pressure is below the programmable parameter set by TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_Engmnt_Limit.
If TEM_PTO_Brake_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the brake pedal must be depressed in order
for the PTO to engage.
If TEM_PTO_Cltch_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the clutch pedal must be depressed for the
PTO to engage.
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Run_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the engine has to be running in order for
the PTO to be engaged.
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the PTO cannot be engaged if the engine
speed is over a certain threshold, which is defined as a programmable parameter in
TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_Engmnt_Limit
If TEM_PTO_Neut_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the PTO can only be engaged if the
Transmission is NOT in Neutral or Park.
If TEM_PTO_Non_Neut_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the Transmission must be in Neutral or
Park for the PTO to be engaged.
If TEM_PTO_Pk_Brake_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the Park Brake must be set in order for the
PTO to be engaged.
If TEM_PTO_Veh_Spd_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the PTO cannot be engaged if the Vehicle
Speed is over the value prescribed by TEM_PTO_Veh_Spd_Engmnt_Limit.
If TEM_PTO_Mast_Switch_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the PTO will not be engaged if the
vehicle master switch is not ON.
October 2012
SECTION 23 - PAGE 27
ID
Description
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will not be
engaged if the primary vehicle air pressure is
below TEM_PTO_Air_ Pres_Engmnt_ Limit
Default
Min
Max
Step
On
N/A
N/A
N/A
2098
90 psi
500
2095
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
2094
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
2096
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
On
N/A
N/A
N/A
1000 RPM
100
5000
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
On
N/A
N/A
N/A
2097
2089
2088
2087
3 MPH
100
2099
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
DISENGAGEMENT
These parameters set the conditions under which the PTO will be disengaged.
If TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_Disengages parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the primary air
pressure is below the value set in TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_DisEng_Limit.
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Run_Disengages parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the engine is
turned off.
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_Disengages parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the engine
speed rises above the value set by TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_DisEng_Limit.
If TEM_PTO_ Non_Neut _Disengages parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the
transmission is taken out of neutral.
If TEM_PTO_Pk_Brake_Disengages parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the Park Brake
is released.
SECTION 23 - PAGE 28
October 2012
ID
Description
Default
Min
Max
Step
2116
80 psi
500
2115
On
N/A
N/A
N/A
2114
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
2113
1800 RPM
5000
2112
On
N/A
N/A
N/A
2109
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
2108
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
2110
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
2111
0 MPH
100
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
RE-ENGAGEMENT
These parameters set the conditions under which the PTO can be reengaged.
All re-engagement parameters should be set to 0 with non-clutched air-shifted PTOs to prevent gear grind and
damage to the transmission.
If TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_Allow_ReEng parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be reengaged (after
disengagement due to low air pressure) when the primary air pressure rises about the value specified by
TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_Engmnt_Limit.
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Run_Allow_ReEng parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be reengaged (after
disengagement due to engine stopping) when the engine is restarted.
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_Allow_ReEng parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be reengaged (after
disengagement due to engine overspeed) when the engine speed falls below
TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_Engmnt_Limit.
October 2012
SECTION 23 - PAGE 29
ID
TEM_PTO_
Air_Pres_
Allow_ReEng
2124
TEM_PTO_
Eng_Run_
Allow_ReEng
2122
TEM_PTO_
Eng_Spd_
Allow_ReEng
2120
TEM_PTO_
Key_State_
Allow_ReEng
2069
TEM_PTO_
Non_Neut_
Allow_ReEng
2148
TEM_PTO_
Pk_Brake_
Allow_ReEng
2149
TEM_PTO_
Veh_Spd_
Allow_ReEng
2119
TEM_PTO_Ext_
Input_Allow_ReEng
2121
TEM_PTO_Mast_
Switch_Allow_
ReEng
2123
SECTION 23 - PAGE 30
Description
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be reengaged
after disengagement due to low vehicle air
pressure when the primary air pressure is over
TEM_PTO_Air_ Pres_Engmnt_ Limit.
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be reengaged
after disengagement due to the engine stopping
when the engine is restarted.
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be reengaged
after disengagement due to engine overspeed
when the engine speed is below
TEM_PTO_Eng_ Spd_Engmnt_ Limit.
If this parameter is set, the PTO will be allowed to
reengage when the key state is returned to run.
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be reengaged
after disengagement due to transmission out of
neutral when the transmission is placed back into
neutral.
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be reengaged
after disengagement due to park brake released
when the park brake is reapplied.
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be reengaged
after disengagement due to vehicle overspeed
when the vehicle speed is below
TEM_PTO_Veh_ Spd_Engmnt_ Limit.
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be reengaged
after a disengage due to the designated external
input when the external input is no longer active
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be reengaged
after a disengage due to the master switch being
turned off when the master switch is turned on
again
October 2012
Default
Min
Max
Step
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
ID
TEM_PTO_
Air_Pres_ Alarms
2138
TEM_PTO_Air_
Pres_Alarm_Limit
TEM_PTO_
Eng_Run_ Alarms
Description
If this Parameter is 1, an alarm will sound if the
primary air pressure is below TEM_PTO_Air_
Pres_Alarm_Limit.
Default
Min
Max
Step
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
See TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_Alarms
0 psi
500
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
1400 RPM
5000
0.1
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
5 mph
100
2139
2137
TEM_PTO_
Eng_Spd_ Alarms
2135
TEMP_PTO_Eng_
Spd_Alarm_Limit
2136
TEM_PTO_
Non_Neut_ Alarms
2132
TEM_PTO_
Pk_Brake_ Alarms
2131
TEM_PTO_
Veh_Spd_ Alarms
2133
TEM_PTO_Veh_
Spd_Alarm_Limit
2134
OTHER PARAMETERS
These parameters allow the customer to program the active state of the RPM input and set the maximum
current of the RPM output.
The TEM_RPM_PTO_Engaged_Param parameter 2147 indicates the state that the BC will read as active for
the TEM PTO feedback switch (as it goes into the RPM input). This active state will be used to indicate when
the PTO is engaged.
0 = Input active when open circuit
1 = Input active when grounded
3 = Input active when at 12V
October 2012
SECTION 23 - PAGE 31
ID
Description
Default
Min
Max
Step
2147
List
List
List
1993
20 Amps
20
0.1
WIRING INFORMATION
Please use the Diamond Logic Builder software to determine pin and switch locations for RPM inputs and
outputs and to set programmable parameters (refer to pin and switch location section).
All wiring to RPM inputs and outputs is customer supplied.
One wire must be connected from the pin labeled PTO_Output in the Brown 8-pin RPM output connector, to
the coil on the air solenoid. This wire drives the engagement and disengagement of the solenoid. The
customer supplies a GND wire for the air solenoid.
A second wire must be connected from the Body Builder-installed PTO feedback switch (GND active) to the
pin labeled PTO_Feedback_Switch in the black 23-pin RPM input connector. This switch is used to
determine whether or not the PTO is engaged by determining if the switch is in the active state. If the switch
is indeed in the active state and the PTO is running, then an indicator light in the gauge cluster will be on.
When the switch is not in the active state, the indicator light will not be on.
The switch provided is not labeled; therefore the customer will have to install a PTO label for the switch from
the bag of switch labels provided with the vehicle. The customer should use the Diamond Logic Builder
software to determine the location of the in-cab switch.
SECTION 23 - PAGE 32
October 2012
f_131
Part Number
2585651C91
2585423C91
NOTE: The following connectors are optional because they are already provided with the RPMs.
This information is given so that the Body Builder can purchase connectors in the event that the original
connectors are damaged or lost, or so that the Body Builder can pre-fabricate a harness.
Table 141 8-Way RPM Output Connector (Brown) and 23-Way RPM Input Connector (Black)
Connector Part No.
Description
Terminal Part
Cable Seal Part
Connector Lock Part
CPA Lock
Cavity Plug
3548934C1
Connector, Body, Brown 8Way RPM Output
3534163C1 12 Gauge
3535931C1 14 Gauge
3535930C1 16 & 18 Gauge
3548945C1 12 & 14 Gauge
3535937C1 16 & 18 Gauge
3548943C1
3573833C1
3535938C1
October 2012
2585981C91
Connector, Body, Black 23-Way RPM Input Kit
1698937C1
N/A
N/A
N/A
Included
SECTION 23 - PAGE 33
SECTION 23 - PAGE 34
October 2012
f_127
f_123
October 2012
SECTION 23 - PAGE 35
ENGAGEMENT
These parameters set rules that must be met in order for the PTO to be engaged.
If TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, the PTO cannot be engaged if the primary
vehicle air pressure is below the programmable parameter set by TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_Engmnt_Limit.
If TEM_PTO_Brake_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the brake pedal must be depressed in order
for the PTO to engage.
If TEM_PTO_Cltch_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the clutch pedal must be depressed for the
PTO to engage.
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Run_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the engine has to be running in order for
the PTO to be engaged.
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the PTO cannot be engaged if the engine
speed is over a certain threshold, which is defined as a programmable parameter in
TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_Engmnt_Limit
If TEM_PTO_Neut_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the PTO can only be engaged if the
Transmission is NOT in Neutral or Park
If TEM_PTO_Non_Neut_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the Transmission must be in Neutral or
Park for the PTO to be engaged.
If TEM_PTO_Pk_Brake_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the Park Brake must be set in order for the
PTO to be engaged.
If TEM_PTO_Veh_Spd_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the PTO cannot be engaged if the Vehicle
Speed is over the value prescribed by TEM_PTO_Veh_Spd_Engmnt_Limit.
If TEM_PTO_Mast_Switch_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the PTO will not be engaged if the
vehicle master switch is not ON.
SECTION 23 - PAGE 36
October 2012
ID
Description
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will not be
engaged if the primary vehicle air pressure is
below TEM_PTO_Air_ Pres_Engmnt_ Limit
Default
Min
Max
Step
On
N/A
N/A
N/A
2098
90 psi
500
2095
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
2094
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
2096
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
On
N/A
N/A
N/A
1000 RPM
100
5000
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
On
N/A
N/A
N/A
2097
2089
2088
2087
3 MPH
100
2099
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
DISENGAGEMENT
These parameters set the conditions under which the PTO will be disengaged.
If TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_Disengages parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the primary air
pressure is below the value set in TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_DisEng_Limit.
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Run_Disengages parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the engine is
turned off.
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_Disengages parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the engine
speed rises above the value set by TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_DisEng_Limit.
If TEM_PTO_ Non_Neut _Disengages parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the
transmission is taken out of neutral.
If TEM_PTO_Pk_Brake_Disengages parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the Park Brake
is released.
October 2012
SECTION 23 - PAGE 37
ID
Description
Default
Min
Max
Step
2116
80 psi
500
2115
On
N/A
N/A
N/A
2114
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
2113
1800 RPM
5000
2112
On
N/A
N/A
N/A
2109
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
2108
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
2110
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
2111
0 MPH
100
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
RE-ENGAGEMENT
These parameters set the conditions under which the PTO can be reengaged.
If TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_Allow_ReEng parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be reengaged (after
disengagement due to low air pressure) when the primary air pressure rises about the value specified by
TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_Engmnt_Limit.
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Run_Allow_ReEng parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be reengaged (after
disengagement due to engine stopping) when the engine is restarted.
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_Allow_ReEng parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be reengaged (after
disengagement due to engine overspeed) when the engine speed falls below
TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_Engmnt_Limit.
If TEM_PTO_Key_State_Allow_ReEng parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be allowed to reengage when
the key state is returned to run.
SECTION 23 - PAGE 38
October 2012
ID
TEM_PTO_
Air_Pres_
Allow_ReEng
2124
TEM_PTO_
Eng_Run_
Allow_ReEng
2122
TEM_PTO_
Eng_Spd_
Allow_ReEng
2120
TEM_PTO_
Key_State_
Allow_ReEng
2069
TEM_PTO_
Non_Neut_
Allow_ReEng
2148
TEM_PTO_
Pk_Brake_
Allow_ReEng
2149
TEM_PTO_
Veh_Spd_
Allow_ReEng
2119
TEM_PTO_Ext_
Input_Allow_ReEng
2021
TEM_PTO_Mast_
Switch_Allow_
ReEng
2023
Description
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be reengaged
after disengagement due to low vehicle air
pressure when the primary air pressure is over
TEM_PTO_Air_ Pres_Engmnt_ Limit.
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be reengaged
after disengagement due to the engine stopping
when the engine is restarted.
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be reengaged
after disengagement due to engine overspeed
when the engine speed is below
TEM_PTO_Eng_ Spd_Engmnt_ Limit.
If this parameter is set, the PTO will be allowed to
reengage when the key state is returned to run.
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be reengaged
after disengagement due to transmission out of
neutral when the transmission is placed back into
neutral.
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be reengaged
after disengagement due to park brake released
when the park brake is reapplied.
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be reengaged
after disengagement due to vehicle overspeed
when the vehicle speed is below
TEM_PTO_Veh_ Spd_Engmnt_ Limit.
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be reengaged
after a disengage due to the designated external
input when the external input is no longer active
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be reengaged
after a disengage due to the engine stopping
when the engine is restarted
Default
Min
Max
Step
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
On
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
ALARMS
These parameters utilize the gauge cluster to sound an alarm to the driver when certain programmable
parameters are violated.
If TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_Alarms parameter is turned on, then an audible alarm will sound in the cab if the
primary air pressure drops below the value specified by TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_Alarm_Limit.
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Run_Alarms parameter is turned on, then an audible alarm will sound in the cab if the PTO
is engaged and the engine is turned off.
October 2012
SECTION 23 - PAGE 39
ID
TEM_PTO_
Air_Pres_ Alarms
2138
TEM_PTO_Air_
Pres_Alarm_Limit
TEM_PTO_
Eng_Run_ Alarms
Description
If this Parameter is 1, an alarm will sound if the
primary air pressure is below TEM_PTO_Air_
Pres_Alarm_Limit.
Default
Min
Max
Step
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
See TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_Alarms
0 psi
500
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
1400 RPM
5000
0.1
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
5 mph
100
2139
2137
TEM_PTO_
Eng_Spd_ Alarms
2135
TEMP_PTO_Eng_
Spd_Alarm_Limit
2136
TEM_PTO_
Non_Neut_ Alarms
2132
TEM_PTO_
Pk_Brake_ Alarms
2131
TEM_PTO_
Veh_Spd_ Alarms
2133
TEM_PTO_Veh_
Spd_Alarm_Limit
2134
OTHER PARAMETERS
These parameters allow the customer to program the active state of the RPM input and set the maximum
current of the RPM output.
The TEM_RPM_PTO_Engaged_Param parameter 2147 indicates the state that the BC will read as active for
the TEM PTO feedback switch (As it goes into the RPM input). This active state will be used to indicate when
the PTO is engaged.
0 = Input active when open circuit
1 = Input active when grounded
3 = Input active when at 12V
The TEM_Hyd_PTO_Engagement_Out_Param parameter 1993 sets the current at which the BC will fuse the
Remote Power Module output that drives the engagement of the PTO. This is used to define the maximum
amount of current that can flow through the Remote Power Module output.
SECTION 23 - PAGE 40
October 2012
ID
Description
Default
Min
Max
Step
2147
List
List
List
1993
20 Amps
20
0.1
WIRING INFORMATION
Please use the Diamond Logic Builder software to determine pin and switch locations for RPM inputs and
outputs and to set programmable parameters (refer to pin and switch location section).
All wiring to RPM inputs and outputs is customer supplied.
One wire must be connected from the pin labeled PTO_Output in the Brown 8-pin RPM output connector to
the coil on the air solenoid. This wire drives the engagement and disengagement of the solenoid. The
customer supplies a GND wire for the air solenoid.
A second wire must be connected from the Body Builder-installed PTO feedback switch (GND active) to the
pin labeled PTO_Feedback_Switch in the Black 23-pin RPM input connector. This switch used to determine
whether or not the PTO is engaged by checking if the switch is in the active state. If the switch is indeed in
the active state and the PTO is running, then an indicator light in the gauge cluster will be on. When the
switch is not in the active state, the indicator light will not be on.
The switch provided is labeled PTO.
f_132
October 2012
SECTION 23 - PAGE 41
Part Number
2585651C91
2585423C91
NOTE: The following connectors are optional because they are already provided with the RPMs.
This information is given so that the Body Builder can purchase connectors in the event that the original
connectors are damaged or lost, or so that the Body Builder can pre-fabricate a harness.
Table 148 8-Way RPM Output Connector (Brown) and 23-Way RPM Input Connector (Black)
Connector Part No.
Description
Terminal Part
Cable Seal Part
Connector Lock Part
CPA Lock
Cavity Plug
3548934C1
Connector, Body, Brown 8Way RPM Output
3534163C1 12 Gauge
3535931C1 14 Gauge
3535930C1 16 & 18 Gauge
3548945C1 12 & 14 Gauge
3535937C1 16 & 18 Gauge
3548943C1
3573833C1
3535938C1
2585981C91
Connector, Body, Black 23-Way RPM Input Kit
1698937C1
N/A
N/A
N/A
Included
SECTION 23 - PAGE 42
October 2012
f_127
f_123
TESTING
1. To determine if the PTO is working, depress the PTO switch in the cab to the on position. Ensure that all
interlock conditions are enabled.
2. Verify that the pin labeled PTO_Output of the Brown 8-way Remote Power Module output connector has
the battery voltage levels present.
3. Verify that the Remote Power Module Input labeled PTO_Feedback_Switch (Pin position specified by the
Diamond Logic Builder software) is receiving the correct voltage (12V or GND) as specified by the
customer in the Diamond Logic Builder software.
4. Make certain that the indicator light in the top section of the PTO switch illuminates by engaging the PTO.
5. Make certain that the PTO indicator light in the gauge cluster illuminates by engaging the PTO.
6. The audible alarm can be tested by violating the set programmable parameters and determining if the
alarm sounds. For example, if the park brake interlock is programmed ON, release the park brake and
engage the PTO. The audible alarm should sound with continuous beeps.
October 2012
SECTION 23 - PAGE 43
SECTION 23 - PAGE 44
October 2012
Interlocking Condition
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
f_106
* TEM_Aux1_Interlock_Latches_Off
October 2012
SECTION 23 - PAGE 45
Transmission Gear
125
Transmission in Neutral
126
127
128
125 + x
124
123
125 y
Example: For the output to only come on when the vehicle transmission is in a reverse gear, set
TEM_Aux1_Misc_Interlock_Param to 10 and TEM_Aux1_Gear_Interlock_Param to 125.
* TEM_Aux2_Misc_Interlock_Param
This parameter (TEM_Aux2_Misc_Interlock_Param) is the master parameter for this feature. The setting for
this parameter selects the interlocking condition for the output. The following table indicates which interlocking
condition corresponds to which setting for the parameter. To select the interlocking condition simply set the
value of this parameter to the corresponding setting on the table.
SECTION 23 - PAGE 46
October 2012
Interlocking Condition
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
October 2012
f_106
SECTION 23 - PAGE 47
Transmission Gear
125
Transmission in Neutral
126
127
128
125 + x
124
123
125 y
Example: For the output to only come on when the vehicle transmission is in a reverse gear, you would set
TEM_Aux2_Misc_Interlock_Param to 10 and TEM_Aux2_Gear_Interlock_Param to 125.
SECTION 23 - PAGE 48
October 2012
ID
2006
2007
Description
If this is set, when the output is turned off due to
an interlock, it will remain off until the switch is
recycled.
The speed parameter for the TEM Aux #1 with
Interlocks feature.
Default
Min
Max
Step
Off
On/Off
30
Mph
100
Number
250
10
List
Off
On/Off
30
Mph
100
Number
250
10
List
ENGAGEMENT
*These parameters set rules that must be met in order for the PTO to be engaged.
If TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, the PTO cannot be engaged if the primary
vehicle air pressure is below the programmable parameter set by TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_Engmnt_Limit.
If TEM_PTO_Brake_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the brake pedal must be depressed in order
for the PTO to engage.
If TEM_PTO_Cltch_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the clutch pedal must be depressed for the
PTO to engage.
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Run_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the engine has to be running in order for
the PTO to be engaged.
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the PTO cannot be engaged if the engine
speed is over a certain threshold, which is defined as a programmable parameter in
TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_Engmnt_Limit
If TEM_PTO_Neut_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the PTO can only be engaged if the
transmission is NOT in Neutral or Park.
If TEM_PTO_Non_Neut_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the transmission must be in Neutral or
Park for the PTO to be engaged.
If TEM_PTO_Pk_Brake_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the park brake must be set in order for the
PTO to be engaged.
If TEM_PTO_Veh_Spd_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the PTO cannot be engaged if the vehicle
speed is over the value prescribed by TEM_PTO_Veh_Spd_Engmnt_Limit.
October 2012
SECTION 23 - PAGE 49
ID
Description
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will not be
engaged if the primary vehicle air pressure is
below TEM_PTO_Air_ Pres_Engmnt_ Limit
Default
Min
Max
Step
On
N/A
N/A
N/A
2098
90 psi
500
2095
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
2094
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
2096
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
On
N/A
N/A
N/A
1000 RPM
100
5000
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
On
N/A
N/A
N/A
3 MPH
100
2097
2089
2088
2087
DISENGAGEMENT
These parameters set the conditions under which the PTO will be disengaged.
If TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_Disengages parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the primary air
pressure is below the value set in TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_DisEng_Limit.
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Run_Disengages parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the engine is
turned off.
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_Disengages parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the engine
speed rises above the value set by TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_DisEng_Limit.
If TEM_PTO_ Non_Neut _Disengages parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the
transmission is taken out of neutral.
If TEM_PTO_Pk_Brake_Disengages parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the Park Brake
is released.
If TEM_PTO_Veh_Spd_Disengages parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the vehicle
speed is over the valued specified by TEM_PTO_Veh_Spd_DisEng_Limit.
SECTION 23 - PAGE 50
October 2012
ID
Description
Default
Min
Max
Step
2116
80 psi
500
2115
On
N/A
N/A
N/A
2114
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
2113
1800 RPM
5000
2112
On
N/A
N/A
N/A
2109
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
2108
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
2110
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
2111
0 MPH
100
RE-ENGAGEMENT
These parameters set the conditions under which the PTO can be reengaged.
If TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_Allow_ReEng parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be reengaged (after
disengagement due to low air pressure) when the primary air pressure rises about the value specified by
TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_Engmnt_Limit.
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Run_Allow_ReEng parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be reengaged (after
disengagement due to engine stopping) when the engine is restarted.
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_Allow_ReEng parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be reengaged (after
disengagement due to engine overspeed) when the engine speed falls below
TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_Engmnt_Limit.
If TEM_PTO_Key_State_Allow_ReEng parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be allowed to reengage when
the key state is returned to run.
If TEM_PTO_Non_Neut_Allow_ReEng parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be reengaged (after
disengagement due to transmission out of neutral) when the transmission is placed back into neutral.
If TEM_PTO_Pk_Brake_Allow_ReEng parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be reengaged (after
disengagement due to park brake released) when the park brake is reapplied.
If TEM_PTO_Veh_Spd_Allow_ReEng parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be reengaged (after
disengagement due to the vehicle being over the vehicle speed value) when the vehicle speed falls below
TEM_PTO_Veh_Spd_Engmnt_Limit.
October 2012
SECTION 23 - PAGE 51
ID
TEM_PTO_
Air_Pres_
Allow_ReEng
2124
TEM_PTO_
Eng_Run_
Allow_ReEng
2122
TEM_PTO_
Eng_Spd_
Allow_ReEng
2120
TEM_PTO_
Key_State_
Allow_ReEng
2069
TEM_PTO_
Non_Neut_
Allow_ReEng
TEM_PTO_
Pk_Brake_
Allow_ReEng
TEM_PTO_
Veh_Spd_
Allow_ReEng
Description
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be reengaged
after disengagement due to low vehicle air
pressure when the primary air pressure is over
TEM_PTO_Air_ Pres_Engmnt_ Limit.
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be reengaged
after disengagement due to the engine stopping
when the engine is restarted.
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be reengaged
after disengagement due to engine overspeed
when the engine speed is below
TEM_PTO_Eng_ Spd_Engmnt_ Limit.
If this parameter is set, the PTO will be allowed to
reengage when the key state is returned to run.
Default
Min
Max
Step
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
On
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
ALARMS
This feature does not provide any PTO feedback indications or alarms. If this functionality is required, add the
feature described in the chapter for 16WLM PTO Feedback and Alarms.
WIRING INFORMATION
The wiring out of the pin labeled TEM_PTO_Relay_Driver_Command should be connected to the F2 pin on the
J4 (1601) connector.
The wiring out of the pin labeled Interlocked_switch_relay1_output should be connected to the F6 pin on the J4
(1601) connector.
The wiring out of the pin labeled Interlocked_switch_relay2_output should be connected to the F7 pin on the J4
(1601) connector.
SECTION 23 - PAGE 52
October 2012
f_135
TESTING
1. Depress switch.
2. Verify that the output labeled Interlocked_switch_relay1_output is obtaining the desired voltage (as
programmed by the Diamond Logic Builder software).
3. Verify the functionality of the 30 Mph interlock by violating the parameter and determine that the output
shuts off.
4. Test all other interlocks can by violating the programmable parameters to see if the output shuts off
5. Depress the second switch.
6. Verify that the RPM output labeled Interlocked_switch_relay2_output is obtaining the desired voltage (as
programmed by the Diamond Logic Builder software).
7. Verify the functionality of the 30 MPH interlock by violating the parameter and determine that the output
shuts off.
8. Test all other interlocks can by violating the programmable parameters to see if the output shuts off
9. Depress the In-cab PTO switch to the ON position.
10. Verify that all enabled interlock conditions are met.
October 2012
SECTION 23 - PAGE 53
PTO CONTROL
13XAA
PTO CONTROL, DASH MOUNTED For Customer Provided PTO; Includes Switch, Electric/Air Solenoid, Piping
and Wiring
13WDH
WIRING, TRANS, BODY BUILDER, Installed Wiring for Transmission/PTO Controls, for Allison 2000, 2100,
2200, 2400, 2500 Series Transmission Only. NOTE: See the Automatic Transmission Interfaces section of this
manual for connector reference information and connector location.
13WDN
PTO CONTROL, DASH MOUNTED for Customer Provided PTO; Includes 2 Independent Illuminated Switches,
2 Electric/Air Solenoids, Piping and Wiring
This feature provides the customer with the ability to control a customer-supplied PTO(s) with a single
(13XAA)/two (13WDN) in-dash switch(es) and a single (13XAA)/two (13WDN) air solenoid(s). This feature
provides all the software and wiring to the air solenoid located inside the drivers side frame rail next to the
transmission. Customer must supply and route air plumbing to the PTO. Programmable parameters allow
customers to customize the functionality of their PTO.
ENGAGEMENT
These parameters set rules that must be met in order for the PTO to be engaged.
If TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, the PTO cannot be engaged if the primary
vehicle air pressure is below the programmable parameter set by TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_Engmnt_Limit.
SECTION 23 - PAGE 54
October 2012
October 2012
SECTION 23 - PAGE 55
ID
Description
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will not be
engaged if the primary vehicle air pressure is
below TEM_PTO_Air_ Pres_Engmnt_ Limit
Default
Min
Max
Step
On
N/A
N/A
N/A
2098
90 psi
500
2095
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
2094
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
2096
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
On
N/A
N/A
N/A
1000 RPM
100
5000
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
On
N/A
N/A
N/A
2097
2089
2088
2087
3 MPH
100
2099
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
DISENGAGEMENT
These parameters set the conditions under which the PTO will be disengaged.
If TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_Disengages parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the primary air
pressure is below the value set in TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_DisEng_Limit.
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Run_Disengages parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the engine is
turned off.
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_Disengages parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the engine
speed rises above the value set by TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_DisEng_Limit.
If TEM_PTO_ Non_Neut _Disengages parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the
transmission is taken out of neutral.
If TEM_PTO_Pk_Brake_Disengages parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the Park Brake
is released.
SECTION 23 - PAGE 56
October 2012
ID
Description
Default
Min
Max
Step
2116
80 psi
500
2115
On
N/A
N/A
N/A
2114
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
2113
1800 RPM
5000
2112
On
N/A
N/A
N/A
2109
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
2108
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
2110
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
2111
0 MPH
100
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
RE-ENGAGEMENT
These parameters set the conditions under which the PTO can be reengaged.
If TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_Allow_ReEng parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be reengaged (after
disengagement due to low air pressure) when the primary air pressure rises about the value specified by
TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_Engmnt_Limit.
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Run_Allow_ReEng parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be reengaged (after
disengagement due to engine stopping) when the engine is restarted.
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_Allow_ReEng parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be reengaged (after
disengagement due to engine overspeed) when the engine speed falls below
TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_Engmnt_Limit.
If TEM_PTO_Key_State_Allow_ReEng parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be allowed to reengage when
the key state is returned to run.
October 2012
SECTION 23 - PAGE 57
Table 159
Off Indicates a 0 is set in for this parameter
On Indicates a 1 is set for the parameter
Parameter
ID
TEM_PTO_
Air_Pres_
Allow_ReEng
2124
TEM_PTO_
Eng_Run_
Allow_ReEng
2122
TEM_PTO_
Eng_Spd_
Allow_ReEng
2120
TEM_PTO_
Key_State_
Allow_ReEng
2069
TEM_PTO_
Non_Neut_
Allow_ReEng
2148
TEM_PTO_
Pk_Brake_
Allow_ReEng
2149
TEM_PTO_
Veh_Spd_
Allow_ReEng
2119
TEM_PTO_Ext_
Input_Allow_ReEng
2121
TEM_PTO_Mast_
Switch_Allow_
ReEng
2123
Description
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be reengaged
after disengagement due to low vehicle air
pressure when the primary air pressure is over
TEM_PTO_Air_ Pres_Engmnt_ Limit.
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be reengaged
after disengagement due to the engine stopping
when the engine is restarted.
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be reengaged
after disengagement due to engine overspeed
when the engine speed is below
TEM_PTO_Eng_ Spd_Engmnt_ Limit.
If this parameter is set, the PTO will be allowed to
reengage when the key state is returned to run.
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be reengaged
after disengagement due to transmission out of
neutral when the transmission is placed back into
neutral.
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be reengaged
after disengagement due to park brake released
when the park brake is reapplied.
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be reengaged
after disengagement due to vehicle overspeed
when the vehicle speed is below
TEM_PTO_Veh_ Spd_Engmnt_ Limit.
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be reengaged
after a disengage due to the designated external
input when the external input is no longer active
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be reengaged
after a disengage due to the master switch being
turned off when the master switch is turned on
again
Default
Min
Max
Step
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
On
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
WIRING INFORMATION
Customer must supply and route air plumbing from the Navistar-provided air solenoid (Located inside the
drivers side frame rail, adjacent to the Transmission) to the PTO.
SECTION 23 - PAGE 58
October 2012
f_136
TESTING
1. Depress the In-cab PTO switch to the ON position.
2. Verify that all enabled interlock conditions are met.
3. Verify that the Navistar-provided air solenoid is supplying air pressure at the solenoid output.
October 2012
SECTION 23 - PAGE 59
PTO CONTROL ONLY FOR LINE HAUL AND PROSTAR MODELS, DASH MOUNTED FOR
CUSTOMER PROVIDED PTO; INCLUDES SWITCH, ELECTRIC/AIR SOLENOID, PIPING
AND WIRING
SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES/PROGRAMMABLE PARAMETERS
REQUIRED SOFTWARE FEATURE CODES
595ADD for post 2007 clusters and pre 2010 clusters 595BKJ or 595BNP is required to be added for 2010
clusters.
Software feature 595BNP is similar to 595BKJ, but has 42 parameters available.
PARAMETERS
PTOa_Vehicle_Speed_Enable Set to 0 to ignore the vehicle speed. Set to 1 to require the vehicle to be below
a specified vehicle speed for the PTO to engage. Please use PTOa_Vehicle_Speed_Range to specify the
appropriate vehicle speed if this parameter is set to 1.
PTOa_Engine_Speed_Enable Set to 0 to ignore the engine speed. Set to 1 to require the vehicle to be below
a specified engine speed for the PTO to be engaged. Please use PTOa_Engine_Speed_Range to specify the
appropriate engine speed if this parameter is set to 1.
PTOa_Engine_Speed_Alarm_Enable Set to 0 to not have an alarm based on engine speed. Set to 1 to have
a speed that an alarm will sound when the PTO is engaged and the engine speed is greater than the set value.
Please use PTOa_Engine_Speed_Alarm_Range to specify the appropriate engine speed if this parameter is
set to 1.
Vehicle_Speed_Alarm_Enable PTOa_ Set to 0 to not have an alarm based on vehicle speed. Set to 1 to have
a speed limit that an alarm will sound when the PTO is engaged and the vehicle speed is greater than the set
value. Please use PTOa_Vehicle_Speed_Alarm_Range to specify the appropriate vehicle speed if this
parameter is set to 1.
PTOa_Clutch_Pedal Set to 0 to ignore the clutch pedal or if the vehicle does not have a clutch pedal. Set to 1
to ensure that the clutch pedal is depressed for engagement.
PTOa_Engine_Running Set to 0 to ignore the engine. Set to 1 to ensure that the engine is running to engage
and disengage if the engine stops running.
PTOa_Engine_Speed_Range Set to a speed that the engine has to be below for the PTO to engage. The
PTO will disengage if the engine speed becomes greater than the set value. If engine speed is required for
PTO operation, please use PTOa_Engine_Speed_Enable to enable this interlock.
PTOa_Park_Brake Set to 0 to ignore the park brake. Set to 1 to ensure that the park brake is set for engage
and disengage if the park brake is released.
PTOa_Engine_Speed_Alarm_Range Set to the speed that the vehicle has to be below for the PTO to
engage. The PTO will disengage if the vehicle speed becomes greater than the set value. If vehicle speed is
required for PTO operation, please use PTOa_Vehicle_Speed_Enable parameter to enable this interlock.
PTOa_Vehicle_Speed_Alarm_Range.
SECTION 23 - PAGE 60
October 2012
ID
PTOa_Vehicle_
Speed_Enable
2242
PTOa_Engine_
Speed_Enable
2243
PTOa_Engine_
Speed_Alarm_
Enable
2244
Vehicle_Speed_
Alarm_Enable
PTOa
2267
PTOa_Clutch_
Pedal
PTOa_Engine_
Running
2333
2334
PTOa_Engine_
Speed_Range
2336
PTOa_Park_Brake
2338
PTOa_Vehicle_
Speed_Range
2339
PTOa_Engine_
Speed_Alarm_
Range
2340
PTOa_Vehicle_
Speed_Alarm_
Range
2342
PTOa_
Transmission_
Neutral
2355
Description
Set to 1 to require the vehicle to be below a specified
vehicle speed for the PTO to engage. Please use
PTOa_Vehicle_Speed_Range to specify the
appropriate vehicle speed if this parameter is set to 1..
Set to 1 to require the vehicle to be below a specified
engine speed for the PTO to be engaged. Please use
PTOa_Engine_Speed_Range to specify the
appropriate engine speed if this parameter is set to 1.
Set to 1 to have a speed that an alarm will sound when
the PTO is engaged and the engine speed is greater
than the set value. Please use
PTOa_Engine_Speed_Alarm_Range to specify the
appropriate engine speed if this parameter is set to 1.
Set to 1 to have a speed limit that an alarm will sound
when the PTO is engaged and the vehicle speed is
greater than the set value. Please use
PTOa_Vehicle_Speed_Alarm_Range to specify the
appropriate vehicle speed if this parameter is set to 1.
Set to 1 to ensure that the clutch pedal is depressed for
engagement.
Set to 1 to ensure that the engine is running to engage
and disengage if the engine stops running.
Set to a speed that the engine has to be below for the
PTO to engage. The PTO will disengage if the engine
speed becomes greater than the set value. If engine
speed is required for PTO operation, please use
PTOa_Engine_Speed_Enable to enable this interlock.
Set to 1 to ensure that the park brake is set for engage
and disengage if the park brake is released.
Set to the speed that the vehicle has to be below for
the PTO to engage. The PTO will disengage if the
vehicle speed becomes greater than the set value. If
vehicle speed is required for PTO operation, please
use PTOa_Vehicle_Speed_Enable parameter to
enable this interlock.
If an engine speed alarm is required for PTO operation,
please use PTOa_Engine_Speed_Alarm_Enable
parameter to enable this alarm.
Set to a speed limit that an alarm will sound when the
PTO is engaged and the vehicle speed is greater than
the set value. If the vehicle alarm is required for PTO
operation, please use
PTOa_Vehicle_Speed_Alarm_Enable to enable this
alarm.
NOTE, this parameter will only work for vehicles with
automated manual transmissions. Set to 1 to ensure
that the transmission is in neutral for engagement.
October 2012
Default
Min
Max
Step
On
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
300
300
3000
10
On
N/A
N/A
N/A
100
300
300
3000
10
100
On
N/A
N/A
N/A
SECTION 23 - PAGE 61
PARAMETERS
ENGAGEMENT
These parameters set rules that must be met in order for the PTO to be engaged.
If TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, the PTO cannot be engaged if the primary
vehicle air pressure is below the programmable parameter set by TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_Engmnt_Limit.
If TEM_PTO_Brake_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the brake pedal must be depressed in order
for the PTO to engage.
If TEM_PTO_Cltch_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the clutch pedal must be depressed for the
PTO to engage.
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Run_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the engine has to be running in order for
the PTO to be engaged.
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the PTO cannot be engaged if the engine
speed is over a certain threshold, which is defined as a programmable parameter in
TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_Engmnt_Limit
If TEM_PTO_Neut_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the PTO can only be engaged if the
transmission is NOT in Neutral or Park.
If TEM_PTO_Non_Neut_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the transmission must be in Neutral or
Park for the PTO to be engaged.
If TEM_PTO_Pk_Brake_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the park brake must be set in order for the
PTO to be engaged.
If TEM_PTO_Veh_Spd_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the PTO cannot be engaged if the vehicle
speed is over the value prescribed by TEM_PTO_Veh_Spd_Engmnt_Limit.
If TEM_PTO_Mast_Switch_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the PTO will not be engaged if the
vehicle master switch is not ON.
SECTION 23 - PAGE 62
October 2012
ID
Description
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will not be engaged if
the primary vehicle air pressure is below
TEM_PTO_Air_ Pres_Engmnt_ Limit
Default
Min
Max
Step
On
N/A
N/A
N/A
2098
90 psi
500
2095
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
2094
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
2096
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
2092
On
N/A
N/A
N/A
2093
1000 RPM
100
5000
2089
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
2088
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
2087
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
2090
On
N/A
N/A
N/A
2091
3 MPH
100
2099
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
2097
DISENGAGEMENT
These parameters set the conditions under which the PTO will be disengaged.
If TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_Disengages parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the primary air
pressure is below the value set in TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_DisEng_Limit.
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Run_Disengages parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the engine is
turned off.
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_Disengages parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the engine
speed rises above the value set by TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_DisEng_Limit.
If TEM_PTO_ Non_Neut _Disengages parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the
transmission is taken out of neutral.
If TEM_PTO_Pk_Brake_Disengages parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the Park Brake
is released.
October 2012
SECTION 23 - PAGE 63
ID
Description
Default
Min
Max
Step
2116
80 psi
500
2115
On
N/A
N/A
N/A
2114
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
2113
1800 RPM
5000
2112
On
N/A
N/A
N/A
2109
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
2108
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
2110
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
2111
0 MPH
100
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
RE-ENGAGEMENT
These parameters set the conditions under which the PTO can be reengaged.
If TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_Allow_ReEng parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be reengaged (after
disengagement due to low air pressure) when the primary air pressure rises about the value specified by
TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_Engmnt_Limit.
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Run_Allow_ReEng parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be reengaged (after
disengagement due to engine stopping) when the engine is restarted.
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_Allow_ReEng parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be reengaged (after
disengagement due to engine overspeed) when the engine speed falls below
TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_Engmnt_Limit.
If TEM_PTO_Key_State_Allow_ReEng parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be allowed to reengage when
the key state is returned to run.
SECTION 23 - PAGE 64
October 2012
ID
Description
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be reengaged after
disengagement due to low vehicle air pressure when
2124
the primary air pressure is over TEM_PTO_Air_
Pres_Engmnt_ Limit.
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be reengaged after
2122 disengagement due to the engine stopping when the
engine is restarted.
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be reengaged after
disengagement due to engine overspeed when the
2120
engine speed is below TEM_PTO_Eng_ Spd_Engmnt_
Limit.
2069
2148
2149
TEM_PTO_
Veh_Spd_
Allow_ReEng
2119
TEM_PTO_Ext_
Input_Allow_ReEng
2121
TEM_PTO_Mast_
Switch_Allow_
ReEng
2123
Default
Min
Max
Step
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
On
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
ALARMS
These parameters utilize the gauge cluster to sound an alarm to the driver when certain programmable
parameters are violated.
If TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_Alarms parameter is turned on, then an audible alarm will sound in the cab if the
primary air pressure drops below the value specified by TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_Alarm_Limit.
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Run_Alarms parameter is turned on, then an audible alarm will sound in the cab if the PTO
is engaged and the engine is turned off.
October 2012
SECTION 23 - PAGE 65
ID
Description
If this Parameter is 1, an alarm will sound if the primary
2138
air pressure is below TEM_PTO_Air_
Pres_Alarm_Limit.
2139
2137
2135
See TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_Alarms
If this Parameter is 1, an alarm will sound if the PTO is
engaged and the engine is turned off.
If this Parameter is 1, an alarm will sound if the PTO is
engaged and the engine speed is over
TEM_PTO_Eng_ Spd_Alarm_Limit.
2136
2132
2131
TEM_PTO_
Veh_Spd_ Alarms
2133
TEM_PTO_Veh_
Spd_Alarm_Limit
2134
See TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_Alarms
If this Parameter is 1, an alarm will sound if the PTO is
engaged and transmission is taken out of neutral.
If this Parameter is 1, an alarm will sound if the PTO is
engaged and the park brake is released
If this Parameter is 1, an alarm will sound if the PTO is
engaged and the vehicle speed is over
TEM_PTO_Veh_ Spd_Alarm_Limit.
See TEM_PTO_Veh_Spd_Alarms
Default
Min
Max
Step
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
0 psi
500
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
1400 RPM
5000
0.1
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
5 mph
100
WIRING INFORMATION
Customer must supply and route air plumbing from the Navistar-provided air solenoid (Located inside the
drivers side frame rail, adjacent to the Transmission) to the PTO.
SECTION 23 - PAGE 66
October 2012
f_136
TESTING
1. Depress the In-cab PTO switch to the ON position.
2. Verify that all enabled interlock conditions are met.
3. Verify that the Navistar-provided air solenoid is supplying air pressure at the solenoid output.
October 2012
SECTION 23 - PAGE 67
SECTION 23 - PAGE 68
October 2012
October 2012
SECTION 23 - PAGE 69
ID
PTOb_Clutch_Pedal
2017
PTOb_Engine_
Running
2018
PTOb_Engine_
Speed_Range
2019
PTOb_Transmission
_Neutral
2020
PTOb_Park_Brake
2021
PTOb_Vehicle_
Speed_Range
2031
PTOb_Engine_
Speed_Enable
2050
PTOb_Engine_
Speed_Alarm
2051
PTOb_Vehicle_
Speed_Enable
2052
PTOb_Vehicle_
Speed_Alarm_
Enable
2053
SECTION 23 - PAGE 70
Description
Set to 1 to ensure that the clutch pedal is
depressed for engagement.
Set to 1 to ensure that the engine is
running to engage and disengage if the
engine stops running.
Set to a speed that the engine has to be
below for the PTO to engage. The PTO
will disengage if the engine speed
becomes greater than the set value. If
engine speed is required for PTO
operation, please use
PTOb_Engine_Speed_Enable to enable
this interlock.
NOTE, this parameter will only work for
vehicles with automated manual
transmissions. Set to 1 to ensure that the
transmission is in neutral for
engagement.
Set to 1 to ensure that the park brake is
set for engage and disengage if the park
brake is released.
Set to the speed that the vehicle has to
be below for the PTO to engage. The
PTO will disengage if the vehicle speed
becomes greater than the set value. If
vehicle speed is required for PTO
operation, please use
PTOb_Vehicle_Speed_Enable parameter
to enable this interlock.
Set to 1 to require the vehicle to be below
a specified engine speed for the PTO to
be engaged. Please use
PTOb_Engine_Speed_Range to specify
the appropriate engine speed if this
parameter is set to 1.
Set to 1 to have a speed that an alarm
will sound when the PTO is engaged and
the engine speed is greater than the set
value. Please use
PTOb_Engine_Speed_Alarm_Range to
specify the appropriate engine speed if
this parameter is set to 1.
Set to 1 to require the vehicle to be below
a specified vehicle speed for the PTO to
engage. Please use
PTOb_Vehicle_Speed_Range to specify
the appropriate vehicle speed if this
parameter is set to 1.
Set to 1 to have a speed limit that an
alarm will sound when the PTO is
engaged and the vehicle speed is greater
than the set value. Please use
PTOb_Vehicle_Speed_Alarm_Range to
specify the appropriate vehicle speed if
this parameter is set to 1.
October 2012
Default
Min
Max
Step
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
On
N/A
N/A
N/A
300
300
3000
10
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
On
N/A
N/A
N/A
100
On
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
On
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
ID
PTOb_Engine_
Speed_Alarm_
Range
2140
PTOb_Vehicle_
Speed_Alarm_
Range
2141
PTOa_Vehicle_
Speed_Enable
2242
PTOa_Engine_
Speed_Enable
2243
PTOa_Engine_
Speed_Alarm_
Enable
2244
Vehicle_Speed_
Alarm_Enable PTOa
2267
PTOa_Clutch_
Pedal
2333
PTOa_Engine_
Running
2334
PTOa_Engine_
Speed_Range
2336
PTOa_Park_Brake
2338
Description
Set to a speed that an alarm will sound
when the PTO is engaged and the engine
speed is greater than the set value. If an
engine speed alarm is required for PTO
operation, please use
PTOb_Engine_Speed_Alarm_Enable
parameter to enable this alarm.
Set to a speed limit that an alarm will
sound when the PTO is engaged and the
vehicle speed is greater than the set
value. If the vehicle alarm is required for
PTO operation, please use
PTOb_Vehicle_Speed_Alarm_Enable to
enable this alarm.
Set to 1 to require the vehicle to be below
a specified vehicle speed for the PTO to
engage. Please use
PTOa_Vehicle_Speed_Range to specify
the appropriate vehicle speed if this
parameter is set to 1..
Set to 1 to require the vehicle to be below
a specified engine speed for the PTO to
be engaged. Please use
PTOa_Engine_Speed_Range to specify
the appropriate engine speed if this
parameter is set to 1.
Set to 1 to have a speed that an alarm
will sound when the PTO is engaged and
the engine speed is greater than the set
value. Please use
PTOa_Engine_Speed_Alarm_Range to
specify the appropriate engine speed if
this parameter is set to 1.
Set to 1 to have a speed limit that an
alarm will sound when the PTO is
engaged and the vehicle speed is greater
than the set value. Please use
PTOa_Vehicle_Speed_Alarm_Range to
specify the appropriate vehicle speed if
this parameter is set to 1.
Set to 1 to ensure that the clutch pedal is
depressed for engagement.
Set to 1 to ensure that the engine is
running to engage and disengage if the
engine stops running.
Set to a speed that the engine has to be
below for the PTO to engage. The PTO
will disengage if the engine speed
becomes greater than the set value. If
engine speed is required for PTO
operation, please use
PTOa_Engine_Speed_Enable to enable
this interlock.
Set to 1 to ensure that the park brake is
set for engage and disengage if the park
brake is released.
October 2012
Default
Min
Max
Step
300
300
3000
10
100
On
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
300
300
3000
10
On
N/A
N/A
N/A
SECTION 23 - PAGE 71
ID
PTOa_Vehicle_
Speed_Range
2339
PTOa_Engine_
Speed_Alarm_
Range
2340
PTOa_Vehicle_
Speed_Alarm_
Range
2342
PTOa_
Transmission_
Neutral
2355
Description
Set to the speed that the vehicle has to
be below for the PTO to engage. The
PTO will disengage if the vehicle speed
becomes greater than the set value. If
vehicle speed is required for PTO
operation, please use
PTOa_Vehicle_Speed_Enable parameter
to enable this interlock.
If an engine speed alarm is required for
PTO operation, please use
PTOa_Engine_Speed_Alarm_Enable
parameter to enable this alarm.
Set to a speed limit that an alarm will
sound when the PTO is engaged and the
vehicle speed is greater than the set
value. If the vehicle alarm is required for
PTO operation, please use
PTOa_Vehicle_Speed_Alarm_Enable to
enable this alarm.
NOTE, this parameter will only work for
vehicles with automated manual
transmissions. Set to 1 to ensure that
the transmission is in neutral for
engagement.
Default
Min
Max
Step
100
300
300
3000
10
100
On
N/A
N/A
N/A
PARAMETERS
ENGAGEMENT
These parameters set rules that must be met in order for the PTO to be engaged.
If TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, the PTO cannot be engaged if the primary
vehicle air pressure is below the programmable parameter set by TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_Engmnt_Limit.
If TEM_PTO_Brake_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the brake pedal must be depressed in order
for the PTO to engage.
If TEM_PTO_Cltch_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the clutch pedal must be depressed for the
PTO to engage.
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Run_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the engine has to be running in order for
the PTO to be engaged.
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the PTO cannot be engaged if the engine
speed is over a certain threshold, which is defined as a programmable parameter in
TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_Engmnt_Limit
If TEM_PTO_Neut_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the PTO can only be engaged if the
transmission is NOT in Neutral or Park.
If TEM_PTO_Non_Neut_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the transmission must be in Neutral or
Park for the PTO to be engaged.
If TEM_PTO_Pk_Brake_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the park brake must be set in order for the
PTO to be engaged.
If TEM_PTO_Veh_Spd_Engmnt_Inhib parameter is turned on, then the PTO cannot be engaged if the vehicle
speed is over the value prescribed by TEM_PTO_Veh_Spd_Engmnt_Limit.
SECTION 23 - PAGE 72
October 2012
October 2012
SECTION 23 - PAGE 73
ID
TEM_PTO_
Air_Pres_
Engmnt_Inhib
2097
TEM_PTO_
Air_Pres_
Engmnt_Limit
TEM_PTO_
Brake_Engmnt_
Inhib
TEM_PTO_
Cltch_Engmnt_
Inhib
TEM_PTO_
Eng_Run_
Engmnt_Inhib
2098
2095
2094
Description
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will not be
engaged if the primary vehicle air
pressure is below TEM_PTO_Air_
Pres_Engmnt_ Limit
See TEM_PTO_Air_ Pres_Engmnt_
Inhib
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will not be
engaged if the brake pedal is not
depressed
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will not be
engaged when the clutch pedal is not
depressed
Default
Min
Max
Step
On
N/A
N/A
N/A
90 psi
500
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
2096
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
TEM_PTO_
Eng_Spd_
Engmnt_Inhib
2092
On
N/A
N/A
N/A
TEM_PTO_
Eng_Spd_
Engmnt_Limit
2093
1000 RPM
100
5000
TEM_PTO_
Neut_Engmnt_ Inhib
2089
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
TEM_PTO_
Non_Neut_
Engmnt_Inhib
TEM_PTO_Pk_
Brake_Engmnt_
Inhib
TEM_PTO_
Veh_Spd_
Engmnt_Inhib
TEM_PTO_
Veh_Spd_
Engmnt_Limit
TEM_PTO_Mast_
Switch_Engmnt_
Inhib
TEM_PTOb_
Air_Pres_
Engmnt_Inhib
TEM_PTOb_
Air_Pres_
Engmnt_Limit
TEM_PTO_
Brake_Engmnt_
Inhib
TEM_PTOb_
Cltch_Engmnt_
Inhib
TEM_PTOb_
Eng_Run_
Engmnt_Inhib
SECTION 23 - PAGE 74
2088
2087
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
2090
On
N/A
N/A
N/A
2091
3 MPH
100
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
On
N/A
N/A
N/A
90 psi
500
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
2099
2711
2712
2676
2677
2678
October 2012
ID
TEM_PTOb_
Eng_Spd_
Engmnt_Inhib
2679
TEM_PTOb_
Eng_Spd_
Engmnt_Limit
TEM_PTOb_
Neut_Engmnt_
Inhib
TEM_PTOb_
Non_Neut_
Engmnt_Inhib
TEM_PTOb_Pk_
Brake_Engmnt_
Inhib
TEM_PTOb_
Veh_Spd_
Engmnt_Inhib
TEM_PTOb_
Veh_Spd_
Engmnt_Limit
TEM_PTOb_Mast_
Switch_Engmnt_
Inhib
2680
2681
2682
Description
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will not be
engaged if the engine speed is over the
value set in TEM_PTO_Eng_
Spd_Engmnt_ Limit
See TEM_PTO_Eng_ Spd_Engmnt_
Inhib
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will only
be engaged if the Transmission is not in
Neutral or Park
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will not be
engaged if the Transmission is not in
Neutral or Park
Default
Min
Max
Step
On
N/A
N/A
N/A
1000 RPM
100
5000
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
2683
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
2684
On
N/A
N/A
N/A
2685
3 MPH
100
2714
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
DISENGAGEMENT
These parameters set the conditions under which the PTO will be disengaged.
If TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_Disengages parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the primary air
pressure is below the value set in TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_DisEng_Limit.
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Run_Disengages parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the engine is
turned off.
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_Disengages parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the engine
speed rises above the value set by TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_DisEng_Limit.
If TEM_PTO_ Non_Neut _Disengages parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the
transmission is taken out of neutral.
If TEM_PTO_Pk_Brake_Disengages parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the Park Brake
is released.
If TEM_PTO_Veh_Spd_Disengages parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the vehicle
speed is over the valued specified by TEM_PTO_Veh_Spd_DisEng_Limit.
If TEM_PTO_Ext_Input_Disengages is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the external input
designated for this purpose is active.
If TEM_PTO_Mast_Switch_Disengages is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the vehicle master
switch is not ON.
If TEM_PTOb_Air_Pres_Disengages parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the primary air
pressure is below the value set in TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_DisEng_Limit.
If TEM_PTOb_Eng_Run_Disengages parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be disengaged if the engine is
turned off.
October 2012
SECTION 23 - PAGE 75
ID
Description
Default
Min
Max
Step
2116
80 psi
500
2115
On
N/A
N/A
N/A
2114
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
5000
On
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
2113
2112
2109
2108
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
TEM_PTO_
Veh_Spd_
Disengages
2110
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
TEM_PTO_
Veh_Spd_
DisEng_Limit
2111
0 MPH
100
TEM_PTO_Ext_
Input_Disengages
2117
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
TEM_PTO_Mast_
Switch_Disengages
2118
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
TEM_PTOb_
Air_Pres_
DisEng_Limit
2719
80 psi
500
SECTION 23 - PAGE 76
October 2012
ID
TEM_PTOb_
Air_Pres_
Disengages
2716
TEM_PTOb_
Eng_Run_
Disengages
TEM_PTOb_
Eng_Spd_
DisEng_Limit
TEM_PTOb_
Eng_Spd_
Disengages
TEM_PTOb_
Non_Neut_
Disengages
TEM_PTOb_
Pk_Brake_
Disengages
2686
2687
2688
2689
Description
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be
disengaged if the primary air pressure is
below the value set in TEM_PTO_Air_
Pres_DisEng_ Limit.
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be
disengaged if the engine is turned off.
Default
Min
Max
Step
On
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
5000
On
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
2690
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
TEM_PTOb_
Veh_Spd_
Disengages
2691
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
TEM_PTOb_
Veh_Spd_
DisEng_Limit
2692
0 MPH
100
TEM_PTOb_Ext_
Input_Disengages
2772
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
TEM_PTOb_Mast_
Switch_Disengages
2718
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
RE-ENGAGEMENT
These parameters set the conditions under which the PTO can be reengaged.
If TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_Allow_ReEng parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be reengaged (after
disengagement due to low air pressure) when the primary air pressure rises about the value specified by
TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_Engmnt_Limit.
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Run_Allow_ReEng parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be reengaged (after
disengagement due to engine stopping) when the engine is restarted.
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_Allow_ReEng parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be reengaged (after
disengagement due to engine overspeed) when the engine speed falls below
TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_Engmnt_Limit.
If TEM_PTO_Key_State_Allow_ReEng parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be allowed to reengage when
the key state is returned to run.
If TEM_PTO_Non_Neut_Allow_ReEng parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be reengaged (after
disengagement due to transmission out of neutral) when the transmission is placed back into neutral.
If TEM_PTO_Pk_Brake_Allow_ReEng parameter is turned on, then the PTO will be reengaged (after
disengagement due to park brake released) when the park brake is reapplied.
October 2012
SECTION 23 - PAGE 77
SECTION 23 - PAGE 78
October 2012
ID
TEM_PTO_
Air_Pres_
Allow_ReEng
2124
TEM_PTO_
Eng_Run_
Allow_ReEng
2122
TEM_PTO_
Eng_Spd_
Allow_ReEng
2120
TEM_PTO_
Key_State_
Allow_ReEng
2069
TEM_PTO_
Non_Neut_
Allow_ReEng
2148
TEM_PTO_
Pk_Brake_
Allow_ReEng
2149
TEM_PTO_
Veh_Spd_
Allow_ReEng
2119
TEM_PTO_Ext_
Input_Allow_ReEng
2121
TEM_PTO_Mast_
Switch_Allow_
ReEng
2123
TEM_PTOb_
Air_Pres_
Allow_ReEng
2713
TEM_PTOb_
Eng_Run_
Allow_ReEng
2693
TEM_PTOb_
Eng_Spd_
Allow_ReEng
2694
TEM_PTOb_
Key_State_
Allow_ReEng
2696
TEM_PTOb_
Non_Neut_
Allow_ReEng
2697
Description
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be
reengaged after disengagement due to
low vehicle air pressure when the primary
air pressure is over TEM_PTO_Air_
Pres_Engmnt_ Limit.
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be
reengaged after disengagement due to
the engine stopping when the engine is
restarted.
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be
reengaged after disengagement due to
engine overspeed when the engine
speed is below TEM_PTO_Eng_
Spd_Engmnt_ Limit.
If this parameter is set, the PTO will be
allowed to reengage when the key state
is returned to run.
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be
reengaged after disengagement due to
transmission out of neutral when the
transmission is placed back into neutral.
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be
reengaged after disengagement due to
park brake released when the park brake
is reapplied.
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be
reengaged after disengagement due to
vehicle overspeed when the vehicle
speed is below TEM_PTO_Veh_
Spd_Engmnt_ Limit.
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be
reengaged after a disengage due to the
designated external input when the
external input is no longer active
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be
reengaged after a disengage due to the
master switch being turned off when the
master switch is turned on again
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be
reengaged after disengagement due to
low vehicle air pressure when the primary
air pressure is over TEM_PTO_Air_
Pres_Engmnt_ Limit.
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be
reengaged after disengagement due to
the engine stopping when the engine is
restarted.
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be
reengaged after disengagement due to
engine overspeed when the engine
speed is below TEM_PTO_Eng_
Spd_Engmnt_ Limit.
If this parameter is set, the PTO will be
allowed to reengage when the key state
is returned to run.
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be
reengaged after disengagement due to
transmission out of neutral when the
transmission is placed back into neutral.
October 2012
Default
Min
Max
Step
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
On
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
On
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
SECTION 23 - PAGE 79
ID
TEM_PTOb_
Pk_Brake_
Allow_ReEng
2698
TEM_PTOb_
Veh_Spd_
Allow_ReEng
2699
TEM_PTOb_Ext_
Input_Allow_ReEng
2771
TEM_PTOb_Mast_
Switch_Allow_
ReEng
2715
Description
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be
reengaged after disengagement due to
park brake released when the park brake
is reapplied.
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be
reengaged after disengagement due to
vehicle overspeed when the vehicle
speed is below TEM_PTO_Veh_
Spd_Engmnt_ Limit.
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be
reengaged after a disengage due to the
designated external input when the
external input is no longer active
If this Parameter is 1, the PTO will be
reengaged after a disengage due to the
master switch being turned off when the
master switch is turned on again
Default
Min
Max
Step
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
ALARMS
These parameters utilize the gauge cluster to sound an alarm to the driver when certain programmable
parameters are violated.
If TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_Alarms parameter is turned on, then an audible alarm will sound in the cab if the
primary air pressure drops below the value specified by TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_Alarm_Limit.
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Run_Alarms parameter is turned on, then an audible alarm will sound in the cab if the PTO
is engaged and the engine is turned off.
If TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_Alarms parameter is turned on, then an alarm will sound in the cab if the PTO is
engaged and the engine speed is over the value set by TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_Alarm_Limit.
If TEM_PTO_Non_Neut_Alarms parameter is turned on, then an audible alarm will sound in the cab if the PTO
is engaged and the transmission is taken out of neutral.
If TEM_PTO_Pk_Brake_Alarms parameter is turned on, then an audible alarm will sound in the cab if the PTO
is engaged and the park brake is released
If TEM_PTO_Veh_Spd_Alarms parameter is turned on, then an audible alarm will sound in the cab if the PTO is
engaged and the vehicle speed is about the value set by TEM_PTO_Veh_Spd_Alarm_Limit.
If TEM_PTOb_Air_Pres_Alarms parameter is turned on, then an audible alarm will sound in the cab if the
primary air pressure drops below the value specified by TEM_PTOb_Air_Pres_Alarm_Limit.
If TEM_PTOb_Eng_Run_Alarms parameter is turned on, then an audible alarm will sound in the cab if the PTO
is engaged and the engine is turned off.
If TEM_PTOb_Eng_Spd_Alarms parameter is turned on, then an alarm will sound in the cab if the PTO is
engaged and the engine speed is over the value set by TEM_PTO_Eng_Spd_Alarm_Limit.
If TEM_PTOb_Non_Neut_Alarms parameter is turned on, then an audible alarm will sound in the cab if the
PTO is engaged and the transmission is taken out of neutral.
If TEM_PTOb_Pk_Brake_Alarms parameter is turned on, then an audible alarm will sound in the cab if the PTO
is engaged and the park brake is released
If TEM_PTOb_Veh_Spd_Alarms parameter is turned on, then an audible alarm will sound in the cab if the PTO
is engaged and the vehicle speed is about the value set by TEM_PTO_Veh_Spd_Alarm_Limit.
SECTION 23 - PAGE 80
October 2012
ID
TEM_PTO_
Air_Pres_ Alarms
2138
TEM_PTO_Air_Pres
_Alarm_Limit
2139
TEM_PTO_
Eng_Run_ Alarms
2137
TEM_PTO_
Eng_Spd_ Alarms
2135
TEMP_PTO_Eng_
Spd_Alarm_Limit
2136
Description
If this Parameter is 1, an alarm will sound
if the primary air pressure is below
TEM_PTO_Air_ Pres_Alarm_Limit.
Default
Min
Max
Step
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
See TEM_PTO_Air_Pres_Alarms
0 psi
500
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
1400 RPM
5000
0.1
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
TEM_PTO_
Non_Neut_ Alarms
2132
TEM_PTO_
Pk_Brake_ Alarms
2131
TEM_PTO_
Veh_Spd_ Alarms
2133
TEM_PTO_Veh_
Spd_Alarm_Limit
2134
See TEM_PTO_Veh_Spd_Alarms
5 mph
100
TEM_PTOb_
Air_Pres_ Alarms
2700
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
TEM_PTOb_Air_
Pres_Alarm_Limit
2701
See TEM_PTOb_Air_Pres_Alarms
0 psi
500
TEM_PTOb_
Eng_Run_ Alarms
2702
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
TEM_PTOb_
Eng_Spd_ Alarms
2704
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
TEMP_PTOb_Eng_
Spd_Alarm_Limit
2703
1400 RPM
5000
0.1
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
5 mph
100
TEM_PTOb_
Non_Neut_ Alarms
2705
TEM_PTOb_
Pk_Brake_ Alarms
2706
TEM_PTOb_
Veh_Spd_ Alarms
2708
TEM_PTOb_Veh_
Spd_Alarm_Limit
2709
WIRING INFORMATION
Customer must supply and route air plumbing from the Navistar-provided air solenoid (Located inside the
drivers side frame rail, adjacent to the Transmission) to the PTO.
October 2012
SECTION 23 - PAGE 81
f_137
TESTING
1. Depress the In-cab PTO 1 or PTO 2 switch to the ON position.
2. Verify that all enabled interlock conditions are met.
3. Verify that the Navistar-provided air solenoid is supplying air pressure at the solenoid output.
SECTION 23 - PAGE 82
October 2012
PTO HOURMETER
16WLM
HOURMETER, PTO for Customer Provided PTO; Indicator Light and Hourmeter in Gauge Cluster Includes
Return Wire for PTO Feedback Switch
This feature provides the customer with a wire (Circuit K88B 14 gauge, light green cut blunt located in the
transmission harness) to be wired into a PTO body builder-installed feedback switch. Also included in this
feature is a PTO indicator light in the gauge cluster and a PTO hourmeter, which allows the operator to
measure stationary PTO hours for maintenance records and fuel tax purposes. To view the hourmeter, press
the gauge cluster selection button momentarily until the text portion of the display indicates PTO Hour.
This feature cannot be used if 16HGJ (Optional Transmission Oil Temperature Gauge for a MANUAL
Transmission) is utilized.
ID
Description
Default
2199 Active State for the PTO engagement feedback switch. No_Units
Min
Max
Step
N/A
NA
NA
WIRING INFORMATION
The customer must wire the Navistar-provided PTO engagement feedback return wire (14 gauge, Light Green)
into the PTO feedback switch which should be a GND active switch.
October 2012
SECTION 23 - PAGE 83
f_138
TESTING
1. Customer should apply the correct active state voltage (as programmed in the Diamond Logic Builder
software) to the Navistar-provided PTO engagement feedback wire.
2. Verify that the PTO indicator light in the gauge cluster comes on and stays on as long as the active state
voltage is applied.
SECTION 23 - PAGE 84
October 2012
October 2012
SECTION 24 - PAGE 1
SECTION 24 - PAGE 2
ID
Description
Default
Units
Min
Max
Step
1870
None
2240
None
October 2012
October 2012
f_140
SECTION 24 - PAGE 3
Remote Throttle Installation with Preset Engine Control Using the Remote
Engine Speed Controller (RESCM)
SECTION 24 - PAGE 4
October 2012
f_141
Remote Throttle Installation with Split Shaft Engine Control Using the Remote
Engine Speed Controller (RESCM)
October 2012
f_142
SECTION 24 - PAGE 5
Remote Throttle Installation with a Remote Throttle Pedal Control Using the
Remote Engine Speed Controller (RESCM)
SECTION 24 - PAGE 6
October 2012
f_143
f_144
October 2012
SECTION 24 - PAGE 7
SECTION 24 - PAGE 8
October 2012
f_147
October 2012
SECTION 24 - PAGE 9
f_148
SECTION 24 - PAGE 10
October 2012
f_149
TESTING
12VXY is tested and programmable parameters are set with Master Diagnostics or ServiceMaxx Software
packages.
October 2012
SECTION 24 - PAGE 11
WIRING INFORMATION
No additional wiring is associated with this feature.
TESTING
This feature is added by programming the Engine Control Module (ECM) for stationary, variable speed control.
Refer to the Body Builder Book CT-471 (PBB-71000A) for engine ECM programming functionality.
WIRING INFORMATION
No additional wiring is associated with this feature.
TESTING
This feature is added by programming the Engine Control Module (ECM) for stationary, pre-set speed control.
Refer to the Body Builder Book CT-471 (PBB-71000A) for engine ECM programming functionality.
SECTION 24 - PAGE 12
October 2012
WIRING INFORMATION
No additional wiring is associated with this feature.
TESTING
This feature is added by programming the Engine Control Module (ECM) for mobile, variable speed control.
Refer to the Body Builder Book CT-471 (PBB-71000A) for engine ECM programming functionality.
WIRING INFORMATION
The new connector associated with sales feature code 12VZA is illustrated below. The connector can be
located in the engine compartment near the megafuse above the driver side wheel well.
October 2012
SECTION 24 - PAGE 13
f_150
If the Engine Harness is not provided, the following diagrams show how to hard-wire this feature.
SECTION 24 - PAGE 14
October 2012
October 2012
f_151
SECTION 24 - PAGE 15
SECTION 24 - PAGE 16
October 2012
f_152
Remote Installation for Preset Engine Control Using the Hard Wired ECM
Inputs
October 2012
f_153
SECTION 24 - PAGE 17
Remote Installation for Engine Control Using the Hard Wired ECM
Inputs
SECTION 24 - PAGE 18
October 2012
f_154
October 2012
f_155
SECTION 24 - PAGE 19
SECTION 24 - PAGE 20
October 2012
f_156
ACTIVATION PARAMETERS:
1. Momentary 12 volt input to RPM
2. Park brake applied
3. Transmission in neutral or park or clutch pedal not depressed
4. Vehicle speed is less than one MPH
5. Engine running and at idle
6. Optional PTO feedback is true.
DEACTIVATION PARAMETERS:
1. Momentary GND input to RPM
2. Park brake not applied
3. Transmission not in neutral or park or clutch pedal depressed
4. Vehicle speed is greater than one MPH.
5. Engine not running
6. Service brake depressed
7. Optional PTO feedback not true
October 2012
SECTION 24 - PAGE 21
PROGRAMMABLE PARAMETERS
1. 2036 TEM_Ext_Eng_Spd_Ctrl_PTO_Ilock; This parameter sets the optional PTO interlock mode on or off.
If set on, the Remote engine speed control preset-1 will be interlocked to all International pre-engineered
PTO features that use a center panel switch. This means that the remote engine speed control will only be
allowed to operate if the PTO is being requested to engage. If this parameter is not set, the engine speed
control will operate regardless of the PTO request.
a. On
b. Off
2. 2035 TEM_Ext_Eng_Spd_Control_Mode; This parameter sets the mode of operation for the TEM external
engine speed control feature and should be set to 1.
a. 1, 12 volts on the engine speed control input causes engine to ramp to preset-1. GND on the same input
causes the engine to return to idle.
3. 2158 TEM_Ext_ Eng_Spd_ Ctrl_Active_State; This is the active state for the external engine speed control
switch input to the RPM and should be set to 3.
a. 3, 12 volts The input is connected to 12 volts through a switch.
SECTION 24 - PAGE 22
October 2012
ID
2036
2035
2158
Description
If this parameter is a one, external
engine speed controls will be
interlocked to PTO request.
This parameter sets the mode of
operation for the TEM external
engine speed control feature.
This is the active state for the
external engine speed control switch.
Default
Units
Min
Max
Step
On/Off
List
List
HARDWARE INSTALLATION
1. Reference the connectors tab within Diamond Logic Builder to verify the correct RPM input pin on the
black 23-pin connector. The pin is named Remote_Engine_Speed_Sw_Input.
2. Connect an 18 gauge wire to input pin, and run this wire to the center pole on the switch.
3. Connect one of the remaining switch poles to a 12 volt power source.
4. Connect the only remaining switch pole to a chassis GND source.
5. Mount switch.
Input connector part number 2005482C1
Input terminal part number 1698937C1
October 2012
SECTION 24 - PAGE 23
f_157
Feature Testing
1. Stationary Remote engine speed control preset-1 Activation; Start engine, set park brake, transmission in
neutral or park, vehicle speed is less than one MPH, and take the switch to the up position, or supply 12
volts on the input pin labeled Remote_Engine_Speed_Sw_Input, or use Diamond Logic Builder to force
the RPM input pin to the 12 volt state.
2. Verify the RPM input labeled Remote_Engine_Speed_Sw_Input (pin position specified Diamond Logic
Builder software) is receiving GND as long as the switch is closed.
3. Verify that the engine ramps to the first preset speed.
4. If engine does not ramp to the first preset speed, check engine programming to verify that the correct
engine speed control parameters are set.
5. Deactivate the remote engine speed control switch (release GND).
6. Verify the RPM input labeled Remote_Engine_Speed_Sw_Input (pin position specified Diamond Logic
Builder software) is an open circuit when switch is in the center stable position.
7. Verify that the engine returns to idle.
SECTION 24 - PAGE 24
October 2012
ACTIVATION PARAMETERS:
1. Momentary or latched GND or 12 volt input to RPM
2. Park brake applied
3. Transmission in neutral or park or clutch pedal not depressed
4. Vehicle speed is less than one MPH
5. Engine running and at idle
6. Optional PTO feedback is true.
DEACTIVATION PARAMETERS:
1. No GND or 12 volt input to RPM
2. Park brake not applied
3. Transmission not in neutral or park or clutch pedal depressed
4. Vehicle speed is greater than one MPH.
5. Engine not running
6. Service brake depressed
7. Optional PTO feedback not true
October 2012
SECTION 24 - PAGE 25
1. Use Diamond Logic Builder to install Body Controller (BC) software feature code 595AKK, and set the
feature code parameters to the following settings:
a. 595AKK Set parameter 2035 to 3. Reference feature configuration programmable parameters.
b. 595AKK Set parameter 2158 to 3 for 12 volt input or 1 for GND input. Reference feature configuration
programmable parameters.
c. 595AKK Set parameter 2036 to on for optional PTO interlock. Reference feature configuration
programmable parameters.
2. Use Diamond Logic Builder to remove BC software feature codes 595AKJ, 595AKL, 595AKM, and
595AN.
3. Use Master Diagnostics to program Engine control module: PTO in-cab control: on
4. Use Master Diagnostics to program Engine control module: PTO in-cab mode: stationary pre-set
5. Use Master Diagnostics to program Engine control module: PTO Power Take Off mode: remote and in-cab
operation
6. Use Master Diagnostics to program Engine control module: PTO Preset-1 RPM set (700.00 to 2800.00)
(Note: this is the RPM the customer or TEM has requested).
PROGRAMMABLE PARAMETERS
1. 2036 TEM_Ext_Eng_Spd_Ctrl_PTO_Ilock; This parameter sets the optional PTO interlock mode on or off.
If set on, the Remote engine speed control preset-1 will be interlocked to all International pre-engineered
PTO features that use a center panel switch. This means that the remote engine speed control will only be
allowed to operate if the PTO is being requested to engage. If this parameter is not set, the engine speed
control will operate regardless of the PTO request.
a. On
b. Off
2. 2035 TEM_Ext_Eng_Spd_Control_Mode; This parameter sets the mode of operation for the TEM external
engine speed control feature and should be set to 3.
a. 3, Engine will ramp for only as long as the engine speed control input is held in its active state.
3. 2158 TEM_Ext_ Eng_Spd_ Ctrl_Active_State; This is the active state for the external engine speed control
switch input to the RPM and should be set to 3 or 1.
a. 3, 12 volts The input is connected to 12 volts through a switch.
b. 1, GND The input is connected to GND through a switch.
SECTION 24 - PAGE 26
October 2012
ID
2036
2035
2158
Description
If this parameter is a one, external
engine speed controls will be
interlocked to PTO request.
This parameter sets the mode of
operation for the TEM external
engine speed control feature.
This is the active state for the
external engine speed control switch.
Default
Units
Min
Max
Step
On/Off
List
List
HARDWARE INSTALLATION
1. Reference the connectors tab within Diamond Logic Builder to verify the correct RPM input pin on the
black 23-pin connector. The pin is named Remote_Engine_Speed_Sw_Input.
2. Connect an 18 gauge wire to input pin, and run this wire to one pole on the switch.
3. Connect the remaining switch pole to a 12 volt or GND power source.
4. Mount switch.
Input connector part number 2005482C1
Input terminal part number 1698937C1
October 2012
SECTION 24 - PAGE 27
f_156
FEATURE TESTING
1. Stationary Remote engine speed control preset-1 Activation; Start engine, set park brake, transmission in
neutral or park, vehicle speed is less than one MPH, and take the switch to the closed position, or supply
12 volts or GND on the input pin labeled Remote_Engine_Speed_Sw_Input, or use Diamond Logic
Builder to force the RPM input pin to the 12 volt or GND state.
2. Verify the RPM input labeled Remote_Engine_Speed_Sw_Input (pin position specified Diamond Logic
software) is receiving GND or 12 volts as long as the switch is closed.
3. Verify that the engine ramps to the first preset speed.
4. If engine does not ramp to the first preset speed, check engine programming to verify that the correct
engine speed control parameters are set.
5. Deactivate the remote engine speed control switch (release GND).
6. Verify the RPM input labeled Remote_Engine_Speed_Sw_Input (pin position specified Diamond Logic
Builder software) is an open circuit when switch is in the down or open position.
7. Verify that the engine returns to idle.
SECTION 24 - PAGE 28
October 2012
ACTIVATION PARAMETERS
1. First momentary GND or 12 volt input to RPM
2. Park brake applied
3. Transmission in neutral or park or clutch pedal not depressed
4. Vehicle speed is less than one MPH
5. Engine running and at idle
6. Optional PTO feedback is true.
DEACTIVATION PARAMETERS:
1. Second momentary GND or 12 volt input to RPM
2. Park brake not applied
3. Transmission not in neutral or park or clutch pedal depressed
4. Vehicle speed is greater than one MPH.
5. Engine not running
6. Service brake depressed
7. Optional PTO feedback not true
October 2012
SECTION 24 - PAGE 29
1. Use Diamond Logic to install Body Controller (BC) software feature code 595AKL, and set the feature
code parameters to the following settings:
a. 595AKL Set parameter 2035 to 2. Reference feature configuration programmable parameters.
b. 595AKL Set parameter 2158 to 3 for 12 volt input or 1 for GND input. Reference feature configuration
programmable parameters.
c. 595AKL Set parameter 2036 to on for optional PTO interlock. Reference feature configuration
programmable parameters.
2. Use Diamond Logic Builder to remove BC software feature codes 595AKK, 595AKJ, 595AKM, and
595AKN.
3. Use Master Diagnostics to program Engine control module: PTO in-cab control: on
4. Use Master Diagnostics to program Engine control module: PTO in-cab mode: stationary pre-set
5. Use Master Diagnostics to program Engine control module: PTO Power Take Off mode: remote and in-cab
operation
6. Use Master Diagnostics to program Engine control module: PTO Preset-1 RPM set (700.00 to 2800.00)
(Note: this is the RPM the customer or TEM has requested)
PROGRAMMABLE PARAMETERS
1. 2036 TEM_Ext_Eng_Spd_Ctrl_PTO_Ilock; This parameter sets the optional PTO interlock mode on or off.
If set on, the Remote engine speed control preset-1 will be interlocked to all International pre-engineered
PTO features that use a center panel switch. This means that the remote engine speed control will only be
allowed to operate if the PTO is being requested to engage. If this parameter is not set, the engine speed
control will operate regardless of the PTO request.
a. On
b. Off
2. 2035 TEM_Ext_Eng_Spd_Control_Mode; This parameter sets the mode of operation for the TEM external
engine speed control feature and should be set to 3.
a. 3, Pulling the engine speed control input momentarily to its active state causes the engine to ramp to
preset-1; another momentary active state causes the engine to return to idle.
3. 2158 TEM_Ext_ Eng_Spd_ Ctrl_Active_State; This is the active state for the external engine speed control
switch input to the RPM and should be set to 3 or 1.
a. 3, 12 volts The input is connected to 12 volts through a switch.
b. 1, GND The input is connected to GND through a switch.
Table 164
Parameter
TEM_Ext_
Eng_Spd_
Ctrl_PTO_ Ilock
TEM_Ext_
Eng_Speed_
Control_ Mode
TEM_Ext_
Eng_Spd_
Ctrl_Active_
State
ID
2036
2035
2158
SECTION 24 - PAGE 30
Description
If this parameter is a one, external
engine speed controls will be
interlocked to PTO request.
This parameter sets the mode of
operation for the TEM external
engine speed control feature.
This is the active state for the
external engine speed control switch.
Default
Units
Min
Max
Step
On/Off
List
List
October 2012
f_156
FEATURE TESTING
1. Stationary Remote engine speed control preset-1 Activation; Start engine, set park brake, transmission in
neutral or park, vehicle speed is less than one MPH, and take the switch to the closed position, or supply
12 volts or GND on the input pin labeled Remote_Engine_Speed_Sw_Input, or use Diamond Logic
Builder to force the RPM input pin to the 12 volt or GND state.
2. Verify the RPM input labeled Remote_Engine_Speed_Sw_Input (pin position specified Diamond Logic
Builder software) is receiving GND or 12 volts as long as the switch is closed.
3. Verify that the engine ramps to the first preset speed.
4.
If engine does not ramp to the first preset speed, check engine programming to verify that the correct
engine speed control parameters are set.
October 2012
SECTION 24 - PAGE 31
SECTION 24 - PAGE 32
October 2012
1. Use Diamond Logic to install Body Controller (BC) software feature code 595AKM, and set the feature
code parameters to the following settings:
a. 595AKM Set Parameter 2060, fusing value for the output driving the emergency pump in the
combination remote engine speed control emergency pump feature.
b. 595AKM Set parameter 2035 to 2. Reference feature configuration programmable parameters.
c. 595AKM Set parameter 2158 to 1 for GND input. Reference feature configuration programmable
parameters.
d. 595AKM Set parameter 2036 to on for optional PTO interlock. Reference feature configuration
programmable parameters.
2. Use Diamond Logic to remove BC software feature codes 595AKK, 595AKJ, 595AKL, and 595AKN.
3. Use Master Diagnostics to program Engine control module: PTO in-cab control: on
4. Use Master Diagnostics to program Engine control module: PTO in-cab mode: stationary pre-set
5. Use Master Diagnostics to program Engine control module: PTO Power Take Off mode: remote and in-cab
operation
6. Use Master Diagnostics to program Engine control module: PTO Preset-1 RPM set (700.00 to 2800.00)
(Note: this is the RPM the customer or TEM has requested)
PROGRAMMABLE PARAMETERS
1. 2060 TEM_Emergency_Pump_Fuse; fusing value for the output driving the emergency pump in the
combination remote engine speed control emergency pump feature
2. 2036 TEM_Ext_Eng_Spd_Ctrl_PTO_Ilock; This parameter sets the optional PTO interlock mode on or off.
If set on, the Remote engine speed control preset-1 will be interlocked to all International pre-engineered
PTO features that use a center panel switch. This means that the remote engine speed control will only be
allowed to operate if the PTO is being requested to engage. If this parameter is not set, the engine speed
control will operate regardless of the PTO request.
a. On
b. Off
October 2012
SECTION 24 - PAGE 33
ID
2060
2036
2035
2158
Description
Fusing value for the output driving
the emergency pump in the
combination remote engine speed
control emergency pump feature
If this parameter is a one, external
engine speed controls will be
interlocked to PTO request.
This parameter sets the mode of
operation for the TEM external
engine speed control feature.
This is the active state for the
external engine speed control switch.
Default
Units
Min
Max
Step
20
0.1
On/Off
List
List
HARDWARE INSTALLATION
1. Reference the connectors tab within Diamond Logic to verify the correct RPM input pin on the black
23-pin connector. The pin is named Remote_Engine_Speed_Sw_Input.
2. Reference the connectors tab within Diamond Logic to verify the correct RPM output pin on the brown
connector. The pin is named Utility_Emergency_Pump_Output.
3. Connect an 18 gauge wire to input pin, and run this wire to one pole on the switch.
4. Connect the remaining switch pole to a GND power source.
5. Connect emergency pump relay to RPM output connector using 12 gauge wire.
6. Mount switch.
Input connector part number 2005482C1
Input terminal part number 1698937C1
SECTION 24 - PAGE 34
October 2012
f_160
FEATURE TESTING
1. Verify the RPM input labeled Remote_Engine_Speed_Sw_Input (pin position specified Diamond Logic
software) is receiving GND as long as the switch is closed.
2. Verify that the engine ramps to the first preset speed.
3. If engine does not ramp to the first preset speed, check engine programming to verify that the correct
engine speed control parameters are set.
4. Deactivate the remote engine speed control switch (release GND).
5. Verify the RPM input labeled Remote_Engine_Speed_Sw_Input (pin position specified Diamond Logic
Builder software) is an open circuit when switch is in the down or open position.
6. Verify that the engine returns to idle.
7. Verify 12 volts 20 AMPS on RPM output connector labeled Utility_Emergency_Pump_Output.
October 2012
SECTION 24 - PAGE 35
ACTIVATION PARAMETERS:
1. Latched switch that supplies 12 volt input to RPM
2. Park brake applied
3. Transmission in neutral or park or clutch pedal not depressed
4. Vehicle speed is less than one MPH
5. Engine running and at idle
6. Optional PTO feedback is true.
DEACTIVATION PARAMETERS:
1. No 12 volt input to RPM
2. Park brake not applied
3. Transmission not in neutral or park or clutch pedal depressed
4. Vehicle speed is greater than one MPH.
5. Engine not running
6. Service brake depressed
7. Optional PTO feedback not true
SECTION 24 - PAGE 36
October 2012
1. Use Diamond Logic Builder to install Body Controller (BC) software feature code 595AKN, and set the
feature code parameters to the following settings:
a. 595AKN Set parameter 2035 to 3. Reference feature configuration programmable parameters.
b. 595AKN Set parameter 2158 to 3 for 12 volt input. Reference feature configuration programmable
parameters.
c. 595AKN Set parameter 2036 to on for optional PTO interlock. Reference feature configuration
programmable parameters.
2. Use Diamond Logic to remove BC software feature codes 595AKJ, 595AKK, 595AKL, and 595AKM.
3. Use Master Diagnostics to program Engine control module: PTO in-cab control: on
4. Use Master Diagnostics to program Engine control module: PTO in-cab mode: stationary pre-set
5. Use Master Diagnostics to program Engine control module: PTO Power Take Off mode: remote and in-cab
operation
6. Use Master Diagnostics to program Engine control module: PTO Preset-1 RPM set (700.00 to 2800.00)
(Note: this is the RPM the customer or TEM has requested)
PROGRAMMABLE PARAMETERS
1. 2036 TEM_Ext_Eng_Spd_Ctrl_PTO_Ilock; This parameter sets the optional PTO interlock mode on or off.
If set on, the Remote engine speed control preset-1 will be interlocked to all International pre-engineered
PTO features that use a center panel switch. This means that the remote engine speed control will only be
allowed to operate if the PTO is being requested to engage. If this parameter is not set, the engine speed
control will operate regardless of the PTO request.
a. On
b. Off
2. 2035 TEM_Ext_Eng_Spd_Control_Mode; This parameter sets the mode of operation for the TEM external
engine speed control feature and should be set to 3.
a. 3, Engine will ramp for only as long as the engine speed control input is held in its active state.
3. 2158 TEM_Ext_ Eng_Spd_ Ctrl_Active_State; This is the active state for the external engine speed control
switch input to the RPM and should be set to 3.
a. 3, 12 volts The input is connected to 12 volts through a switch.
Table 166
Parameter
TEM_Ext_
Eng_Spd_
Ctrl_PTO_ Ilock
TEM_Ext_
Eng_Speed_
Control_ Mode
TEM_Ext_
Eng_Spd_
Ctrl_Active_
State
ID
2036
2035
2158
Description
If this parameter is a one, external
engine speed controls will be
interlocked to PTO request.
This parameter sets the mode of
operation for the TEM external
engine speed control feature.
This is the active state for the
external engine speed control switch.
Default
Units
Min
Max
Step
On/Off
List
List
HARDWARE INSTALLATION
1. Reference the connectors tab within Diamond Logic to verify the correct RPM input pin on the black
23-pin connector. The pin is named Remote_Engine_Speed_Sw_Input.
October 2012
SECTION 24 - PAGE 37
f_156
FEATURE TESTING
1. Stationary Remote engine speed control preset-1 Activation; Start engine, set park brake, transmission in
neutral or park, vehicle speed is less than one MPH, and take the switch to the closed position, or supply
12 volts on the input pin labeled Remote_Engine_Speed_Sw_Input, or use Diamond Logic to force the
RPM input pin to the 12 volt.
2. Verify the RPM input labeled Remote_Engine_Speed_Sw_Input (pin position specified Diamond Logic
software) is receiving 12 volts as long as the switch is closed.
3. Verify that the engine ramps to the first preset speed.
4. If engine does not ramp to the first preset speed, check engine programming to verify that the correct
engine speed control parameters are set.
5. Deactivate the remote engine speed control switch (release 12 volts).
6. Verify the RPM input labeled Remote_Engine_Speed_Sw_Input (pin position specified Diamond Logic
software) is an open circuit when switch is in the down or open position.
7. Verify that the engine returns to idle.
SECTION 24 - PAGE 38
October 2012
Vehicle Speed
Engine Speed
Remote PTO On/Off
Remote PTO Ramp Up/Ramp Down
Frequency Output Signals for Driving Off-board Engine Warning Lights
Remote Throttle (Pedal) Control
Remote Engine Speed Control Features Available with 2004 Cummins Engines
Vehicle speed on a Cummins engine can be accessed on a datalink or via a second vehicle speed sensor
added to the transmission.
ACCESSORY WIRING
12VYL
ACCESSORY WIRING, SPECIAL For Road Speed Wire Coiled Under Instrument Panel for Customer Use
This feature provides a vehicle speed signal source from the engine ECM. This speedometer output is
calibrated to 30,000 pulses per mile.
PROGRAMMABLE PARAMETERS
None
WIRING INFORMATION
The Road Speed Wire is coiled under the instrument panel.
TESTING
Specific testing requirements depend upon the customer application.
October 2012
SECTION 24 - PAGE 39
SECTION 24 - PAGE 40
October 2012
Normally Closed
08WGA
SOLENOID, AIR for Customer Use; Provides (1) Normally Closed Pilot Air Source, Approx. 4 CFM, Includes
Switch in Cab; Air Available Only With Key in Ignition (IGN) or Accessory Position; Air Will Exhaust with Key
in Off Position
08WGB
SOLENOID, AIR for Customer Use; Provides (2) Normally Closed Pilot Air Source, Approx. 4 CFM, Includes
Switch in Cab; Air Available Only With Key in IGN or Accessory Position; Air Will Exhaust with Key in Off
Position
08WGC
SOLENOID, AIR for Customer Use; Provides (3) Normally Closed Pilot Air Source, Approx. 4 CFM, Includes
Switch in Cab; Air Available Only With Key in IGN or Accessory Position; Air Will Exhaust with Key in Off
Position
08WGD
SOLENOID, AIR for Customer Use; Provides (4) Normally Closed Pilot Air Source, Approx. 4 CFM, Includes
Switch in Cab; Air Available Only With Key in IGN or Accessory Position; Air Will Exhaust with Key in Off
Position
08WKM
SOLENOID, AIR for Customer Use; Provides (6) Normally Closed Pilot Air Source, Approx. 4 CFM, Includes
Switch in Cab; Air Available Only With Key in Ignition or Accessory Position; Air Will Exhaust with key in
Off Position
Normally Open
08WGP
SOLENOID, AIR for Customer Use; Provides (5) Normally Open Pilot Air Source, Approx. 4 CFM, Includes
Switch in Cab; Air Exhausted Only With Key in IGN or Accessory Position; Air Will be Supplied with Key in
Off Position
08WGR
SOLENOID, AIR for Customer Use; Provides (6) Normally Open Pilot Air Source, Approx. 4 CFM, Includes
Switch in Cab; Air Exhausted Only With Key in IGN or Accessory Position; Air Will be Supplied with Key in
Off Position
These air solenoids provide Instrument Panel (IP)-mounted, rocker switches and normally closed and/or
normally open air solenoids that allow the operator to control up to four normally closed or five or six normally
open body-mounted air accessories from the cab. Note: these air solenoids are to be used as a pilot air source
and are not to be used as an air supply. All of the air solenoid feature codes include windowed latching rocker
switches and do not include any interlock features. Product graphics are included for application to each switch
window.
October 2012
SECTION 25 - PAGE 1
WIRING INFORMATION
Use the Diamond Logic Builder software to determine switch locations of the air solenoid switches.
Customer supplies air plumbing from the air solenoids to the desired air-controlled accessory.
There are several positions where the solenoid packs may be mounted.
f_161
(1) The first 4-pack is mounted on the inboard side of the drivers side frame rail in front of the rear cab
crossmember.
(2) The second and third 4-packs for a 6x4 suspension are mounted on the forward rear suspension
crossmember.
(3) The second and third 4-packs for a 4x2 suspension are located on the passenger side frame rail in front of
the rear suspension crossmember.
(4) A 6x4 or SS 4x2 can have a fourth 4-pack which mounts on the passenger side frame rail in front of the
forward rear suspension crossmember.
SECTION 25 - PAGE 2
October 2012
f_162
TESTING
Directions For 4-Pack
This procedure can be used for each auxiliary air solenoid added to the vehicle.
1. Activate the in-cab auxiliary air solenoid switch.
2. Verify that the particular air solenoid either provides air pressure for normally closed or exhausts the air for
normally open solenoids.
3. Verify that the proper pin in the air solenoid 4-pack connector has battery voltage.
4. Pin A for all air solenoids should have continuity with the negative battery stud.
October 2012
SECTION 25 - PAGE 3
Description
3610975C1
3610976C1
3610977C1
3610978C1
3610973C1
3610974C1
2506711C91
2506712C91
2506713C91
3549776C4
3549777C4
f_163
SECTION 25 - PAGE 4
October 2012
WIRING INFORMATION
Both the hard wired rocker switch in the IP and the air horn switch in the steering wheel are connected to a
single input on the BC connector 1602 Pin F8. The air solenoid is driven from the BC output connector 1602 Pin
E12.
f_164
October 2012
SECTION 25 - PAGE 5
f_165
3. Use a switch hole punching tool to cut a hole in the plastic plate of the central IP plate.
4. Remove the storage box or 12-pack of switches located above plastic plate. Use a scribe or other marker
tool to outline the hard wired switch openings in the steel plate located behind the plastic switch plate.
5. Drill a pilot hole in the center of the desired switch location.
6. Use the switch punch to open the hole in the plastic plate. The recommended method to create a
rectangular switch slot is to use a Green Lee Punch (part number ZTSE4426 from SPX).
7. Insert the air horn switch in the plastic plate.
8. Wire the mating switch connector as Circuit Diagram Manual S08322, Chapter 4 Cab Accessories, Horn
Electric.
9. Attach the switch connector to the air horn switch.
10. Reinstall the plastic switch plate and central IP trim piece.
SECTION 25 - PAGE 6
October 2012
October 2012
f_166
SECTION 25 - PAGE 7
SECTION 25 - PAGE 8
October 2012
REMOTE START/STOP
REMOTE START/STOP
REMOTE START/STOP
Refer to the circuit diagram in S08322, Chapter 10, Chassis Accessories, Remote Start/Stop.
60ABC
BDY INTG, REMOTE START/STOP To Start and Stop Vehicle Engine
The Remote Start/Stop feature provides the operator with the ability to remotely start or stop the engine from a
single ground (GND) active switch closure located on the vehicle body equipment. The vehicle park brake must
be set, and the hood of the vehicle must be closed. The vehicle must also be equipped with an automatic
transmission and must be in neutral. This feature requires the customer to provide the GND active switch as
well as the wiring from that switch into the Remote Start/Stop connector located in the middle of the chassis.
The customer will also provide the terminals and seals for the International-provided connector.
ID
Description
Default
Units
Min
Max
Step
TEM_Rem_
Start_Stop_
PTO_Ilock
2192
Off
On/Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
TEM_Rem_
Start_Stop_
Crank_Delay_
Gen2
2438
0.5
0.1
0.01
WIRING INFORMATION
When 60ABC is ordered on a truck, a connector (# 9778) is provided for the TEM to wire into for Remote
Start/Stop. This connector is located in the mid-chassis harness. The mid-chassis harness is located
approximately halfway between the rear axle (or forward-rear axle for trucks with tandem rear axles) and the
back of the cab on the drivers side frame rail. The customer should wire into the circuit with the Dark Blue
wire (# N104CA).
The customer must provide a GND active momentary switch that is wired into the mid-chassis Remote
Start/Stop connector.
The customer must also order the terminals and seals (based on their wire gauge) for the
International-provided connector so that the customer can wire the switch into the connector.
Table 169
Customer Wire Gauge
12AWG
14AWG
16AWG
1673748C1
0587577C1
0587577C1
0589390C1
0589391C1
1652325C1
October 2012
SECTION 26 - PAGE 1
REMOTE START/STOP
f_167
TESTING
1. When starting and stopping the engine, make sure that the Body Builder switch is providing a GND signal
to the mid-chassis wire. The vehicle ignition (IGN) key must be in the ON position and the hood must be
closed.
2. If the engine is running, a momentary switch closure of the body builder-supplied switch will stop the
engine.
3. If the engine is stopped, push and hold the body builder-supplied switch until the vehicle starts.
SECTION 26 - PAGE 2
October 2012
REMOTE START/STOP
ID
2192
2072
2438
Description
If this parameter is set, the remote
start/stop functionality will not
function unless the PTO switch is in
the on position.
Time allotted to stop the engine for
the remote engine start stop with
emergency pump feature.
This is the time that the remote
start/stop feature delays before
starting to crank the engine.
Default
Units
Min
Max
Step
Off
On/Off
N/A
N/A
N/A
6-
0.01
0.5
0.1
0.01
WIRING INFORMATION
When 60ABD is ordered on a truck, two mid-chassis wires with a connector (# 9778) are provided for the
TEM to wire into for Remote Start/Stop with emergency pump. This connector is located in the mid-chassis
harness. The mid chassis harness is located approximately halfway between the rear axle (or forward-rear
axle for trucks with tandem rear axles) and the back of the cab on the drivers side frame rail.
The first wire is the wire used to stop and start the engine (# N104CA). It is a dark blue wire.
The second wire is used to control an emergency pump (#N59CA). It is a grey wire.
The customer must also order the terminals and seals (based on their wire gauge) for the
International-provided connector so that the customer can wire the switch into the connector.
October 2012
SECTION 26 - PAGE 3
REMOTE START/STOP
Table 171
Customer Wire Gauge
12AWG
14AWG
16AWG
1673748C1
0587577C1
0587577C1
0589390C1
0589391C1
1652325C1
The customer must provide a GND active momentary switch that is wired into the mid-chassis connector.
If the customer orders 60ABD but decides not to use an emergency pump, the customer should simply use
the Diamond Logic Builder software to enable software feature code 595AKW, and remove software
feature code 595AKV.
f_168
TESTING
1. When starting and stopping the engine, make sure that the Body Builder switch is providing a GND signal
to the mid-chassis wire. The vehicle IGN key must be in the ON position and the hood must be closed.
2. If the engine is running, a momentary switch closure of the body builder-supplied switch will stop the
engine.
3. If the engine is stopped, push and hold the body builder-supplied switch until the vehicle starts.
4. If the engine will not start, release the start/stop switch momentarily, activate the switch again, and hold it
until the emergency pump control wire supplies GND to the emergency pump relay. The emergency pump
will remain ON as long as the switch is active.
SECTION 26 - PAGE 4
October 2012
October 2012
SECTION 27 - PAGE 1
SECTION 27 - PAGE 2
October 2012
ID
Description
Default
Units
Min
Max
Step
2249
60
120
2234
10
10
0.1
2233
0.3
10
0.1
2232
0.3
10
0.1
60
Min
10
240
10
11.5
11.5
13.8
0.1
2235
2239
WIRING INFORMATION
For 08WJA and 08WJB
Please refer to Circuit Diagram Manual S08337, Chapter 10, Chassis Accessories, Power Source, Customer
Installed Lift Gate.
For 08WJA
The Body Builder will be required to cut the 2 straplocks securing the power cable and route and clip the power
cable to the lift gate motor. Then trim the power cable to length and add a lug terminal for securing cable to the
lift gate motor. Two product graphics, from the plastic bag for Body Builders, need to be installed on the van
body in the approximate locations shown.
For 08WJB
The Body Builder will be required to route a 0 gauge cable from the mag switch, back along the frame to the lift
gate motor.
Also the 3592400C93-REF 2 gauge Cable Assy, Lift Gate 33.5 feet Ref Cut to length is changed to 0
gauge cable. The Body Builder will be required to remove the 2 gauge cable from the mag switch, back along
the frame to the lift gate motor and replace it with the 0 gauge cable.
October 2012
SECTION 27 - PAGE 3
f_169
SECTION 27 - PAGE 4
October 2012
f_170
TESTING
1. The body builder or lift gate installer must bring the batteries up to a full charge before trying to test the
system for functionality.
2. With the batteries at a full charge, voltage in the 12.6 to 12.9 range and the lift gate power controlled by the
Battery Protection System, the system will operate as described in the above section.
HARDWARE
Please refer to Circuit Diagram Manual S08337, Chapter 10, Chassis Accessories, Customer Installed Lift Gate
for circuit locations and routing and an International dealer for parts information.
October 2012
SECTION 27 - PAGE 5
SECTION 27 - PAGE 6
October 2012
October 2012
SECTION 28 - PAGE 1
f_171
SECTION 28 - PAGE 2
October 2012
October 2012
f_172
f_173
SECTION 28 - PAGE 3
SECTION 28 - PAGE 4
AC Derating Curve
f_174
DC Derating Curve
f_175
October 2012
Software feature code 595AZU must be enabled on the vehicle Body Controller using the Diamond Logic
Builder software (see local dealer).
Parameter PPE3_param_incrThrottle_rqst_enable will enable the automatic throttle request. This will
automatically ramp the engine to the value set in parameter 2344 when the PowerPack is requested on.
Parameter PPE3_param_incrThrottle_startDelay is the amount of time that the PowerPack will wait to turn on.
This is to allow the engine to ramp to the operating RPM before the PowerPack is activated.
Parameter PPE3_param_incrThrottle_targetRPMs is the target RPM for the engine to ramp to when the
PowerPack is activated.
Parameter PPE3_param_incrThrottle_timeout is the amount of time that the inverter is inhibited from coming
back on due to inadequate engine speed.
Table 173
Parameter
ID
PPE3_param_
incrThrottle_
rqst_enable
2357
PPE3_param_
incrThrottle_
startDelay
2399
PPE3_param_
incrThrottle_
targetRPMs
PPE3_param_
incrThrottle_
timeout
Description
If this is true, then the automatic
throttle increase request has been
enabled.
This parameter allows the throttle to
ramp to the target RPM prior to
enabling the PPE. The logic for this
parameter is that a maximum load on
the PPE would turn off the inverter if
the alternator RPMs are not at target.
Default
Units
Min
Max
Step
On/Off
Seconds
0.1
2344
935
RPM
900
2000
2345
Seconds
30
0.1
October 2012
SECTION 28 - PAGE 5
f_176
SECTION 28 - PAGE 6
October 2012
f_177
POWERPACK 3 TROUBLESHOOTING
If the PowerPack 3 output does not power up or shuts down during vehicle operation, follow these steps to
troubleshoot the system:
1. Set the 120VAC ON/OFF switch to OFF position, and ensure interlocks are satisfied, as described above,
correcting as necessary.
2. Attempt to restart the PowerPack 3 by pressing the ON switch.
3. If the unit continues to shut-down, (blinking green light in the rocker switch) disconnect any AC loads before
restarting the PowerPack 3.
4. Check for green light on GFCI. If there is a red light press the reset button on GFCI.
5. Press the 120VAC switch to OFF, check the 30-Amp circuit breaker, and reset if necessary.
6. Wait several minutes to allow the system alternator and PowerPack 3 unit to cool, and then attempt to
restart.
7. If the unit does not restart, then turn the vehicles ignition OFF, and then back ON again. This will restart the
PowerPack 3 output protection circuits.
8. If the above steps fail to restart the PowerPack 3 unit, then have the system serviced by a qualified
technician.
NOTE: If the unit does not restart, the problem could be caused by overheating or other circuit protection
devices. If the PowerPack 3 circuit breaker or the GFCI device is tripped, the green light in rocker switch will
continue to show an indication that AC power is ON. Be advised to check these other elements of the system if
120 volt AC power is not present as expected.
October 2012
SECTION 28 - PAGE 7
FMI
Byte 7
Byte 8
Switch Indicator
Blink Rate
168
Fast
168
Fast
168
Slow
168
Fast
168
Slow
168
Slow
168
Fast
168
16
Fast
168
16
Slow
168
17
Fast
639
14
37
255
Fast
SECTION 28 - PAGE 8
October 2012
FMI
Byte 7
Byte 8
Switch Indicator
Blink Rate
520467
Fast
168
Fast
520664
Slow
168
Fast
520644
Slow
520771
Slow
115
Fast
520774
Fast
520773
Slow
520772
31
Fast
639
37
255
Fast
NOTE: A complete aftermarket parts kit is under development. The PowerPack 3 kit part number is not
available at this time.
October 2012
SECTION 28 - PAGE 9
f_172
SECTION 28 - PAGE 10
October 2012
ALTERNATOR HARNESS
The harness from the PowerPack 3 to the alternator must be properly routed and securely fastened to avoid
any hot or sharp areas and to prevent cable movement. Failure to use the proper size wire can result in
overheating conditions that could cause fire, personal injury, and void of warranty.
h. Add Ignition (IGN) lead to the in-cab fuse relay panel.
1. Connect an 18 gauge wire from the PowerPack 3 IGN feed connector to the dash pass thru
connector 1702 pin 5.
2. Connect an 18 gauge wire from the dash pass thru connector 1702 pin 5 to an IGN feed in the cab
fuse/relay panel cavity G2-H2 (see fuse box detail).
3. Add 10 AMP fuse to fuse locations G2-H2.
4. Connect to inverter overlay harness (connector 9740 at the center of valve cover). Strap lock the
connector to the main center chassis harness.
5. Remove terminating resistor from J1939 datalink back bone harness (connector 7801M located on
the top center of the engine valve cover). Connect the PP3 J1939 datalink harness (connector
7801M) to J1939 inverter (connector 7801N). Save J1939 terminator resistor assembly.
6. Strap harness to existing harnesses.
Keep clear of sharp edges or anything that can rub or damage wire insulation.
4. Connect harness wires to the alternator.
a. Attach 3-Phase AC output ring terminal wires to bolt studs on the back of alternator. 80-120 in lb
(inch-pounds, NOT foot-pounds) Three phase wire attachment order to the alternator does not matter.
b. Attach field coil wires to the top of alternator using two nuts 15-20 in lb (inch- pounds, NOT
foot-pounds).
f_178
5. Make connections from the PowerPack 3 wire harness to the inverter module.
a. At back of the battery box:
October 2012
SECTION 28 - PAGE 11
SECTION 28 - PAGE 12
October 2012
f_179
Fuse Wiring
Route the AC power wiring separately from the DC wiring and low voltage wiring such as audio and video
signal wires with as much physical separation from the AC wires as possible.
WARNING: Fire Hazard. Make sure all connections are tight and properly made. Failure to follow this warning
may result in property damage, personal injury or death.
CAUTION: An in-line 150 AMP DC fuse is REQUIRED on the positive battery cable to properly protect the
PowerPack 3 and batteries. Failure to properly fuse the input leads to the PowerPack 3 can result in damage to
the unit.
10. Add switch to switch pack.
f_031
Insert the extraction tools (2) into the two holes on either side of a switch pack housing until the locking tabs are
fully depressed. The switch pack can then be removed from the panel and the extraction tools removed.
f_096
To remove individual switches or blanks from a switch pack, squeeze the locking tabs on the rear of the switch
or blank (top and bottom) and push it from the housing.
October 2012
SECTION 28 - PAGE 13
f_092
To install a switch in the switch pack housing, insert the switch in the proper slot, and push in until the switch
locking tabs are fully engaged (switches are keyed and cannot be installed upside down).
LED INSTALLATION
The LEDs are installed from the rear of the switch housing (snap fit rear cover must first be removed). The
amber backlight LED (part number 3533928C1) must be installed in the lower position and the green indicator
LED (part number 3578733C1) in the upper position. The LEDs can be identified by the color of the base
black for the amber LED and white for the green LED.
To install an LED, insert it into the hole in the printed wiring board and, with a small flat blade screwdriver, turn
the LED clockwise until locked. Replace the rear cover when complete.
11. Program Vehicle.
a. Using DLB, activate feature 0595AJU BC PROG, INVERTER ON In-Cab Multiplex Switch enables 3kw
Inverter.
b. After 0595AJU is activated, use DLB to locate position for 120 volt on switch location. Make note of
location for switch install. Exit DLB.
c. Use Master Diagnostics to program the engine for proper operation with PowerPack 3
Open Master Diagnostics. Turn IGN key on. Open com port, go to view >session>basic plus session. Right
click add/delete parameters, delete all currently selected parameters from Selected Parameters window. In
the available parameters window, double click on:
PTO Power Take Off mode
PTO in-cab control
PTO remote pedal
If PTO in-cab control is on, set Power Take Off mode to remote and in-cab operation.
If in-cab control is off, then set PTO mode to remote operation only.
Set remote pedal on.
Default ramp rate 100.
Right click, enter password, right click, then program all.
Cycle IGN key from off to on.
SECTION 28 - PAGE 14
October 2012
f_180
PROGRAMMABLE PARAMETERS
None
LOCATION
60AKD mounted Inside Rail, Back of Cab; 60AKE mounted Left Side Outside Rail, Back of Cab
APPLICATION RECOMMENDATION
Optional Equipment Any application that requires mobile power at a work site, such as Utility, Recovery,
Construction or Rescue applications.
October 2012
SECTION 28 - PAGE 15
SECTION 28 - PAGE 16
October 2012
f_171
October 2012
SECTION 28 - PAGE 17
SECTION 28 - PAGE 18
October 2012
f_172
f_173
AC Derating Curve
f_174
DC Derating Curve
f_175
October 2012
SECTION 28 - PAGE 19
SECTION 28 - PAGE 20
October 2012
ID
2473
2487
PPE3_param_
Auto_ReStart
2488
PPE3_param_
ReStart_
Attempts
2490
PPE3_param_
ReStart_Delay
2489
PPE3_param_
incrThrottle_
rqst_enable
2357
PPE3_param_
incrThrottle_sta
rtDelay
2399
PPE3_param_
incrThrottle_
targetRPMs
PPE3_param_
incrThrottle_
timeout
Description
If this is true, then the AC Power is
automatically activated when the
engine is started.
If this is true, then the AC Power is
available any time the engine is
running
If this is true, then the PowerPack 3
system will automatically attempt a
re-start after an over load event.
This number indicates the number of
re-start attempts after an overload
event.
If this is true, then the automatic
throttle increase request has been
enabled.
If this is true, then the automatic
throttle increase request has been
enabled.
This parameter allows the throttle to
ramp to the target RPM prior to
enabling the PPE. The logic for this
parameter is that a maximum load on
the PPE would turn off the inverter if
the alternator RPMs are not at target.
Default
Units
Min
Max
Step
On/Off
On/Off
On/Off
Number
40
Seconds
60
10
On/Off
Seconds
0.1
2344
935
RPM
900
2000
2345
Seconds
30
0.1
WIRING INFORMATION
WARNING: All electrical connections to the PowerPack 3 must be made by a qualified electrician. Failure to
follow this warning could result in property damage, personal injury, or death.
A Hubbell Watertight Safety-Shroud male plug (Hubbell part number HBL2611SW) is needed to connect to the
AC output plug to mate with the PowerPack supplied Hubbell Watertight Safety-Shroud female socket (Hubbell
part number HBL2613SW). These plugs are available at electrical and industrial supply houses.
Using this part combination will allow for a weather resistant connection to the PowerPack 3 unit. Alteration of
the AC output plug, failure to use the correct male plug, or removal of the supplied socket will not guarantee a
watertight connection.
October 2012
SECTION 28 - PAGE 21
f_176
f_189
POWERPACK 3 TROUBLESHOOTING
If the PowerPack 3 output does not power up or shuts down during vehicle operation, follow these steps to
troubleshoot the system:
1. Set the 120VAC ON/OFF switch to OFF position, and ensure interlocks are satisfied, as described above,
correcting as necessary.
2. Attempt to restart the PowerPack 3 by pressing the ON switch.
SECTION 28 - PAGE 22
October 2012
FMI
Byte 7
Byte 8
Switch Indicator
Blink Rate
168
Fast
168
Fast
168
Slow
168
Fast
168
Slow
168
Slow
168
Fast
168
16
Fast
168
16
Slow
168
17
Fast
639
14
37
255
Fast
October 2012
SECTION 28 - PAGE 23
FMI
Byte 7
Byte 8
Switch Indicator
Blink Rate
0467
Fast
168
Fast
520664
Slow
168
Fast
520644
Slow
520771
Slow
115
Fast
520774
Fast
520773
Slow
520772
31
Fast
639
37
255
Fast
NOTE: A complete aftermarket parts kit is under development. The PowerPack 3 kit part number is not
available at this time.
SECTION 28 - PAGE 24
October 2012
f_172
October 2012
SECTION 28 - PAGE 25
ALTERNATOR HARNESS
The harness from the PowerPack 3 to the alternator must be properly routed and securely fastened to avoid
any hot or sharp areas and to prevent cable movement. Failure to use the proper size wire can result in
overheating conditions that could cause fire, personal injury, and void of warranty.
h. Add Ignition (IGN) lead to the in-cab fuse relay panel.
1. Connect an 18 gauge wire from the PowerPack 3 IGN feed connector to the dash pass thru
connector 1702 pin 5.
2. Connect an 18 gauge wire from the dash pass thru connector 1702 pin 5 to an IGN feed in the cab
fuse/relay panel cavity G2-H2 (see fuse box detail).
3. Add 10 AMP fuse to fuse locations G2-H2.
4. Connect to inverter overlay harness (connector 9740 at the center of valve cover). Strap lock the
connector to the main center chassis harness.
5. Remove terminating resistor from J1939 datalink back bone harness (connector 7801M located on
the top center of the engine valve cover). Connect the PP3 J1939 datalink harness (connector
7801M) to J1939 inverter (connector 7801N). Save J1939 terminator resistor assembly.
6. Strap harness to existing harnesses.
Keep clear of sharp edges or anything that can rub or damage wire insulation.
4. Connect harness wires to the alternator.
a. Attach 3-Phase AC output ring terminal wires to bolt studs on the back of alternator. 80-120 in lb
(inch-pounds, NOT foot-pounds) Three phase wire attachment order to the alternator does not matter.
b. Attach field coil wires to the top of alternator using two nuts 15-20 in lb (inch- pounds, NOT
foot-pounds).
SECTION 28 - PAGE 26
October 2012
f_178
October 2012
SECTION 28 - PAGE 27
f_179
Fuse Wiring
Route the AC power wiring separately from the DC wiring and low voltage wiring such as audio and video
signal wires with as much physical separation from the AC wires as possible.
WARNING: Fire Hazard. Make sure all connections are tight and properly made. Failure to follow this warning
may result in property damage, personal injury or death.
CAUTION: An in-line 150 AMP DC fuse is REQUIRED on the positive battery cable to properly protect the
PowerPack 3 and batteries. Failure to properly fuse the input leads to the PowerPack 3 can result in damage to
the unit.
10. Add switch to switch pack.
f_031
Insert the extraction tools (2) into the two holes on either side of a switch pack housing until the locking tabs are
fully depressed. The switch pack can then be removed from the panel and the extraction tools removed.
f_096
SECTION 28 - PAGE 28
October 2012
f_092
To install a switch in the switch pack housing, insert the switch in the proper slot, and push in until the switch
locking tabs are fully engaged (switches are keyed and cannot be installed upside down).
LED INSTALLATION
The LEDs are installed from the rear of the switch housing (snap fit rear cover must first be removed). The
amber backlight LED (part number 3533928C1) must be installed in the lower position and the green indicator
LED (part number 3578733C1) in the upper position. The LEDs can be identified by the color of the base
black for the amber LED and white for the green LED.
To install an LED, insert it into the hole in the printed wiring board and, with a small flat blade screwdriver, turn
the LED clockwise until locked. Replace the rear cover when complete.
11. Program Vehicle.
a. Using DLB, activate feature 0595AJU BC PROG, INVERTER ON In-Cab Multiplex Switch enables 3kw
Inverter.
b. After 0595AJU is activated, use DLB to locate position for 120 volt on switch location. Make note of
location for switch install. Exit DLB.
12. Checking system operation
a. Start engine, and ensure that the park brake is set.
b. Verify that the batteries are being charged. Voltmeter should be reading greater than 13.5 volts.
c. Verify green light in rocker switch is ON solid within 5 seconds.
d. Check 120 volt AC output voltage.
October 2012
SECTION 28 - PAGE 29
SECTION 28 - PAGE 30
October 2012
THEFT DETERRENT
THEFT DETERRENT
THEFT DETERRENT
60ACX
BODY INTG, THEFT DETERRENT SYS Includes one (1) Switch Pack of Six Switches
The International Theft Deterrent system provides a means to help control the mobility of a vehicle. Once the
vehicle has been started, the driver is required to enter a pre-programmed code (theft deterrent code). The theft
deterrent code must also be entered when driving is resumed after the vehicle is at idle with the park brake set.
The theft deterrent feature is effective in preventing a vehicle from being driven by unauthorized individuals.
f_181
The red ENGINE STOP indicator portion of the ENGINE STOP/CLEAR ENTRY switch flashes to alert the
driver that the theft deterrent code must be entered (within the preprogrammed time delay or the engine will
shut down). The momentary CLEAR ENTRY position is pressed whenever the driver needs to clear a failed
code so that the correct code can be re-entered.
NOTE: If the operator enters the wrong security code, the vehicle must be stopped and the park brake must be
set/engaged before the system will clear the previous theft deterrent code entry.
PROGRAMMABLE PARAMETERS
Anti_Theft_Active_Min: Length of time the engine is shut down
Anti_Theft_Code_Length: Number of digits in the theft deterrent code
Anti_Theft_Code_Master_Lo: Lower 4 digits of the numerical theft deterrent code to be entered by the driver
Anti_Theft_Code_Master_Hi: Upper 4 digits of the numerical theft deterrent code to be entered by the driver
Anti_Theft_Enable: Parameter to enable or disable the theft deterrent feature
October 2012
SECTION 29 - PAGE 1
THEFT DETERRENT
Anti_Theft_Warning_Time: The amount of time after the park brake has been released or the vehicle starts
moving until the vehicle enters shutdown mode
Table 179
Parameter
Anti_Theft_
Active_Min
Anti_Theft_
Code_Length
Anti_Theft_
Code_Master_
Lo
Anti_Theft_
Code_Master_
Hi
Anti_Theft_
Enable
Anti_Theft_
Warning_Time
ID
Description
2227
2257
2224
2226
2222
2245
Default
Units
Min
Max
Step
10
Seconds
10
60
Number
2345
Number
9999
0001
Number
9999
On/Off
Seconds
655
WIRING INFORMATION
2588809C93 KIT, THEFT DETERRENT
Table 180
Item
Part Number
Quantity
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
2588808C91
3519350C1
239481R1
3544921C1
3515517C1
3535930C1
3535937C1
997129R2
2588813R2
3522073C1
001
001
002
004
004
001
001
AR
001
001
Description
MODULE, THEFT DETERRENT SWITCH
RELAY, MICRO SPDT
TERMINAL, CABLE
SLEEVE, CABLE INSULATING* HEAT S
TERMINAL, CABLE 280 M/P FEMALE
TERMINAL, CABLE* GT 280 SERIES 5
SEAL, CABLE TERMINAL* GT 280 SER
CABLE, LIGHTING, 18 GAUGE W/GXL
MANUAL, INST THEFT DETER KIT
TERMINAL, CABLE FEMALE
TESTING
Engine Start/Theft Deterrent Code Entry Sequence:
The correct engine start and theft deterrent code entry sequence is as follows:
1. Driver starts vehicle with park brake set.
2. The driver enters the code programmed by the dealer by pressing the switch positions for that code (read
from left to right). For example, if the code is 54321, the driver should press switch positions 5 4 3 2 1 in
that order.
If an error is made while entering the code, the driver presses the CLEAR ENTRY position of ENGINE
STOP/CLEAR ENTRY switch and enters the correct code. The park brake must be set for clearing the incorrect
code.
3. When the correct code is entered, the gauge cluster alarm will sound one short beep and, at the same time,
the ENGINE STOP indicator will flash once. If the wrong code is entered, the gauge cluster will sound one
long beep and the ENGINE STOP indicator will be illuminated for approximately 1.5 seconds.
4. Park brake is released.
5. Vehicle may be driven without interruption.
SECTION 29 - PAGE 2
October 2012
THEFT DETERRENT
NOTE: The theft deterrent code must be re-entered every time the park brake is set/engaged or when the key
switch is cycled from the run position.
Table 181 System Response Table
Driver Action
Engine started with park
brake set
Correct theft deterrent
code entered (vehicle
stopped and park brake
set)
System Alerts
No system alerts
NOTE: There is a ten second period between the beginning of the warning sequence and engine shut down.
During this period, the vehicle can be started and moved. Once shutdown occurs, the sequence can be
re-initiated after a programmable time delay (default = 10 seconds).
October 2012
SECTION 29 - PAGE 3
THEFT DETERRENT
The theft deterrent code must be entered AFTER the engine is started and before the park brake is
released. After the engine is started, enter the correct theft deterrent code. The ENGINE STOP indicator in
the top portion of the first switch will illuminate for one fast blink with the correct code entered. If the wrong
code is entered, the ENGINE STOP light will be illuminated for 1.5 seconds, hence the system will still be
armed to shut down until the correct code is entered.
3. Theft deterrent code never works:
The theft deterrent code has been designed to be as flexible as possible and still work with the overall
design of the Body Controller (BC) in the vehicle. It is important that programmable parameters are set
correctly. The theft deterrent code is controlled by three programmable parameters. They are as follows:
Anti_Theft_Code_Length Number of digits in theft deterrent code
Anti_Theft_Code_Master_Hi Upper portion of theft deterrent code
Anti_Theft_Code_Master_Lo Lower portion of theft deterrent code
The theft deterrent code may be any length from one to eight digits. The Anti_Theft_Code_Length
programmable parameter must contain the length of the desired code. For example, if the theft deterrent
code is 739042, then the code length should have a 6 entered for the Anti_Theft_Code_Length parameter.
Use DLB to enter the code length under the FEATURES tab. Find the desired programmable parameter in
the list on the bottom half of the screen.
The theft deterrent code must be entered in two different parameters.
The Anti_Theft_Code_Master_Lo is the right most 4 digits of the code.
The Anti_Theft_Code_Master_Hi is the left or upper digits of the theft deterrent code.
For example, if the theft deterrent code is 739042, enter the following digits into the two parameters:
Anti_Theft_Code_Master_Hi: 73
Anti_Theft_Code_Master_Lo: 9042
For theft deterrent codes that are four digits or less, place a 0 in the parameter
Anti-Theft_Code_Master_Hi. It is not necessary to enter a leading zero in the code as long as the code
length is four digits or less.
4. Can leading zeros be entered in the theft deterrent code?
Leading zeroes may be used in either parameter as long as the Anti_Theft_Code_Length count is large
enough to include them in the count.
For example, if the theft deterrent code is 0142, the programmable parameters should be entered as
follows:
Anti_Theft_Code_Length: 4
Anti_Theft_Code_Master_Hi: 0
Anti_Theft_Code_Master_Lo: 0142
On early versions, the leading zero will not stay visible in the parameter entry, but the 0 still needs to be
entered on the switch packs when entering the theft deterrent code.
For example, if the theft deterrent code is 075142, the programmable parameters should be entered as
follows:
Anti_Theft_Code_Length: 6
Anti_Theft_Code_Master_Hi: 07
Anti_Theft_Code_Master_Lo: 5142
For example, if the theft deterrent code is 60925, the programmable parameters should be entered as
follows:
Anti_Theft_Code_Length: 5
Anti_Theft_Code_Master_Hi: 6
Anti_Theft_Code_Master_Lo: 0925
SECTION 29 - PAGE 4
October 2012
THEFT DETERRENT
5. Once the engine shut down sequence is initiated, the engine stumbles but does not shut down. The theft
deterrent relay keeps cycling off and on.
The Ignition (IGN) interrupter relay that was added for this system must have the coil powered from an
un-switched battery source. This stumbling condition is caused by the relay being powered from an IGN
source instead of a battery source. Ensure an un-switched battery feed powers the coil of the theft
deterrent relay.
6. Engine will not shut down even though the ENGINE STOP light is on for a constant ten seconds.
Ensure that the theft deterrent relay coil is connected to the BC connector 1601 pin # for pre 2007 engine
vehicles or BC connector 1601 Pin E4 for post 2007 engine vehicles. If the relay is not being energized, the
vehicle engine will still be de-powered through an alternate means, thus rendering the vehicle immobile. If
the shut down sequence has been initiated and the ENGINE STOP light is illuminated for ten seconds, then
the theft deterrent relay should also be energized to kill the engine.
October 2012
SECTION 29 - PAGE 5
THEFT DETERRENT
f_182
SECTION 29 - PAGE 6
October 2012
October 2012
SECTION 30 - PAGE 1
595BBL
HEV_Electric_Motor_Demand_Circuit_1_Input = Aerial_Boom_Request_Signal_Input
HEV_Electric_Motor_Demand_Circuit_2_Input = Boom_Tool_Circuit_Signal_Input
HEV_Electric_Motor_Demand_Circuit_3_Input = Lower_Ground_Tool_Circuit_Signal_Input
HEV_Electric_Motor_Demand_Circuit_4_Input = Outrigger_Motion_Switch_Signal_Input
Please use the Diamond Logic software to determine pin locations for RPM inputs (refer to the CONNECTOR
screen view) and to set programmable parameters (refer to the FEATURE screen view).
SECTION 30 - PAGE 2
October 2012
The HEV_Electric_Motor_Demand_Cir_1_Motor_On_Time parameter sets the amount of time that the hybrid
electric motor will be on after demand circuit #1 becomes inactive. After this time, the motor will turn off until
demand is requested active again.
The HEV_Electric_Motor_Demand_Cir_2_Motor_On_Time parameter sets the amount of time that the hybrid
electric motor will be on after demand circuit #2 becomes inactive. After this time, the motor will turn off until
demand is requested active again
The HEV_Electric_Motor_Demand_Cir_3_Motor_On_Time parameter sets the amount of time that the hybrid
electric motor will be on after demand circuit #1 becomes inactive. After this time, the motor will turn off until
demand is requested active again
October 2012
SECTION 30 - PAGE 3
The HEV_Electric_Motor_Demand_Cir_4_Motor_On_Time parameter sets the amount of time that the hybrid
electric motor will be on after demand circuit #1 becomes inactive. After this time, the motor will turn off until
demand is requested active again
Table 182
Parameter
ID
Min
Max
1 (List)
HEV_Electric_
Motor_Demand
_Cir_1_Enabled
2391
HEV_Electric_
Motor_Demand
_Cir_1_Motor_
On_Time
2495
0s
600
HEV_Electric_
Motor_Demand
_Cir_2_Enabled
2396
1 (List)
HEV_Electric_
Motor_Demand
_Cir_2_Motor_
On_Time
2390
30s
600
HEV_Electric_
Motor_Demand
_Cir_3_Enabled
2400
1 (List)
HEV_Electric_
Motor_Demand
_Cir_3_Motor_
On_Time
2304
60s
600
HEV_Electric_
Motor_Demand
_Cir_4_Enabled
2425
1 (List)
HEV_Electric_
Motor_Demand
_Cir_4_Motor_
On_Time
2270
120s
600
SECTION 30 - PAGE 4
October 2012
Step
The Aerial_Boom_Request_Signal_Active_State parameter sets the logical active state at the aerial boom
demand input that will cause the initiation of the hybrid electric traction motor.
2 = disabled
0 = enabled active floating
3 = input active high
1 = input active low
The Aerial_Boom_Circuit_Demand_Timeout parameter sets the amount of time that the hybrid electric traction
motor will continue to run following the operation of the aerial boom.
The Emergency_Pump_Maximum_Run_Time parameter sets the amount of time that the emergency pump will
be requested ON once the emergency pump request switch has been initiated and maintained its active state.
The Outrigger_Traction_Motor_Operation_Timeout parameter sets the amount of time that the hybrid electric
motor will continue to run following the operation of the chassis mounted equipments outriggers.
October 2012
SECTION 30 - PAGE 5
The Lower_Ground_Tool_Circuit_Demand_Timeout parameter sets the amount of time that the hybrid electric
traction motor will continue to run following the operation of any specific lower tool function where the demand
is no longer generating back pressure (demand) within the hydraulic system.
The Lower_Ground_Tool_Circuit_Switch_Action parameter is the type of switch device used to operate the
lower tools.
0 = disabled
1 = latching
2 = momentary
The Boom_Tool_Request_Signal_Active_State parameter is the logical active state at the boom tool circuit
demand input that will cause the initiation of the hybrid electric traction motor.
2 = disabled
0 = enabled active floating
3 = enabled active high
1 = enabled active low
The Boom_Tool_Circuit_Demand_Timeout parameter sets the amount of time that the hybrid electric traction
motor will continue to run following the operation of any specific upper bucket tool function where the demand is
no longer generating back pressure (demand) within the hydraulic system.
The Boom_Tool_Continuous_Run_Parameter enables a continuous run cycle where the hybrid electric traction
motor will continue to run as long as the boom tool switch request logic is active.
SECTION 30 - PAGE 6
October 2012
The Outriggers_Not_Stowed_Parameter specifies the logical active state at the outrigger motion switch
device/s that will cause the initiation of the hybrid electric traction motor.
2 = disabled
0 = enabled active floating
3 = enabled active high
1 = enabled active low
The Emergency_Pump_Request_Signal_Active_State specifies the logical active state at the emergency pump
input that will cause the initiation of the emergency pump.
2 = disabled
0 = enabled active floating
3 = enabled active high
1 = enabled active low
The Key_ON_Biased_RPM_Output_Delay parameter is used to delay the activation of the Key_ON biased
RPM output during the initialization of the HCM and subsequent systems.
The Emergency_Pump_Power_Output_Current_Limit parameter is the emergency pump output (RPM) fuse
value.
The Key_ON_Biased_RPM_Output_Current_Limit parameter is the key state biased power output (RPM) fuse
value.
October 2012
SECTION 30 - PAGE 7
Parameter
Aerial_Boom_
Request_Signal_
Active_State
Aerial_Boom_
Circuit_Demand_
Timeout
Emergency_Pump_
Interlocked_To_
ePTO_Request_
Parameter
Emergency_Pump_
Maximum_Run_
Timer_Enable
Emergency_Pump_
Maximum_Run_
Time
ID
2587
2589
2590
2591
2592
Outrigger_Motion_
Switch_Request_
Signal_Active_State
2618
Outrigger_Traction_
Motor_Operation_
Timeout
2619
Prohibit_Driving_
Interlock_Parameter
2620
Lower_Ground_Tool
_Request_Signal_
Active_State
2621
Lower_Ground_Tool
_Circuit_Demand_
Timeout
Lower_Ground_Tool
_Circuit_Switch_
Action
2622
2623
Lower_Ground_Tool
_Continuous_Run_
Parameter
2524
Boom_Tool_
Request_Signal_
Active_ State
2625
Boom_Tool_Circuit_
Demand_Timeout
2626
SECTION 30 - PAGE 8
October 2012
Max
Step
3 (List)
7s
655
1s
30s
655
1s
3 (List)
7s
655
1 (List)
60s
655
2 (List)
3 (List)
30s
655
Off
Off
On
Off
ID
Boom_Tool_
Continuous_Run_
Parameter
2627
Boom_Not_Stowed
_Parameter
2647
Outriggers_Not_
Stowed_Parameter
2648
Emergency_Pump_
Request_Signal_
Active_State
2649
Key_ON_Biased_
RPM_Output_Delay
2727
Emergency_Pump_
Power_Output_
Current_Limit
Key_ON_Biased_
RPM_Output_
Current_Limit
Max
Step
Off
3 (List)
3 (List)
1 (List)
0s
655
2739
20A
20
0.1A
2740
20A
20
0.1A
October 2012
SECTION 30 - PAGE 9
Parameter
ID
SECTION 30 - PAGE 10
October 2012
Max
Step
120psi
90
150
10s
600
13.2V
20
0.1
300s
600
100psi
90
150
10s
600
12.1V
20
0.1
60s
600
ePTO
These parameters set various input/output conditions for operating ePTO.
The HEV_Body_Equipment_Power_Current_Limit parameter sets the fuse value for the HEV ePTO Body
Equipment Power output (on the RPM).
The HEV_ePTO_Engaged_State parameter indicates the active state of the Hybrid Electric Vehicle (HEV)
ePTO clutch engaged feedback signal into the RPM.
0 = disabled
1 = engaged when pulled low
3 = engaged when pulled high
Parameter
ID
HEV_PTO_Body_
Equipment_Power_
Current_Limit
2522
HEV_ePTO_
Disengagement_
Enabled
2533
HEV_ePTO_
Engaged_State
2523
HEV_Body_
Equipment_Power_
Interlock_Enabled
2494
Max
Step
20A
20
0.1
List
List
On
The KeyState_Debounce_Time parameter allows the debounce time to be specified for the
HEV_Prohibit_Driving signal.
October 2012
SECTION 30 - PAGE 11
Parameter
KeyState_
Debounce_Time
ID
2730
5000 ms
Max
Step
65
535
000
10 ms
DEMAND CIRCUITS
HOOD OPEN
The HEV_Hood_Open signal is an input reflecting the status of the Hood Open Switch (ON = open, OFF =
closed).
HYBRID FAULT
The HEV_Check_Hybrid_Input signal is an input from the Hybrid Control Module (HCM) to indicate a
non-critical fault in the hybrid system.
The HEV_Stop_Hybrid_Input signal is an input signal from the Hybrid Control Module (HCM) to indicate a
critical fault in the hybrid system.
SECTION 30 - PAGE 12
October 2012
The HEV_PTO_Disengagement_Input signal is a body builder provided hardware input3 signal connected to
RPM1 input 5, disabling the ePTO air solenoid (ON = disable ePTO, OFF = allow normal ePTO operation).
The Hybrid_PTO_Disengagement_DLB_Req signal is a written to data link semaphore1output signal disabling
the ePTO air solenoid (ON = disable ePTO, OFF = allow normal ePTO operation).
The HEV_ePTO_Engaged signal is a data link output from ESC to the HCM indicating that the ePTO is
engaged.
The HEV_ePTO_Requested signal is an input signal from the Hybrid Control Module (HCM) to the Body
Controller (BC) indicating that the operator has pressed the ePTO switch to engage (or disengage) the PTO.
This signal will be active as long as the PTO is requested to be engaged.
The HEV_PTO_Air_Solenoid_Cmd signal is a data link input signal from the HCM to the ESC indicating that
the in cab, shift console mounted ePTO button has been depressed and all interlocks are met.
AIR PRESSURE
The HEV_Filtered_Pressure signal can be used in DLB ladder Logic to get the filtered pressure value (psi).
The HEV_Pressure_Filter_Reset_Flag signal can be used in DLB ladder logic to reset the pressure filter.
The HEV_Unfiltered_Pressure signal can be used in DLB ladder logic to get the unfiltered pressure (psi).
Notes
1. Semaphores are messages sent to another module to request that the other module take action.
2. These signals may become unavailable in a future release of the software.
3. Please use the Diamond Logic software to determine pin locations for RPM inputs (refer to the
CONNECTOR screen view).
October 2012
SECTION 30 - PAGE 13
Part Number
2585651C91
2585423C91
NOTE: The following connectors are optional because they are already provided with the RPMs.
This information is given so that the Body Builder can purchase connectors in the event that the original
connectors are damaged or lost, or so that the Body Builder can pre-fabricate a wire harness.
Table 188 8-Way RPM Output Connector (Brown) and 23-Way RPM Input Connector (Black)
Connector Part No.
Description
Terminal Part
Cable Seal Part
Connector Lock Part
CPA Lock
Cavity Plug
SECTION 30 - PAGE 14
3548934C1
2585981C91
October 2012
1698937C1
N/A
N/A
N/A
Built into the connector
f_183
October 2012
SECTION 30 - PAGE 15
f_184
Body Builder Integration Points: This is where the connections are made to integrate the hybrid ePTO
application with the chassis. The following two figures illustrate the necessary connections.
SECTION 30 - PAGE 16
October 2012
October 2012
f_185
SECTION 30 - PAGE 17
f_186
Mounting positions for air solenoids are different based upon vehicle air accessory content. Locate the air
solenoid labeled Pwr Take Off for controlling the PTO mechanism.
SECTION 30 - PAGE 18
October 2012
DISABLE TEST
Start the diesel engine with transmission in neutral and the park brake set. Make sure the air pressure is
greater than 110 psi and battery voltage is greater than 13.3 volts.
Depress the ePTO button on the shifter.
Verify that the diesel engine shuts off.
Disengage the ePTO through the RPM input HEV_Remote_PTO_Disable.
Verify that the ePTO is disabled.
Once the HEV_Remote_PTO_Disable switch has been activated, the PTO mechanism cannot be
re-engaged until the HEV_Remote_PTO_Disable switch has been returned to its inactive state and the
ePTO request switch located in the Eaton shift console is recycled.
October 2012
SECTION 30 - PAGE 19
HYBRID FAULT
The HEV_Check_Hybrid_Input signal is an input from the Hybrid Control Module (HCM) to indicate a
non-critical fault in the hybrid system.
The HEV_Stop_Hybrid_Input signal is an input signal from the Hybrid Control Module (HCM) to indicate a
critical fault in the hybrid system.
SECTION 30 - PAGE 20
October 2012
f_187
If the Service Disconnect switch is pushed in, the Check Hybrid light should be flashing to indicate the
hybrid system is offline.
October 2012
f_188
SECTION 30 - PAGE 21
SECTION 30 - PAGE 22
October 2012
October 2012
SECTION 30 - PAGE 23
ID
Fuel_Econ_Filter_
Heavy_Weight
Fuel_Econ_Filter_
Lite_Weight
HEV_Fuel_Econ_
Filter_Param
2731
Fuel_Econ_Alrm_
Ty_Param
2723
HEV_Fuel_Econ_
MaxWL_Gen2
HEV_Fuel_Econ_
MinWL_Gen2
HEV_SOC_Filter_
Param
SOC_Alarm_Ty_
Param
HEV_SOC_MaxWL
_Gen2
HEV_SOC_MinWL_
Gen2
HEV_Torque_
Param
Torque_Alarm_Ty_
Param
HEV_Torque_
MaxWL_Gen2
HEV_Torque_
MinWL_Gen2
2733
2581
2585
2584
2580
2724
2582
2583
2577
2725
2579
2578
Description
Weight value for Inst. Fuel Econ
heavy filter
Weight low value for Inst. Fuel
Econ light filter
Gauge filter parameter
The type of alarm that will occur
when the needle reaches a
warning area on the gauge
Gauge warning light threshold
parameter
Gauge warning light threshold
parameter
Gauge filter parameter
The type of alarm that will occur
when the needle reaches a
warning area on the gauge
Gauge warning light threshold
parameter
Gauge warning light threshold
parameter
Gauge filter parameter
The type of alarm that will occur
when the needle reaches a
warning area on the gauge
Gauge warning light threshold
parameter
Gauge warning light threshold
parameter
Default
Units
Min
Max
Step
10
No_ Units
32768
32
No_ Units
32768
20
No_Units
255
No alarm
List
254
No_Units
65535
No_Units
65535
10
No_Units
255
No alarm
List
254
No_Units
65535
No_Units
65535
255
No_Units
255
No alarm
List
254
No_Units
65535
No_Units
65535
WIRING INFORMATION
The Hybrid Display Module Kit is listed below. The wiring for this kit is the same as the wiring requirements for
the Auxiliary Gauge and Switch Pack (AGSP) as found in the circuit diagrams under Cab Accessories Switch
Pack Optional Gauge Pack, p. 15.
Table 190
Kit
Part Number
2604309C91
SECTION 30 - PAGE 24
October 2012
October 2012
SECTION 30 - PAGE 25
SECTION 30 - PAGE 26
October 2012
October 2012
SECTION 31 - PAGE 1
ID
177
178
179
182
1895
1896
1897
2213
Description
Default
Units
Min
Max
Step
No_ Units
NA
NA
NA
Percent
10
80
Percent
10
100
20
655
10
0.1
10
10
0.1
10
0.1
10
min
120
SECTION 31 - PAGE 2
October 2012
October 2012
SECTION 31 - PAGE 3
SECTION 31 - PAGE 4
October 2012
CROSS REFERENCE
CROSS REFERENCE
This section has been added to assist you in cross referencing software feature codes from pre2007 and post2007
model years. It is presented in two ways, the first is sorted by the pre2007 software feature code and the second is
sorted on the post2007 feature code.
Table 195 595 Feature Codes Sorted by Pre-2007 Feature Code Number
ESC 595 Code
514011
595006
595007
595008
595009
595010
595011
595012
595013
595014
595015
595016
595017
595018
595019
2007 BC
PRE 2007 Feature Description
595 Code
***All denotes 2000, DuraStar, WorkStar, 8000, Bus and Prostar Models***
595ANL
None
595AEP
595ABB
595ABV
None
595ACB
595ABW
None
595AAZ
595AAD
595AGC
595ANE
595ALB
595AMS
595AMT
595ACE
595020
None
595021
595022
595023
595024
595AAL
595ALD
595AAV
595AKY
595025
None
595026
None
595027
None
595028
None
595029
None
595030
595031
595032
595033
595034
595ABC
595AAC
595AHE
595ACY
595AHA
595035
None
595036
None
595037
595038
595039
595040
595041
595ADP
595AYP
595ALN
595ACU
595ACZ
595042
None
595043
October 2012
32 - PAGE 1
CROSS REFERENCE
ESC 595 Code
2007 BC
PRE 2007 Feature Description
595 Code
***All denotes 2000, DuraStar, WorkStar, 8000, Bus and Prostar Models***
595044
595045
None
595046
None
595047
595048
595ALE
595AYD
595049
None
595050
None
595051
595052
595ACW
595ABD
595054
None
595057
595058
595059
595060
595061
595063
595064
595065
595066
595067
None
None
None
595ADZ
595ABP
595ABA
None
None
595ABL
595ABK
595068
None
595069
595ABN
595070
None
595071
None
595072
595073
595074
595075
None
None
None
595ANP
595076
None
595077
None
595078
None
595079
None
595080
None
595081
None
595082
None
595083
595AAP
595084
None
595085
None
595086
595087
595AYA
595AYB
595088
None
595089
None
32 - PAGE 2
October 2012
CROSS REFERENCE
ESC 595 Code
2007 BC
PRE 2007 Feature Description
595 Code
***All denotes 2000, DuraStar, WorkStar, 8000, Bus and Prostar Models***
595090
None
595091
595092
595093
595ANG
595ALX
595AYK
595094
None
595095
None
595096
None
595097
595ADX
595098
None
595100
595101
595AMV
595AMW
595AYY
595ADK
None
595102
None
595103
None
595104
None
595105
595106
595107
595108
595109
595110
595111
595112
595113
595114
595115
595116
595AYS
595AAK
595ABY
595AEJ
None
595ANN
595ANB
595ADR
595AEL
595AET
595AEV
595AEU
595117
None
595118
595119
595120
595121
595122
595ALV
595AHB
595AHC
595AHD
595AHG
595123
None
595124
None
595125
595126
595127
595128
595129
595130
595131
595132
595133
595134
595135
595136
595137
595ALK
595ABH
595ABJ
None
595ABZ
595ABG
None
None
None
None
None
None
595AHW
595099
October 2012
32 - PAGE 3
CROSS REFERENCE
ESC 595 Code
2007 BC
PRE 2007 Feature Description
595 Code
***All denotes 2000, DuraStar, WorkStar, 8000, Bus and Prostar Models***
595138
595139
595140
595141
595142
595143
None
None
None
None
None
595ADN
595144
None
595145
595146
595AEW
595AEZ
595147
None
595148
595149
595150
595151
None
None
595ANP
595AMY
595152
None
595153
595AAW
595154
None
595157
595158
595159
595160
595161
595ALY
595AHL
595ALZ
595AHK
595AHT
595162
595ALW
595163
595ADV
595164
595AEK
595166
595167
595168
595ALC
595ANM
595AJE
595169
None
595170
595171
595172
595173
595174
595175
595176
595AJT
595AJV
595AKJ
595AJK
595AJL
595AJM
None
595177
None
595178
595179
595180
595AKA
595AJZ
595ALR
595181
595AKB
595182
595AKC
595183
595184
595185
595AJN
595AHJ
595AAX
595186
595ALS
595187
None
595188
595AAH
32 - PAGE 4
October 2012
CROSS REFERENCE
ESC 595 Code
2007 BC
PRE 2007 Feature Description
595 Code
***All denotes 2000, DuraStar, WorkStar, 8000, Bus and Prostar Models***
595189
595190
595192
595193
595194
595195
595AJP
595AJR
595ABE
595AJW
None
None
595196
595AKM
595197
595198
595AMD
595AKP
595199
None
595200
595AKD
595201
595202
595AKR
595AKS
595203
595AHU
595204
None
595206
595207
595208
595209
595210
595212
595213
595214
595AHM
None
595AER
None
595AGB
595AEX
595AGL
595AGP
595215
595AGR
595218
595219
595220
595221
595222
595223
595224
595225
595227
595228
595AGS
595AMN
None
595AHN
None
595AKX
595ALU
595AGT
595AYT
595AEV
595229
None
595230
595231
595232
595AMA
595AZX
595AAA
595233
None
595234
None
595235
None
595238
595AKE
595239
595AKG
595240
595AKL
595241
595AKK
(TEM) ESC PROG, AUXILIARY LOAD (5) With single latched switch
(TEM) ESC PROG, AUXILIARY LOAD (6)With single latched switch
ESC PROG, DUAL FUEL TANKS W/RELAY DRIVEN PUMP
(TEM) ESC PROG, PTO SHIFT for Hydraulic Clutch engagement mechanism
(TEM) ESC PROG, INTERLOCKED AUX LOAD #3 With single latched switch
(TEM) ESC PROG, INTERLOCKED AUX LOAD #4 With single latched switch
(TEM) ESC PROG, EXTERNAL ENGINE SPEED CONTROL for combined Emergency
Power Output and Utility Application
(TEM) ESC PROG, WARNING LIGHT TAILGATE Open for TCM
(TEM) ESC PROG, IN-CAB ALARM externally controlled
Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
(TEM) ESC PROG, PTO DISENGAGE (kill switch with external switch accommodation)
(TEM) ESC PROG, DUALLY CONTROLLED AUX LOAD (1) with internal switches and
external switch accommodations
(TEM) ESC PROG, AERIAL BOOM WARNING Light and Buzzer
(TEM) ESC PROG, OUTRIGGER WARNING Light and Buzzer
(TEM) ESC PROG, ELECTRIC TRAILER BRAKE Accommodation and ESC Input and
Light Control
Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
(TEM) ESC PROG, SPECIAL ENGINE AUTO RAMPING WITH PTO ENGAGED
ESC PROG, VANDAL LOCK WARNING
ESC PROG, PTO SWITCH CRUISE ENABLE, engine speed control feature
ESC PROG, ENGINE SPEED GAUGE 4000 RPM
(BUS) ESC PROG, HARDWIRE CONFIG DATA - PT
(BUS) ESC PROG, EMERGENCY EXIT BUZZER
(BUS) ESC PROG, CROSSING GATE DISABLE Switch
(BUS) ESC PROG, POST TRIP INSPECTION
(BUS) ESC PROG, PUPIL WARNING LIGHTS, Steering Wheel Mounted (Sequential)
(BUS) ESC PROG, PUPIL WARNING LIGHTS, Steering Wheel Mounted
(Non-Sequential)
(BUS) ESC PROG, PUPIL WARNING LIGHTS, Panel Mounted Switch, (Non-Sequential)
(BUS) ESC PROG, RED PUPIL WARNING LIGHT OVERRIDE Switch
Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
(BUS) ESC PROG, WHEELCHAIR LIFT INTERLOCK With Indicator Light in Cluster
Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
(BUS) ESC PROG, CRUISE/THROTTLE Switches in the 6 Switch Pack
(BUS) ESC PROG, FOG LIGHTS Bus Only
(BUS) ESC PROG, PUPIL WARNING LIGHTS, Panel Mounted Switch, (Sequential)
(BUS) ESC PROG, IP CONFIGURATION DATA PT
(BUS) T/R DATA PROG, PRNDL W/LCT 5-SPD W/PWR PK
Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
(BUS) ESC PROG, COMBINATION STOP TURN SIGNAL/BRAKE
(BUS) ESC PROG, HAZARD LIGHTS ON With Pupil Warning Lights
(BUS) ESC PROG, TEM ENABLERS
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM CONTROLLER, HITACHI ESC2
Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
ESC PROG, WATER IN FUEL LIGHT, ESC2
Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
ESC PROG, BATTERY FEED FUSE DETECTION, ESC2
Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
ESC PROG, HYDRAULIC BRAKE SPLIT Hydro-Max, ESC2
(TEM) ESC PROG, DUALLY CONTROLLED AUX LOAD (2) with internal switches and
external switch accommodations
(TEM) ESC PROG, DUALLY CONTROLLED AUX LOAD (3) with internal switches and
external switch accommodations
(TEM) ESC PROG, EXTERNAL ENGINE SPEED CONTROL For Utility Application
(TEM) ESC PROG, EXTERNAL ENGINE SPEED CONTROL for Utility application for
on-Demand Engine Speed
October 2012
32 - PAGE 5
CROSS REFERENCE
ESC 595 Code
2007 BC
PRE 2007 Feature Description
595 Code
***All denotes 2000, DuraStar, WorkStar, 8000, Bus and Prostar Models***
595242
None
595243
595244
None
595AJY
595245
595AKW
595246
595AKV
595247
None
595248
595250
595AJU
595AMP
595AMR
595ABR
595251
595AZZ
595252
595253
595254
595255
595AJX
595AYC
595ADW
595AMC
595256
None
595259
595260
595261
595262
595AHX
595AHY
595AHZ
595AJA
595263
595AKN
595265
595266
595AJH
595AYN
595267
595AMZ
595269
595ALA
595270
595AGU
595271
595272
595273
595AGE
595AGG
595ACA
595274
595AHH
595275
595276
595277
595ALG
595AEY
595AJS
595278
595AME
595279
595AMG
595280
None
595281
None
595282
595AJG
595283
595AKH
595284
595ALJ
595285
595ALH
595249
32 - PAGE 6
October 2012
CROSS REFERENCE
ESC 595 Code
2007 BC
PRE 2007 Feature Description
595 Code
***All denotes 2000, DuraStar, WorkStar, 8000, Bus and Prostar Models***
595286
595AGV
595287
595288
595289
595291
595292
595293
595295
595296
595297
595AYL
595AJD
None
595AGK
595AMB
595AGN 595AYM
595AGM
595AZY
595AKZ
595298
595AJJ
595299
595300
595301
595AKT
595AJC
595AKU
595302
None
595303
None
595304
None
595306
595307
595308
595AEH
595AGH
595AGJ
595309
None
595310
None
595311
None
595312
595AGW
595313
595AGX
595314
595315
595316
595317
595AAH
595AGA
595ANK
595AEL
595318
595AGY
595319
595AGZ
595320
None
595321
595322
595323
595324
595AYY
595AMX
595AHP
595AMH
595325
595AMJ
595326
595AHR
595327
595328
595AHS
595AZV
595329
None
595330
595331
595AMM
595AND
(BUS) ESC PROG, PUPIL WARNING LIGHTS Panel Mounted Switch, (Non-Sequential),
Manual Activated Stop Arm and Crossing Gate With Alarm
(BUS) PROG, THROTTLE Without Cruise Control, in the Switch Packs
ESC PROG, WIPERS W/SPEED OVERRIDE for ESC2
ESC PROG, WIPERS W/SPEED OVERRIDE FOR ESC1
ESC PROG, FUEL FILTER PLUGGED W/LIGHT/I6 ENG
(BUS) ESC PROG, SEPARATE STOP TURN SIGNAL/BRAKE
ESC PROG, LIFT GATE WIRING PACKGE
ESC PROG, WATER IN FUEL LIGHT With J1939, for 2004 International I6 Engines
ESC PROG, PRE-TRIP, ALL EXTERIOR LAMPS
(TEM) ESC PROG, UNIVERSAL AIR SOLENOID using normally open solenoids (qty 5)
(TEM) ESC PROG, IP CLUSTER DISPLAY Omit Display of Fault Codes in Instrument
Cluster, Requires Service Tool to Retrieve and View Fault Codes
(TEM) ESC PROG, WARN TAILGATE OPEN Dump Box Application
(TEM) ESC PROG, UNIVERSAL AIR SOLENOID using normally open solenoids (qty 6)
(TEM) ESC PROG, WARN DUMP BODY UP Application
Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
(BUS) ESC PROG, BUS FMVSS VALIDATION
Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
(BUS) ESC PROG, BUS ABS FMVSS VALIDATION
Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
(BUS) ESC PROG, BUS PWL FMVSS VALIDATION
(BUS) ESC PROG, EXTERIOR LIGHT CHECK with Rocker Switch Activation
(BUS) ESC PROG, Redundant Door Controls
(BUS) ESC PROG, Manual Door
Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
ESC PROG, AXLE, LIFT, CONTROLS for Automated and Manual Controls
Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM CONTROLLER, NVM, FOR BUS
Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
ELECCTRICAL SYSTEM CONTROLLER, NVM, FOR TRUCK
(BUS) ESC PROG, PUPIL WARNING Steering Wheel Mounted (SEQUENTIAL
WHERE DOOR CLOSED EXTINGUISHES RED PWL MODE)
(BUS) ESC PROG, PUPIL WARNING SEQUENTIAL FLASHERS VARIATION WITH A
THREE POSITION ROTARY DOOR SWITCH
ESC PROG, HEADLIGHTS ON W/WIPERS
(BUS) ESC PROG, Red Always Hot Override With Exit Buzzer
ESC PROG, VORAD ENGINE DISPLAY
(BUS) T/R DATA , PRNDL W/LCT 5-SPD With Park Pawl & Shifter Interlock
(BUS) ESC PROG, PUPIL WARNING LIGHTS Steering Wheel Mounted Switch,
(Sequential) With Illinois Master Switch (SEQUENTIAL)
(BUS) ESC PROG, PUPIL WARNING LIGHTS Steering Wheel Mounted Switch, With
Illinois Master Switch (SEQUENTIAL WHERE DOOR CLOSED EXTINGUISHES RED
PWL MODE)
Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
(BUS) ESC PROG, HARDWARE CONFIG DATA PT with Extra Advanced Logic Outputs
ESC PROG, PLOW LIGHTS compatible w/ Fog Lights
(BUS) ESC PROG, IDLE SYSTEM, ENGINE RAMP With Low Battery
(BUS) ESC PROG, WHEELCHAIR LIFT INTERLOCK W/XMSN IN PARK ONLY
(BUS) T/R DATA, PRNDL W/LCT 5-SPD W/PWR PK W/LIFT DOOR SWITCH
(BUS) T/R DATA, PRNDL W/LCT 5-SPD With Park Pawl and Shifter Interlock With Lift
Door Switch
(BUS) ESC PROG, WHEELCHAIR LIFT INTERLOCK W/XMSN IN PARK ONLY W/O
INDICATOR
(BUS) ESC PROG, WHEELCHAIR LIFT INTERLOCK W/O INDICATOR
ESC PROG, PARK BRAKE ALARM
Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
ESC PROG, IDLE WARNING SHUTDOWN IND LIGHT
ESC PROG, TRANSMISSION WARN IND for LCT AND WTEC
ESC PROG, ECONOMY MODE LIGHT
October 2012
32 - PAGE 7
CROSS REFERENCE
ESC 595 Code
2007 BC
PRE 2007 Feature Description
595 Code
***All denotes 2000, DuraStar, WorkStar, 8000, Bus and Prostar Models***
595332
595ANC
595333
595334
595AZU
595AYU
595335
None
595336
595ADL
595337
595AZS
595338
595339
595AZM
595ANA
595341
None
595342
None
595343
595AZN
595344
595ANY
595345
595AZR
595346
595AZW
595347
None
595348
595AYV
595349
None
595350
None
595351
595AZJ
595352
None
595353
None
595354
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
595ADA
595ADB
595ADC
595ADD
595ADG
595ADH
595ADS
595ADT
595ADU
595AEA
595AEB
595AEC
None
595AED
None
595AEE
32 - PAGE 8
ESC PROG, RANGE INHIBITED WARN Light, for LCT and WTEC XMSNs, Allison Gen 4
XMSNs
ESC PROG, INVERTER ON In Cab Multiplex Switch enables 3kw Inverter
ESC PROG, THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
ESC PROG, AUXILLIARY IGNITION, 1 AMP
ESC PROG, REFRIDGERANT CONTROL, HVAC W/LIGHT IN LOWER CLUSTER
(BUS) ESC PROG, DLB PWL AND TURN SIGNAL GATEWAYS, w/engineering
read/write access
(BUS) ESC PROG, POST TRIP INSPECTION With Snooze
ESC PROG, ENGINE RAMP With A/C on, BUS
Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
(TEM) ESC PROG, EXTERNAL ENGINE SPEED CONTROL for UTILITY application for
on-demand engine speed
Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
(TEM) ESC PROG, SPECIAL AERIAL PKG, for Aerial Device position and warning
system
ESC PROG, POST TRIP INSPECTION for Child Reminder System
ESC PROG, INTERLOCK WHEELCHAIR Less Indicator Light in Cluster, for Cutaway Bus
Chassis
ESC PROG, DUAL A/C COMPRESSOR ACCOMMODATION; for Low Speed
Acceleration Disable for Aftermarket A/C System
ESC PROG, SPECIAL FUEL WARNING SINGLE TANK; Low Fuel Warning Light and
Audible Alarm Activated Separately so Warning Light is Activated Prior to Audible Alarm;
Gauge shows full at 7/8 Capacity
Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
ESC PROG, TURN SIGNAL/BRAKE WITH BULB OUT DETECTION
ESC PROG, XFER CASE STATUS GEN 4 ALLISON
Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
ESC PROG, IND LIGHT AIR BRAKE PRESSURE FAILURE
Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
ESC PROG, TRACTION CONTROL IND (Wabco) WITH TRACTION WARNING LIGHT,
FOR FULL POWER HYDRAULIC BRAKE, AIR BRAKE SYSTEM, NOT INCLUDING
TRAILER
ESC PROG, MAX SPEED PARAMETER; Set at 80 mph, With Bus Models with Steering
Wheel Control Pupil Warning lights.
Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
ESC PROG, TRACTION CONTROL (Wabco ATC ENABLE/DISABLE) With Traction
Warning Light, for Full Power Hydraulic
Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
ESC PROG, TRACTION CONTROL (Bendix ATC OFF ROAD) With Traction Control
Warning Light & Switch, for Air Brake Systems Only, Not Including Trailers
Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
ESC PROG, WORK LIGHT Includes Keyless Entry and Timer Function Effects, (2) Default
Switch Located in Center Panel
BC PROG, BRAKE APPL GAUGE IN Prostar Secondary Gauge Cluster
BC PROG, TRAILER AUX CIRCUIT Accessory Powered
BC PROG, TRAILER AUX CIRCUIT Battery Powered
BC PROG, TRANSMISSION PTO Single
BC PROG, FUEL HEATER Will be Activated by BC
BC PROG, COMPASS DISPLAY
BC PROG, PRNDL Gear Display Eaton
BC PROG, PRNDL Gear Display Freedomline
BC PROG, INTERIOR FLOOR LIGHTS in Cab
BC PROG, ROLL STABILITY PROG
BC PROG, TRANSMISSION PTO Dual PTO
BC PROG, ELECT LOAD W/ICON SYS
BC PROG, BRAKE WARN INDICATOR Light and Audible Alarm; Parking Brake/Motion
Warning System for Engaged Parking Brake
BC PROG, COLLISION AVOIDANCE Requires Input From the Right Turn Signal.
October 2012
CROSS REFERENCE
ESC 595 Code
2007 BC
PRE 2007 Feature Description
595 Code
***All denotes 2000, DuraStar, WorkStar, 8000, Bus and Prostar Models***
None
None
None
None
595AEG
595AES
595BAA
595BAB
None
595BAC
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
595AAE
595AAG
595AAJ
595AAM
595AAN
595AAR
595AAS
595AAT
595AAU
595ABM
595ABS
595ABT
595ABU
595ABX
595ACC
595ACD
595ACE
595ACG
595ACL
595ACM
595ACN
595ACP
595ACR
595ACS
595ACT
595ACV
595ACX
595ADJ
595ADM
595ADY
595ALL
595ALM
595ALT
595AMU
595ANR
595ANS
None
595ANT
None
595ANU
None
None
None
595ANV
595ANW
595ANX
None
595ANZ
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
595AXY
595AYE
595AYG
595AYH
595AYJ
595AYM
595AYR
None
595AYW
October 2012
32 - PAGE 9
CROSS REFERENCE
ESC 595 Code
None
2007 BC
PRE 2007 Feature Description
595 Code
***All denotes 2000, DuraStar, WorkStar, 8000, Bus and Prostar Models***
595AYX
None
595AYZ
None
595AZA
None
595AZB
None
595AZC
None
595AZD
None
595AZE
None
595AZG
None
None
None
None
None
595AZH
595AZK
595AZL
595BAD
595BAE
None
595BAG
None
None
595BAH
595BAJ
None
595BAK
None
None
None
595BAL
595BAM
595BAN
None
595BAP
None
None
None
None
None
None
595BAR
595BAS
595BAT
595BAU
595BAV
595BAW
None
595BAX
None
595BAY
None
595BAZ
None
None
None
None
None
None
595BBA
595BBB
595BBC
595BBD
595BBE
595BBG
None
595BBH
None
595BBJ
None
595BBL
None
595BBM
None
None
None
None
None
595BBN
595BBR
595BHG
595BHH
595BHJ
32 - PAGE 10
October 2012
CROSS REFERENCE
ESC 595 Code
2007 BC
PRE 2007 Feature Description
595 Code
***All denotes 2000, DuraStar, WorkStar, 8000, Bus and Prostar Models***
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
595BHK
595BHL
595BHM
595BHN
595BHP
595BHR
595BHS
595BHT
595BHU
595BHV
595BHW
595BHX
595BHY
595BHZ
595BJA
595BJB
None
595BJC
None
595BJD
None
None
None
None
595BJE
595BJG
595BJH
595BJJ
None
595BJK
None
595BJL
None
None
595BJM
595BJN
None
595BJP
None
595BJR
None
595BJS
None
None
None
None
None
595BJT
595BJU
595BJV
595BJW
595BJX
None
595BJY
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
595BJZ
595BKA
595BKB
595BKC
595BKD
595BKE
595BKG
None
595BKH
None
None
None
595BKJ
595BKK
595BKL
None
595BKM
None
595BKN
None
595BKX
October 2012
32 - PAGE 11
CROSS REFERENCE
ESC 595 Code
2007 BC
PRE 2007 Feature Description
595 Code
***All denotes 2000, DuraStar, WorkStar, 8000, Bus and Prostar Models***
None
595BKY
None
None
595BKZ
595BLA
None
595BLB
None
None
None
595BLM
595BLN
595BLP
None
595BLS
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
595BLT
595BLU
595BLV
595BLW
595BLX
595BLY
595BLZ
595BMA
595BMH
595BMJ
595BMK
595BML
595BMN
None
595BMS
None
None
None
None
None
None
595BMT
595BMU
595BMV
595BMW
595BMX
595BMY
None
595BMZ
None
595BNA
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
595BNB
595BNJ
595BNN
595BNP
595BNY
595BPB
595BPC
None
595BPD
None
595BPE
None
595BPG
None
595BPK
None
595BPL
None
595BPM
32 - PAGE 12
BC PROG, PTO SHIFT for (1) Dash Switch with 30 AMP Relay, for Customer Provided
PTO
BC PROG, HVAC 2010, In Cab With Remote AC Condenser
BC PROG, HVAC 2010, In Cab & Sleeper With Remote AC Condenser
BC PROG, HVAC 2010 in Cab With Remote AC Condenser, with Pinout/Relay Drivers 31
& 32
BC PROG, HVAC Condenser Pusher Fan Control
BC PROG, HEADLIGHTS WIG WAG With Highbeam Flash
BC PROG, HEADLIGHTS WIG WAG With Lowbeam or Highbeam Flash
BC PROG, AIR SUSP LOAD CONTRL for Tandem Weight Bias Suspension Air Control
Valve
BC PROG, SNOW VALVE Engine Air Intake
BC PROG, REAR AXLE LOAD MONITOR #7 for Tandem Hendrickson HAS 40-6-K
BC PROG, REAR AXLE LOAD MONITOR #2 for Single HAS 23K
BC PROG, REAR AXLE LOAD MONITOR #3 for Single IROS Long MSM 12-15.5K
BC PROG, REAR AXLE LOAD MONITOR #4 for Single IROS Long MSM 18-21K
BC PROG, REAR AXLE LOAD MONITOR #5 for Single IROS Short MSM 20K
BC PROG, REAR AXLE LOAD MONITOR #6 for Tandem Hendrickson HTB 40K
BC PROG, ROLL STABILLITY PROG {Wabco}
BC PROG, TRANS HILL START AID for Ultra Shift Plus Transmission
BC PROG, FOG LIGHTS REAR ECE R38 Compliant, Red LED
BC PROG, FOG LIGHTS ECE R19/48 Compliant
BC PROG, DAYTIME RUN/LIGHT ECE R87/48 Compliant
BC PROG, IND DAY RUN/LIGHTS ECE R48, On Dash
BC PROG, TRACTION CONTROL IND {Bendix ATC Enable/Disable} with Traction
Warning Light, for Air Brakes, with 2010 Cluster
BC PROG, IND LIGHT AIR BRAKE Pressure Failure
BC PROG, ADJ SPEED LIMIT Include Switch in Center Panel
BC PROG, ACCELERATOR INTERLOCK
BC PROG, UPSHIFT INDICATOR LIGHT
BC PROG, USER ACTIVATED DATA Logger
BC PROG, ELECTRICAL LOAD CONTRL 11.8 Volts
BC PROG, PARKED REGEN SWITCH 2010, Aftertreatment to Allow Parked Regen
Below Light Level for Service Use Only, Do Not Infuse
BC PROG, BRAKE LT W/Retarder ECE or ADR Compliant; Brake Light ON with Retarder
Activated
BC PROG, DM1 HEARTBEAT for pre 2007 Engines
BC PROG, HYDRAULIC BRAKE SPLIT for Hydro Max
BC PROG, TRANSMISSION PTO Dual PTO, for 2010 with 42 Parameters
BC PROG, TRANSMISSION PTO, Single PTO, for 2010 with 42 Parameters
BC PROG, ENGINE FAN WARNING BUZZER
BC PROG, ENGINE FAN DRIVE Variable Speed
BC PROG, CRUISE SWITCH DISABLE with Park Brake Set
BC PROG, PRNDL with 1000/2000 6 SPD Transmission not With Power Park or Park
Prawl
BC PROG, PRNDL with 1000/2000 6 SPD Transmission With Park Prawl and Shifter
Interlock
BC PROG, PRNDL with 1000/2000 6 SPD Transmission With Power Park and Shifter
Interlock
BC PROG, PRNDL with 1000/2000 6 SPD Transmission With Sixth-Gear Disable and
Park Prawl and Shifter Interlock
BC PROG, PRNDL with 1000/2000 6 SPD Transmission With Sixth-Gear Disable not With
Power Park or Park Prawl
BC PROG, PRNDL with 1000/2000 6 SPD Transmission With Sixth-Gear Disable and
Power Park and Shifter Interlock
October 2012
CROSS REFERENCE
Table 197 595 Feature Codes Sorted by Post-2007 Feature Code Number
2007 BC
595 CODE
***All denotes 2000, DuraStar, WorkStar, 8000, Bus and Prostar Models***
595AAA
595AAC
595AAD
595AAE
595AAG
595AAH
595AAH
595AAJ
595AAK
595AAL
595AAM
595AAN
595AAP
595AAR
595AAS
595AAT
595AAU
595AAV
595AAW
595AAX
595AAZ
595ABA
595ABB
595ABC
595ABD
595ABE
595ABG
595ABH
595ABJ
595ABK
595ABL
595ABM
595ABN
595ABP
595ABR
595ABS
595ABT
595ABU
595232
595031
595015
None
None
595188
595314
None
595106
595021
None
None
595083
None
None
None
None
595023
595153
595185
595014
595063
595008
595030
595052
595192
595130
595126
595127
595067
595066
None
595069
595061
595250
None
None
None
595ABV
595009
595ABW
595ABX
595ABY
595ABZ
595ACA
595012
None
595107
595129
595273
595ACB
595011
595ACC
595ACD
595ACE
595ACG
595ACL
595ACM
595ACN
595ACP
595ACR
595ACS
595ACT
None
None
595019
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
October 2012
32 - PAGE 13
CROSS REFERENCE
2007 BC
595 CODE
***All denotes 2000, DuraStar, WorkStar, 8000, Bus and Prostar Models***
595ACU
595ACV
595040
None
595ACW
595051
595ACX
595ACY
595ACZ
595ADA
595ADB
595ADC
595ADD
595ADG
595ADH
595ADJ
595ADK
595ADL
595ADM
595ADN
595ADP
595ADR
595ADS
595ADT
595ADU
595ADV
595ADW
595ADX
595ADY
595ADZ
595AEA
595AEB
595AEC
None
595033
595041
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
595100
595336
None
595143
595037
595112
None
None
None
595163
595254
595097
None
595060
None
None
None
595AED
None
595AEE
595AEG
595AEH
595AEJ
None
None
595306
595108
595AEK
595164
595AEL
595113
595AEL
595317
595AEP
595AER
595AES
595007
595208
None
595AET
595114
595AEU
595116
595AEV
595115
595AEV
595228
595AEW
595AEX
595AEY
595AEZ
595AGA
595AGB
595AGC
595145
595212
595276
595146
595315
595210
595016
32 - PAGE 14
BC PROG, LOCKING DIFFERENTIAL for Single & Dual With Single Switch
BC PROG, ENGINE AIR MONITOR
BC PROG, ENGINE FAN OVERRIDE Includes Manual Switch for Automatic Manual Fan
Control
BC PROG, INTAKE MANIFOLD PRESS
BC PROG, FIFTH WHEEL SLIDE
BC PROG, POWER DIVIDER LOCK
BC PROG, BRAKE APPL GAUGE IN Prostar Secondary Gauge Cluster
BC PROG, TRAILER AUX CIRCUIT Accessory Powered
BC PROG, TRAILER AUX CIRCUIT Battery Powered
BC PROG, TRANSMISSION PTO Single
BC PROG, FUEL HEATER Will be Activated by BC
BC PROG, COMPASS DISPLAY
BC PROG, REMOTE START/STOP In Bunk
BC PROG, AIR SHIELD LIGHTING
BC PROG, HVAC In Cab
BC PROG, HVAC In Sleeper
BC PROG, METRIC GAUGE
BC PROG, CLUTCH SWITCH
BC PROG, PRNDL No PRNDL, Manual Transmission
BC PROG, PRNDL Gear Display Eaton
BC PROG, PRNDL Gear Display Freedomline
BC PROG, INTERIOR FLOOR LIGHTS in Cab
BC PROG, PDL WARNING BUZZER
BC PROG, MONITOR ENG OIL TEMP Through Body Controller
BC PROG, MONITOR ENG OIL TEMP Through ECM
BC PROG, TRANS OIL TEMP Through Body
BC PROG, TRANS OIL TEMP Through TCM
BC PROG, ROLL STABILITY PROG
BC PROG, TRANSMISSION PTO Dual PTO
BC PROG, ELECT LOAD W/ICON SYS
BC PROG, BRAKE WARN INDICATOR Light and Audible Alarm; Parking Brake/Motion
Warning System for Engaged Parking Brake
BC PROG, COLLISION AVOIDANCE Requires Input From the Right Turn Signal.
BC PROG, SKIRT LIGHTS Customer Supplied
BC PROG, EXTERIOR LIGHT CHECK for Bus
BC PROG, POWER WINDOW/DOOR LOCK With 4 Doors
BC PROG, TRACTION CONTROL IND {Wabco ATC MUD/SNOW} With Traction Warning
Light, for Full Power Hydraulic Brake or Air Brakes, Not Including Trailer
BC PROG, PRNDL With 1000/2000 5 SPD Transmission With Park Pawl & Shifter
Interlock
BC PROG, PRNDL With 1000/2000 5 SPD Transmission With Park Pawl & Shifter
Interlock
BC PROG, AIR PRESSURE GAUGES Auxiliary
BC PROG, TACHOMETER 4000 RPM
BC PROG, EXTERIOR LIGHT CHECK for MD, RH & SS
BC PROG, PRNDL With 1000/2000 5 Speed Transmission not With Power Park or Park
Pawl
BC PROG, PRNDL With 3000/4000 5 & 6 Speed Transmission
BC PROG, PRNDL With 1000/2000 5 Speed Transmission With Power Park & Shifter
Interlock
BC PROG, PRNDL With 1000/2000 5 Speed Transmission With Power Park & Shifter
Interlock
BC PROG, TRANS OIL TEMP
BC PROG, CROSSING GATE DISABLE Switch Mounted in Panel
BC PROG, CROSSING GATE DISABLE Switch With Stop Arm Inhibit, Mounted in Panel
BC PROG, AMMETER 150 AMP
BC PROG, BUZZER EMERGENCY EXIT Red Always Hot Override With Exit Buzzer
BC PROG, BUZZER EMERGENCY EXIT and Warning Light
BC PROG, ENGINE EXHAUST BRAKE
October 2012
CROSS REFERENCE
2007 BC
595 CODE
***All denotes 2000, DuraStar, WorkStar, 8000, Bus and Prostar Models***
595AGE
595AGG
595AGH
595AGJ
595AGK
595AGL
595AGM
595271
595272
595307
595308
595291
595213
595295
595AGN
595293
595AYM
595293
595AGP
595214
595AGR
595215
595AGS
595218
595AGT
595225
595AGU
595270
595AGV
595286
595AGW
595312
595AGX
595313
595AGY
595318
595AGZ
595319
595AHA
595AHB
595AHC
595AHD
595AHE
595AHG
595AHH
595AHJ
595AHK
595AHL
595AHM
595AHN
595034
595119
595120
595121
595032
595122
595274
595184
595160
595158
595206
595221
595AHP
595323
595AHR
595326
595AHS
595AHT
595AHU
595AHW
595AHX
595AHY
595AHZ
595AJA
595AJC
595327
595161
595203
595137
595259
595260
595261
595262
595300
595AJD
595288
595AJE
595168
October 2012
32 - PAGE 15
CROSS REFERENCE
2007 BC
595 CODE
***All denotes 2000, DuraStar, WorkStar, 8000, Bus and Prostar Models***
595AJG
595282
595AJH
595265
595AJK
595AJL
595AJM
595AJN
595AJP
595AJR
595AJS
595AJT
595173
595174
595175
595183
595189
595190
595277
595170
595AJU
595248
595AJV
595171
595AJW
595193
595AJX
595252
595AJY
595244
595AJZ
595AKA
595AKB
595AKC
595AKD
595AKE
595AKG
595AKH
595AKJ
595179
595178
595181
595182
595200
595238
595239
595283
595172
595AKK
595241
595AKL
595240
595AKM
595196
595AKN
595AKP
595AKR
595AKS
595AKT
595AKU
595AKV
595AKW
595AKX
595AKY
595AKZ
595ALA
595ALB
595ALC
595ALD
595ALE
595263
595198
595201
595202
595299
595301
595246
595245
595223
595024
595297
595269
595018
595166
595022
595047
595ALG
595275
595ALH
595285
595ALJ
595284
595ALK
595ALL
595ALM
595ALN
595ALR
595125
None
None
595039
595180
32 - PAGE 16
October 2012
CROSS REFERENCE
2007 BC
595 CODE
***All denotes 2000, DuraStar, WorkStar, 8000, Bus and Prostar Models***
595ALS
595ALT
595ALU
595ALV
595ALW
595ALX
595ALY
595ALZ
595AMA
595AMB
595186
None
595224
595118
595162
595092
595157
595159
595230
595292
595AMC
595255
595AMD
595197
595AME
595278
595AMG
595279
595AMH
595324
595AMJ
595325
595AMM
595330
595AMN
595219
595AMP
595249
595AMR
595AMS
595AMT
595AMU
595AMV
595AMW
595AYY
595AMX
595249
595019
595019
None
595099
595AMY
595151
595AMZ
595267
595ANA
595ANB
595339
595111
595ANC
595332
595AND
595ANE
595ANG
595ANK
595ANL
595ANM
595ANN
595ANP
595ANP
595ANR
595ANS
595331
595017
595091
595316
514011
595167
595110
595075
595150
None
None
595ANT
None
595ANU
None
595ANV
595ANW
595ANX
None
None
None
595322
BC
October 2012
32 - PAGE 17
CROSS REFERENCE
2007 BC
595 CODE
***All denotes 2000, DuraStar, WorkStar, 8000, Bus and Prostar Models***
595ANY
595344
595ANZ
None
595AXY
595AYA
595AYB
595AYC
595AYD
595AYE
595AYG
595AYH
595AYJ
595AYK
595AYL
595AYM
595AYN
595AYP
595AYR
595AYS
595AYT
None
595086
595087
595253
595048
None
None
None
None
595093
595287
None
595266
595038
None
595105
595227
595AYU
595334
595AYV
595348
595AYW
None
595AYX
None
595AYY
595AYZ
595321
None
595AZA
None
595AZB
None
595AZC
None
595AZD
None
595AZE
None
595AZG
None
595AZH
None
595AZJ
595351
595AZK
595AZL
595AZM
595AZN
None
None
595338
595343
595AZR
595345
595AZS
595337
595AZU
595AZV
595333
595328
595AZW
595346
595AZX
595AZY
595231
595296
32 - PAGE 18
BC PROG, INTERLOCK WHEELCHAIR Less Indicator Light in Cluster, for Cutaway Bus
Chassis
BC PROG, IDLE MANAGEMENT SYS for Cummins ICON, N/Freedomline Xmsns, Cruise
Control State Must be Maintained Across Key Cycles Instead of Resetting
BC PROG, FUEL TANK GAUGE Dual Right Side Draw
BC PROG, AXLE TEMP GAUGE Dual
BC PROG, AXLE TEMP GAUGE Single, for SS & Medium
BC PROG, WINDSHIELD WIPER Without Low Washer Fluid Indicator
BC PROG, LOW WASHER FLUID IND.
BC PROG, IP CONFIGURATION for ProStar
BC PROG, ENGINE TYPE MFG International HDD
BC PROG, ENGINE FAN DRIVE Variable Speed
BC PROG, CRUISE CONTL STEER WH ON/OFF, With Diagnosable Switches
BC PROG, FRONT AIR SUSPENSION
BC PROG, THROTTLE CRUISE Without Cruise in Switch Pack
BC PROG, LIFT GATE WIRING PAK Rocker Position
BC PROG, PTO MONITOR for Indicator and Alarm Connected to Body Controller
BC PROG, AUTO NEUTRAL
BC PROG, ECONOMY MODE SWITCH
BC PROG, IP CONFIGURATION for MD, RH, & SS
BC PROG, IP CONFIGURATION for Bus
BC PROG, THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM to Read a Combination Code From a 6-Pack
and Send TSC1 Messages to Limit Engine Speed if an Incorrect Code is Entered
BC PROG, XFER CASE STATUS To TCM; for Allison Gen 4 Transmissions
BC PROG, EXHAUST CLOGGED IND. Indicator for Clogged Diesel Particulate Filter in
Aftertreatment
BC PROG, EXHAUST HIGH TEMP Indicator for High Exhaust Temperatures
(Aftertreatment)
BC PROG, SNOW PLOW LIGHTS GEN 2, With Rocker Switch
BC PROG, INHIBIT REGEN SWITCH Latched (TWO POSITION, BI-STABLE)
BC PROG, INHIBIT REGEN SWITCH Momentary (THREE POSITION,
CENTER-STABLE)
BC PROG, ENGINE COMPRESSION BRAKE With Programmable Levels; Uses On/Off
Switch in Steering Wheel and 1/2/3 Switch in Switchpack
BC PROG, ENGINE COMPRESSION BR With Programmable Levels; Located in Switch
Pack
BC PROG, ENGINE COMPRESSION BR With Variable & Programmable Levels; Located
in Switch Pack
BC PROG, EXHAUST TEMP LIGHT Indicator Light in IP; for High Exhaust Temperatures
(Aftertreatment) for ProStar.
BC PROG, EXHAUST CLOGGED IND. Indicator Light in IP; for Clogged Diesel Particulate
Filter In Aftertreatment, for ProStar
BC PROG, PARKED REGEN SWITCH for Aftertreatment
BC PROG, MAX SPEED PARAMETER for PWL; Set at 80 mph, With Bus Models with
Steering Wheel Control Pupil Warning lights.
BC PROG, FRONT AXLE LOAD MONITOR Meets SAE Standard, Forward Axle
BC PROG, REAR AXLE LOAD MONITOR Meets SAE Standards, for Rear Axle
BC PROG, POST TRIP INSPECTION With Snooze
BC PROG, POST TRIP INSPECTION for Child Reminder System
BC PROG, A/C COMPRESSOR ACCOM. DUAL; for Low Speed Acceleration Disable for
Aftermarket A/C System
BC PROG, ADVANCED LOGIC DLB for Service and Engineering Changes on Bus Only
Not to be infused on any vehicle (DO NOT INFUSE)
BC PROG, INVERTER ON In Cab Multiplex Switch enables 3kw Inverter
BC PROG, PARK BRAKE ALARM
BC PROG, SPECIAL FUEL WARNING SINGLE TANK; Low Fuel Warning Light and
Audible Alarm Activated Separately so Warning Light is Activated Prior to Audible Alarm;
Gauge shows full at 7/8 Capacity
BC PROG, LOGIC BUILDER Enabler
BC PROG, EXTERIOR LIGHT CHECK Push Button B; for MD, RH & SS
October 2012
CROSS REFERENCE
2007 BC
595 CODE
***All denotes 2000, DuraStar, WorkStar, 8000, Bus and Prostar Models***
595AZZ
595BAA
595BAB
595251
None
None
595BAC
None
595BAD
595BAE
None
None
595BAG
None
595BAH
595BAJ
None
None
595BAK
None
595BAL
595BAM
595BAN
None
None
None
595BAP
None
595BAR
595BAS
595BAT
595BAU
595BAV
595BAW
None
None
None
None
None
None
595BAX
None
595BAY
None
595BAZ
None
595BBA
595BBB
595BBC
595BBD
595BBE
595BBG
None
None
None
None
None
None
595BBH
None
595BBJ
None
595BBL
None
595BBM
None
595BBN
595BBR
595BHG
595BHH
595BHJ
595BHK
595BHL
595BHM
595BHN
595BHP
595BHR
595BHS
595BHT
595BHU
595BHV
595BHW
595BHX
595BHY
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
October 2012
32 - PAGE 19
CROSS REFERENCE
2007 BC
595 CODE
***All denotes 2000, DuraStar, WorkStar, 8000, Bus and Prostar Models***
595BHZ
595BJA
595BJB
None
None
None
595BJC
None
595BJD
None
595BJE
595BJG
595BJH
595BJJ
None
None
None
None
595BJK
None
595BJL
None
595BJM
595BJN
None
None
595BJP
None
595BJR
None
595BJS
None
595BJT
595BJU
595BJV
595BJW
595BJX
None
None
None
None
None
595BJY
None
595BJZ
None
595BKA
None
595BKB
None
595BKC
None
595BKD
595BKE
595BKG
None
None
None
595BKH
None
595BKJ
595BKK
595BKL
None
None
None
595BKM
None
595BKN
None
595BKX
None
595BKY
None
595BKZ
595BLA
None
None
595BLB
None
595BLM
595BLN
595BLP
None
None
None
595BLS
None
32 - PAGE 20
BC PROG, AUXILIARY LOAD #7 for (2) Rocker Switches and (2) Relays
BC PROG, HEV E-PTO 2010 Hybrid Electric Vehicle
BC PROG, WAIT TO START IND. 2010
BC PROG, EXHAUST CLOGGED IND. 2010, Indicator for Clogged Diesel Particulate
Filter in Aftertreatment
BC PROG, EXHAUST HIGH TEMP 2010, Indicator for High Exhaust Temperatures
(Aftertreatment)
BC PROG, INHIBIT REGEN SWITCH 2010, Latched
BC PROG, INHIBIT REGEN SWITCH 2010, Momentary
BC PROG, IP CONFIGURATION 2010, for MD, RH & SS
BC PROG, PARKED REGEN SWITCH 2010 Aftertreatment
BC PROG, RANGE INHIBITED WARN 2010, Light for 1000, 2000, 3000 & 4000 Allison
Gen 4 Transmission
BC PROG, TRACTION CONTROL IND (Bendix ATC Off Road) 2010, With Traction
Warning Light, for Air Brakes
BC PROG, IP CONFIGURATION 2010, for ProStar & LoneStar
BC PROG, HVAC 2010, In Sleeper (Behr) and Cab (Bergstrom)
BC PROG, TRACTION CONTROL IND (Wabco ATC MUD/SNOW) 2010, With Traction
Warning Light, for Full Power Hydraulic Brake or Air Brakes, Not Including Trailer
BC PROG, LOGIC BUILDER 2010 Enabler
BC PROG, PTO MONITOR 2010, for Indicator and Alarm Connected to Remote Power
Module
BC PROG, PTO MONITOR 2010, for Indicator and Alarm Connected to Body Controller
BC PROG, IP CONFIGURATION 2010 for Bus
BC PROG, PARKED REGEN SWITCH 2010, for Aftertreatment Switch Blank for BUS
BC PROG, DIESEL PART FILTER ID 2010 Level Indicator
BC PROG, XFER CASE 2 SPD W/2007 V8
BC PROG, TRACTION CONTROL IND (Wabco ATC ENABLE/DISABLE) 2010, With
Traction Warning Light, for Full Power Hydraulic
BC PROG, HEADLIGHTS WIG WAG With Bus Pupil Warning Lights
BC PROG, FULL TIME LIGHTS Provides Head Lights, Park Lights, and Panel Lights when
the Engine is Running
Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
BC PROG, IDLE MANAGEMENT SYSTEM for Heat/HVAC (Bergstrom)
Not Required or Implemented for 2007 BC
BC PROG, HVAC, In Sleeper (Bergstrom) and Cab (Behr)
BC PROG, BODY CONTROLLER for Truck Body Controller #2
BC PROG, BODY CONTROLLER for Bus Body Controller #2
BC PROG, INTERLOCK WHEELCHAIR 2010 With Indicator Light in Cluster
BC PROG, INTERLOCK WHEELCHAIR 2010 With Transmission in Park, Indicator Light in
Cluster, Bus Only
BC PROG, TRANSMISSION PTO Single, for 2010
BC PROG, TRANSMISSION PTO for 2010; Dual PTO
BC PROG, ENGINE RETARDER for 2010; Located in Steering Wheel
BC PROG, ENGINE RETARDER for 2010; With Programmable Levels; Uses On/Off
Switch in Steering Wheel and 1/2/3 Switch in Switchpack
BC PROG, ENGINE COMPRESSION BRAKE with Optional Jake Brake Foot Pedal
BC PROG, TRACTION CONTROL IND {Bendix ATC ENABLE/DISABLE} With Traction
Warning Light, for Air Brakes
BC PROG, PTO SHIFT for (1) Dash Switch with 30 AMP Relay, for Customer Provided
PTO
BC PROG, HVAC 2010, In Cab With Remote AC Condenser
BC PROG, HVAC 2010, In Cab & Sleeper With Remote AC Condenser
BC PROG, HVAC 2010 in Cab With Remote AC Condenser, with Pinout/Relay Drivers 31
& 32
BC PROG, HVAC Condenser Pusher Fan Control
BC PROG, HEADLIGHTS WIG WAG With Highbeam Flash
BC PROG, HEADLIGHTS WIG WAG With Lowbeam or Highbeam Flash
BC PROG, AIR SUSP LOAD CONTRL for Tandem Weight Bias Suspension Air Control
Valve
October 2012
CROSS REFERENCE
2007 BC
595 CODE
***All denotes 2000, DuraStar, WorkStar, 8000, Bus and Prostar Models***
595BLT
595BLU
595BLV
595BLW
595BLX
595BLY
595BLZ
595BMA
595BMH
595BMJ
595BMK
595BML
595BMN
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
595BMS
None
595BMT
595BMU
595BMV
595BMW
595BMX
595BMY
None
None
None
None
None
None
595BMZ
None
595BNA
None
595BNB
595BNJ
595BNN
595BNP
595BNY
595BPB
595BPC
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
595BPD
None
595BPE
None
595BPG
None
595BPK
None
595BPK
None
595BPM
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
595006
595010
595013
595020
595025
595026
595027
595028
595029
595035
595036
595042
595045
595046
595049
595050
October 2012
32 - PAGE 21
CROSS REFERENCE
2007 BC
595 CODE
***All denotes 2000, DuraStar, WorkStar, 8000, Bus and Prostar Models***
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
32 - PAGE 22
595054
595057
595058
595059
595064
595065
595068
595070
595071
595072
595073
595074
595076
595077
595078
595079
595080
595081
595082
595084
595085
595088
595089
595090
595094
595095
595096
595098
595101
595102
595103
595104
595109
595117
595123
595124
595128
595131
595132
595133
595134
595135
595136
595138
595139
595140
595141
595142
595144
595147
595148
595149
595152
595154
595169
595176
595177
595187
595194
595195
October 2012
CROSS REFERENCE
2007 BC
595 CODE
***All denotes 2000, DuraStar, WorkStar, 8000, Bus and Prostar Models***
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
595199
595204
595207
595209
595220
595222
595229
595233
595234
595235
595242
595243
595247
595256
595280
595281
595289
595302
595303
595304
595309
595310
595311
595320
595341
595342
595347
October 2012
32 - PAGE 23
CROSS REFERENCE
32 - PAGE 24
October 2012
INDEX
INDEX
C
Numerics
October 2012
INDEX-1
INDEX
G
H
Hazard Light Override Stop Lights ............................11-5
Headlight Warning Buzzer.........................................11-6
Headlights On W/Wipers ...........................................07-4
Headlights Wig Wag ................................................12-14
HEV Signals Available to Advanced Logic ..............30-13
High Voltage Circuits (Greater Than 50 Volts) on
International Trucks and Buses......................04-10
How Do I - General Information...............................04-18
How to Identify High Voltage Circuits ......................04-12
Hybrid Display Located in Auxiliary Gauge
and Switch Pack ...............................................30-22
Hybrid Electric Vehicle...............................................30-1
Radios, 2-Way...........................................................08-2
Recommended Circuit Protection..............................04-1
Remote Air Solenoid Module.....................................25-1
Remote Engine Speed Control Caterpillar and
Cummins Engines.............................................24-39
I
In-Cab Lighting ..........................................................14-9
Indicator Lights and Alarms .......................................21-1
Instrument Cluster Adding Air Gauges ...................17-3
Instrument Cluster - Adding Gauges .........................17-6
Instrument Cluster - Fault Codes.............................17-11
Instrument Cluster - Omit Fault Codes ....................17-11
J
J1939 High Speed Data Link Cable ........................04-10
J1939 High Speed Data Link Cable (SAE J1939/15) 04-1
Junction Block Stud ...................................................22-3
K
INDEX-2
October 2012
INDEX
Remote Engine Speed Control features....................24-1
Remote Mounted Engine Control ............................24-13
Remote Power Modules ............................................18-1
Remote Start/Stop.....................................................26-1
Remote Start/Stop with Emergency Pump................26-3
Remote Throttle Control Interlocked to Park Brake
Applied..............................................................24-21
Routing Guidelines ..................................................04-14
Run/Stop Diesel Engine ..........................................30-10
S
Safety Information .....................................................01-1
Seatbelt Warning Prewire..........................................11-6
Servicing Navistar Products ....................................04-12
Splice Clip Installation ...............................................04-4
Splice Inspection .......................................................04-5
Standard Battery and Ignition Taps...........................07-1
Standard Tail, Marker, and Clearance Lamp
Connection..........................................................13-1
Standard Terminals and Splices ...............................04-3
Stop/Turn/Tail............................................................13-1
Suppression ............................................................04-13
Switch Actuators for Multiplex System ......................19-2
Switch, Air Horn, Passenger, Fire Truck ...................25-5
Switches and Switch Label part Numbers and
Information..........................................................19-1
T
TEM Air Solenoids.....................................................25-1
Test Exterior Lamps Except Back Ups......................11-1
Theft Deterrent .................................................29-1, 30-1
Three Interlocked Latched Switches Disengage
at 30 MPH with PTO Accommodation ..............23-44
Three Momentary Rocker Switches/Remote Switch
Capability ..........................................................20-19
Throttle, Hand Control, Mobile, Variable Speed......24-13
Throttle, Hand Control, Stationary Pre-Set..............24-12
Throttle, Hand Control, Stationary, Variable Speed 24-12
October 2012
INDEX-3
INDEX
INDEX-4
October 2012